1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.98"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
54 .set drivernamemax "64"
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
62 . provided in the xfpt library.
63 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
65 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
67 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
69 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
70 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
72 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
73 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
75 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
76 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
77 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
79 . --- Also one for multiple option def headings be grouped in a single
80 . --- table (but without the split capability).
83 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
87 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
98 .orow "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .orow "$+1" "$+2" "$+3" "$+4"
113 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
114 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
115 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
117 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
118 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
122 . --- A macro for a plain variable, including the .vitem and .vindex
128 . --- A macro for a "tainted" marker, done as a one-element table
130 .itable none 0 0 1 10pt left
135 . --- A macro for a tainted variable, adding a taint-marker
141 . --- A macro for a cmdline option, including a .oindex
142 . --- 1st arg is the option name, undecorated (we do that here).
143 . --- 2nd arg, optional, text (decorated as needed) to be appended to the name
145 .vitem &%$1%&$=2+&~$2+
149 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
150 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
151 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
155 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
159 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
167 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
168 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
169 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
170 . --- ID that ties them together.
171 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
172 . --- head, or list-item.
175 &<indexterm role="concept">&
176 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
178 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
184 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
185 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
187 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
193 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
197 &<indexterm role="option">&
198 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
200 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
205 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
206 . --- head, or varlist item.
209 &<indexterm role="variable">&
210 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
212 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
218 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
222 . use this for a concept-index entry for a header line
224 .cindex "&'$1'& header line"
225 .cindex "header lines" $1
227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
231 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
237 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
238 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
242 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
243 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
244 <revhistory><revision>
246 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
247 </revision></revhistory>
250 </year><holder>The Exim Maintainers</holder></copyright>
255 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
256 . These implement index entries of the form "x, see y" and "x, see also y".
257 . However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
258 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
259 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
261 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
265 <indexterm role="$2">
266 <primary>$3</primary>
268 <secondary>$5</secondary>
270 <$1><emphasis>$4</emphasis></$1>
275 . NB: for the 4-arg variant the ordering is awkward
277 .seeother see "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
280 .seeother seealso "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
283 .see variable "<emphasis>$1</emphasis>, <emphasis>$2</emphasis>, etc." "numerical variables"
284 .see concept address rewriting rewriting
285 .see concept "Bounce Address Tag Validation" BATV
286 .see concept "Client SMTP Authorization" CSA
287 .see concept "CR character" "carriage return"
288 .see concept CRL "certificate revocation list"
289 .seealso concept de-tainting "tainted data"
290 .see concept delivery "bounce message" "failure report"
291 .see concept dialup "intermittently connected hosts"
292 .see concept exiscan "content scanning"
293 .see concept fallover fallback
294 .see concept filter "Sieve filter" Sieve
295 .see concept headers "header lines"
296 .see concept ident "RFC 1413"
297 .see concept "LF character" "linefeed"
298 .seealso concept maximum limit
299 .see concept monitor "Exim monitor"
300 .see concept "no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis>" "entry for xxx"
301 .see concept NUL "binary zero"
302 .see concept "passwd file" "/etc/passwd"
303 .see concept "process id" pid
304 .see concept RBL "DNS list"
305 .see concept redirection "address redirection"
306 .see concept "return path" "envelope sender"
307 .see concept scanning "content scanning"
309 .see concept string expansion expansion
310 .see concept "top bit" "8-bit characters"
311 .see concept variables "expansion, variables"
312 .see concept "zero, binary" "binary zero"
315 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
316 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
317 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
318 . chapter "Introduction"
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
321 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
322 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
323 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
324 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
326 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
327 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
328 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
329 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
330 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
331 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
332 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
334 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
335 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
336 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
338 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
339 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
340 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
342 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
343 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
344 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
345 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
346 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
348 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
349 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
350 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
351 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
352 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
354 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
355 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
356 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
357 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
361 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
362 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
365 .cindex "documentation"
366 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
367 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
368 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
369 capable of showing a change indicator.
372 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
373 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
374 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
375 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
376 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
377 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
378 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
381 .cindex "books about Exim"
382 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
383 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
384 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
385 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
387 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
388 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
389 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
390 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
392 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
393 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
394 Debian-specific features in the file
395 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
396 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
399 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
400 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
402 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
403 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
404 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
405 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
406 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
408 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
409 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
410 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
411 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
413 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
414 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
416 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
417 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
418 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
422 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
423 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
424 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
425 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
426 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
427 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
428 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
429 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
432 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
433 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
434 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
438 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
441 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
442 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
443 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
447 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
448 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
449 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
450 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
451 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
452 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
453 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
456 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
457 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
458 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
459 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
462 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
463 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
464 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
467 .row &'exim-announce@lists.exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
468 .row &'exim-users@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list"
469 .row &'exim-users-de@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list in German language"
470 .row &'exim-dev@lists.exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
471 .row &'exim-cvs@lists.exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
474 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
475 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
476 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
477 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
478 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
481 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
483 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
486 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
487 .cindex "bug reports"
488 .cindex "reporting bugs"
489 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
490 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
491 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
492 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
496 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
498 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
499 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
500 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
501 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
503 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
505 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
506 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
508 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
509 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
510 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
512 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
513 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
514 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
515 here are top-level directories.
517 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
518 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
520 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
521 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
522 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
523 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
532 most portable to old systems.
534 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
535 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
536 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
537 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
538 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
539 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
540 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
541 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
542 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
543 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
544 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
546 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
547 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
548 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
549 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
551 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
554 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
555 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
557 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
558 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
559 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
561 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
562 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
563 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
564 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
566 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
571 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
572 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
575 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
577 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
578 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
579 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
580 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
581 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
582 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
583 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
585 .cindex "domainless addresses"
586 .cindex "address" "without domain"
587 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
588 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
589 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
590 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
593 .cindex "transport" "external"
594 .cindex "external transports"
595 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
596 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
597 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
598 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
599 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
600 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
602 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
603 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
604 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
607 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
608 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
609 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
610 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
611 a number of common scanners are provided.
615 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
616 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
617 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
618 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
619 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
620 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
623 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
624 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
625 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
626 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
627 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
628 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
629 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
630 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
631 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
632 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
633 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
634 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
636 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
637 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
638 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
639 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
643 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
644 .cindex "terminology definitions"
645 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
646 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
647 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
648 below) by a blank line.
650 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
651 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
652 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
653 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
654 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
655 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
656 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
657 rise to further bounce messages.
659 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
660 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
661 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
664 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
665 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
666 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
669 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
670 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
671 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
673 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
674 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
675 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
676 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
677 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
678 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
679 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
680 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
682 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
683 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
684 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
685 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
686 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
687 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
690 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
691 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
692 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
693 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
694 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
696 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
697 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
698 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
699 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
700 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
701 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
703 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
704 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
707 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
708 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
709 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
710 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
711 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
713 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
714 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
715 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
716 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
717 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
719 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
720 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
721 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
722 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
723 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
724 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
731 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
734 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
735 .cindex "incorporated code"
736 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
739 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
742 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
743 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE2 library, copyright
744 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE2 is not longer shipped with
745 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE2 shipped with your system,
746 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
747 &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
749 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
750 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
751 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
752 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
753 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
754 following statements:
757 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
759 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
760 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
761 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
763 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
764 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
765 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
766 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
767 restrictions applied to it).
770 .cindex "SPA authentication"
771 .cindex "Samba project"
772 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
773 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
774 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
775 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
779 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
780 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
781 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
782 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
783 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
784 conditions expressed therein.
787 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
789 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
790 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
794 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
795 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
797 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
798 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
799 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
802 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
803 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
804 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
805 details, please contact
807 Office of Technology Transfer
808 Carnegie Mellon University
810 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
811 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
812 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
815 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
818 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
819 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
821 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
822 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
823 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
824 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
825 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
826 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
827 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
832 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
835 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
836 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
837 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
838 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
841 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
842 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
846 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
847 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
848 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
849 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
850 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
851 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
852 software without specific, written prior permission.
854 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
855 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
856 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
857 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
858 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
859 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
864 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
865 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
866 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
867 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
868 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
872 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
873 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
874 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
881 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
882 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
884 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
885 "Receiving and delivering mail"
888 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
889 .cindex "design philosophy"
890 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
891 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
892 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
893 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
894 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
895 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
898 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
899 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
900 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
901 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
902 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
903 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
904 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
907 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
908 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
909 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
910 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
911 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
912 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
913 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
914 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
915 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
918 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
919 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
921 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
922 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
923 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
924 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
926 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
927 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
928 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
929 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
930 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
932 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
933 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
934 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
936 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
937 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
938 runs at the start of every delivery process.
943 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
944 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
945 .cindex "Sieve filter"
946 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
947 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
948 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
949 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
950 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
951 of filtering are available:
954 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
957 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
958 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
961 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
965 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
966 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
967 .cindex "format" "of message id"
968 .cindex "id of message"
973 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
974 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is 23
975 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
976 example &`16VDhn-000000001bo-D342`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
977 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
978 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
979 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
980 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
981 not always case-sensitive.
983 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
984 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
985 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
986 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
987 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
988 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
992 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
993 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
994 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
995 way of representing the date and time of day).
997 After the first hyphen, the next
999 characters are the id of the process that received the message.
1001 There are two different possibilities for the final four characters:
1003 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1004 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1005 time of reception, normally in units of
1008 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1009 systems), the units are
1012 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by
1013 500000 (250000) and added to
1014 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 2 us (4 us).
1018 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1019 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1020 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1021 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1022 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1024 The exim_msgdate utility (see section &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>&) can be
1025 used to display the date, and optionally the process id, of an Exim
1029 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030 .cindex "receiving mail"
1031 .cindex "message" "reception"
1032 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035 there are several possibilities:
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1042 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1049 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1055 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1062 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1070 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074 users to change sender addresses.
1076 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1081 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1084 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089 message is received.
1095 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1104 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113 affect file system performance.
1115 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1121 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1136 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137 .cindex "message" "life of"
1138 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1139 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1146 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1153 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1159 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1160 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1166 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1171 .cindex "journal file"
1172 .cindex "file" "journal"
1173 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1182 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1183 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186 deliveries caused by crashes.
1190 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1193 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1198 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1200 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1202 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208 the driver's features in general.
1210 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1216 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1223 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1230 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1235 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1237 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243 configured to fail the address.
1245 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1252 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257 the address is bounced.
1261 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1263 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1270 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1275 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1282 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283 .cindex "router" "running details"
1284 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1286 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1293 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295 original address ceases
1296 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1303 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1309 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1311 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1315 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1321 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1325 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1330 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1334 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1340 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344 facility for this purpose.
1347 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348 .cindex "case of local parts"
1349 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1354 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355 routed addresses are shown.
1359 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1367 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1368 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373 of any other conditions.
1375 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1379 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1385 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1391 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1395 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1399 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1400 of domains that it defines.
1401 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
1402 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
1403 A match verifies the variable &$domain$& (which carries tainted data)
1404 and assigns an untainted value to the &$domain_data$& variable.
1405 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1406 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1407 refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&.
1409 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1410 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1413 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1414 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1415 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1416 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1417 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1418 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1419 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1420 the set of local parts that it defines.
1421 A match verifies the variable &$local_part$& (which carries tainted data)
1422 and assigns an untainted value to the &$local_part_data$& variable.
1423 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1424 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1425 refer to section &<<SECTlocparlis>>&.
1427 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1428 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1430 If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1431 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1432 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1433 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1434 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1435 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1436 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1439 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1440 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1442 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1443 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1444 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1445 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1446 remaining preconditions.
1449 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1450 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1451 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1452 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1453 could lead to confusion.
1456 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1457 set of addresses that it defines.
1460 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1461 specified files is tested.
1464 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1465 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1466 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1467 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1469 Note that while using
1470 this option for address matching technically works,
1471 it does not set any de-tainted values.
1472 Such values are often needed, either for router-specific options or
1473 for transport options.
1474 Using the &%domains%& and &%local_parts%& options is usually the most
1475 convenient way to obtain them.
1479 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1480 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1481 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1482 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1483 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1484 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1485 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1489 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1490 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1491 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1494 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1495 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1496 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1497 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1498 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1500 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1501 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1503 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1504 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1505 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1506 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1507 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1508 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1511 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1512 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1513 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1514 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1515 processed entirely independently of each other.
1517 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1518 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1519 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1520 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1521 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1522 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1523 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1524 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1525 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1527 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1528 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1529 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1530 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1531 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1532 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1533 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1534 addresses to the same domain.
1536 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1537 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1538 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1539 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1540 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1541 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1542 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1543 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1545 .cindex "queue runner"
1546 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1547 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1548 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1549 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1550 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1551 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1552 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1553 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1554 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1556 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1557 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1558 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1559 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1560 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1561 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1563 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1564 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1565 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1566 messages to other addresses.
1568 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1569 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1570 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1573 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1574 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1575 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1581 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1582 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1583 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1584 .cindex "queue runner"
1585 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1586 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1587 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1588 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1589 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1590 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1591 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1592 passed its retry time.
1593 You can run several queue runners at once.
1595 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1596 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1597 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1598 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1599 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1604 .subsection "Temporary delivery failure" SECID20
1605 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1606 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1607 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1608 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1609 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1610 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1611 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1612 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1615 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1616 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1617 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1619 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1620 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1621 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1622 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1623 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1628 .subsection "Permanent delivery failure" SECID21
1629 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1630 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1631 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1632 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1633 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1634 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1635 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1636 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1637 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1638 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1640 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1641 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1642 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1645 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1646 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1647 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1648 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1649 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1650 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1651 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1656 .subsection "Failures to deliver bounce messages" SECID22
1657 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1658 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1659 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1660 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1661 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1662 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1663 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1669 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1672 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1673 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1675 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1676 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1677 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1678 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1681 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1682 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1684 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1685 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1686 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1687 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1691 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1692 following subdirectories are created:
1695 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1696 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1697 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1698 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1699 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1700 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1701 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1704 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1705 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1706 that may be useful to some sites.
1709 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1710 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1711 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1712 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1713 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1714 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1716 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1717 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1718 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1719 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1720 overridden if necessary.
1721 .cindex compiler requirements
1722 .cindex compiler version
1723 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1726 .section "PCRE2 library" "SECTpcre"
1727 .cindex "PCRE2 library"
1728 Exim no longer has an embedded regular-expression library as the vast majority of
1729 modern systems include PCRE2 as a system library, although you may need to
1730 install the PCRE2 package or the PCRE2 development package for your operating
1731 system. If your system has a normal PCRE2 installation the Exim build
1732 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1733 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE2_LIBS
1734 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1735 or set PCRE2_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1736 If your operating system has no
1737 PCRE2 support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE2
1738 from &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
1739 More information on PCRE2 is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1741 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1742 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1743 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1744 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1745 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1746 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1747 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1749 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1750 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1751 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1752 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1753 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1754 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1755 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1756 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1758 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1759 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1760 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1761 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1762 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1763 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1764 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1765 Berkeley DB library.
1767 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1768 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1772 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1773 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1775 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1776 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1777 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1778 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1779 filename is used unmodified.
1781 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1782 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1783 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1784 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1786 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1787 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1788 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1790 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1791 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1792 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while,
1793 but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 5.&'x'&.
1794 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased,
1795 and Exim no longer supports versions before 3.&'x'&.
1796 All versions of Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1797 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1798 page with far newer versions listed.
1799 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1800 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1801 suited to Exim's usage model.
1803 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1804 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1805 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1806 operates on a single file.
1808 It is possible to use sqlite3 (&url(https://www.sqlite.org/index.html))
1809 for the DBM library.
1813 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1814 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1815 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1816 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1817 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1821 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, for tdb you set USE_TDB,
1822 and for sqlite3 you set USE_SQLITE.
1823 An error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1824 You can set USE_NDBM if needed to override an operating system default.
1826 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1827 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1828 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1829 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1830 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1831 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1833 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1834 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1835 in one of these lines:
1840 DBMLIB = -lgdbm -lgdbm_compat
1842 The last of those was for a Linux having GDBM provide emulated NDBM facilities.
1843 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1844 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1845 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1846 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1849 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1850 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1852 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1853 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1857 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1858 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1859 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1860 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1861 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1862 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1863 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1864 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1865 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1866 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1867 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1868 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1870 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1871 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1872 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1873 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1874 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1875 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1877 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1878 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1879 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1880 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1881 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1882 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1885 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1886 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1887 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1888 facilities, you need to set
1890 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1892 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1893 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1896 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1897 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1898 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1899 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1900 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1901 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1902 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1904 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1905 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1906 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1907 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1908 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1913 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1914 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1916 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1917 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1918 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1919 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1920 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1921 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1922 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1924 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1925 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1926 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1927 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1928 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1932 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1936 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1937 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1938 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1939 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1940 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1941 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1942 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1943 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1944 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1947 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1948 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1951 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1955 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1957 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1960 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1963 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1966 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1967 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1969 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1970 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1973 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1975 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1976 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1979 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1981 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1982 library and include files. For example:
1985 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1986 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1988 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1989 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1992 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1995 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1996 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1997 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
2002 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
2004 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
2005 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
2006 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
2007 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
2008 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
2009 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
2010 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
2011 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
2012 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
2013 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
2014 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
2015 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
2018 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
2019 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
2020 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
2022 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
2023 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
2025 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
2027 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
2028 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
2029 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
2030 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
2031 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
2032 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
2036 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
2037 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
2038 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2039 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2040 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
2041 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2044 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2045 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2046 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2047 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2048 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2050 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2055 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2056 .cindex "lookup modules"
2057 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2058 .cindex ".so building"
2059 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2060 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2062 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2063 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2065 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2067 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2068 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2069 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2070 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2071 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2072 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2074 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2075 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2076 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2085 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2086 .cindex "build directory"
2087 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2088 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2089 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2090 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2091 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2092 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2093 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2095 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2096 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2097 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2098 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2099 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2100 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2101 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2102 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2104 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2105 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2106 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2110 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2111 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2112 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2113 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2114 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2115 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2116 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2120 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2121 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2122 given in addition to the short output.
2126 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2127 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2128 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2129 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2130 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2131 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2132 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2135 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2136 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2138 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2139 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2140 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2141 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2143 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2144 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2145 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2146 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2147 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2148 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2149 and are often not needed.
2151 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2152 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2153 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2154 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2155 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2156 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2157 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2158 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2159 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2162 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2163 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2164 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2165 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2169 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2170 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2171 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2172 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2173 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2174 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2175 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2176 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2177 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2178 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2179 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2180 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2181 containing the lines
2186 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2187 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2189 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2190 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2191 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2194 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2195 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2196 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2197 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2198 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2199 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2200 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2201 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2202 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2203 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2209 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2210 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2211 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2212 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2213 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2214 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2215 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2216 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2219 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2220 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2221 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2222 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2223 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2224 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2225 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2226 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2227 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2228 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2229 syntax. For instance:
2232 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2234 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2235 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2236 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2239 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2240 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2241 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2245 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2246 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2248 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2249 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2250 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2251 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2252 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2253 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2256 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2257 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2259 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2260 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2263 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2264 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2266 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2267 definition of all three of these variables into your
2268 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2271 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2272 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2273 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2274 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2276 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2277 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2278 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2279 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2280 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2283 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2284 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2285 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2286 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2287 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2290 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2292 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2293 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2294 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2295 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2296 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2297 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2301 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2302 .cindex "building Eximon"
2303 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2304 where the files that are involved are
2306 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2307 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2308 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2309 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2310 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2311 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2313 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2314 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2315 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2316 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2317 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2318 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2319 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2323 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2324 .cindex "installing Exim"
2325 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2326 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2327 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2328 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2329 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2330 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2331 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2332 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2333 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2334 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2335 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2336 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2338 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2339 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2340 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2341 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2342 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2343 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2344 alternative files, no default is installed.
2346 .cindex "system aliases file"
2347 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2348 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2349 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2350 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2351 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2352 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2353 and outputs a comment to the user.
2355 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2356 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2357 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2358 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2359 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2361 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2362 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2363 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2364 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2365 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2368 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2369 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2372 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2374 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2375 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2376 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2377 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2378 but this usage is deprecated.
2380 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2381 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2382 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2383 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2384 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2385 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2387 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2388 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2389 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2390 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2391 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2392 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2393 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2395 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2396 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2397 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2400 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2402 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2403 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2404 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2405 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2408 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2410 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2411 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2414 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2415 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2417 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2421 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2423 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2425 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2426 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2427 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2429 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2434 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2435 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2436 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2437 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2438 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2441 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2442 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2443 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2447 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2448 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2449 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2450 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2451 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2457 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2458 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2459 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2460 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2461 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2465 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2466 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2467 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2468 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2469 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2472 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2474 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2476 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2478 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2479 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2480 user agent. For example:
2482 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2483 From: user@your.domain.example
2484 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2485 Subject: Testing Exim
2487 This is a test message.
2490 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2491 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2492 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2494 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2495 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2496 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2497 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2498 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2499 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2501 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2503 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2504 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2505 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2506 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2507 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2509 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2510 .cindex "lock files"
2511 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2512 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2513 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2514 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2515 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2516 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2517 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2518 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2519 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2520 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2521 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2522 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2524 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2525 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2526 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2527 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2528 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2531 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2532 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2533 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2534 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2538 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2539 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2540 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2541 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2542 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2543 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2544 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2545 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2546 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2547 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2548 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2549 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2550 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2552 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2553 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2554 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2555 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2556 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2557 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2560 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2561 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2562 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2563 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2565 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2566 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2567 favourite user agent.
2569 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2570 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2571 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2572 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2573 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2574 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2578 .section "Running the daemon" SECTdaemonLaunch
2579 The most common command line for launching the Exim daemon looks like
2583 This starts a daemon which
2585 listens for incoming smtp connections, launching handler processes for
2588 starts a queue-runner process every five minutes, to inspect queued messages
2589 and run delivery attempts on any that have arrived at their retry time
2591 Should a queue run take longer than the time between queue-runner starts,
2592 they will run in parallel.
2593 Numbers of jobs of the various types are subject to policy controls
2594 defined in the configuration.
2597 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2598 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2599 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2600 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2601 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2602 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2603 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2604 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2605 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2606 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2612 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2613 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2614 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2616 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2618 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2619 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2620 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2621 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2622 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2624 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2626 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2628 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2629 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2630 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2635 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2636 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2638 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2639 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2640 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2641 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2642 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2643 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2644 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2645 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2646 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2649 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2651 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2652 were present before any other options.
2653 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2655 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2656 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2657 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2660 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2661 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2662 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2666 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2667 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2668 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2671 .cindex "queue runner"
2672 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2673 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2674 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2676 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2677 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2678 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2679 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2680 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2681 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2682 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2683 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2686 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2687 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2688 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2689 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2690 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2691 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2694 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2695 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2696 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2697 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2698 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2699 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2701 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2702 .cindex "envelope from"
2703 .cindex "envelope sender"
2704 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2705 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2706 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2707 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2708 users to set envelope senders.
2712 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2713 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2714 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2716 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2717 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2718 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2719 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2720 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2721 that are available to trusted users.
2723 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2724 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2725 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2726 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2727 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2729 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2730 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2731 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2732 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2734 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2735 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2736 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2737 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2739 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2740 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2745 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2746 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2747 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2753 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2754 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2755 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2756 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2757 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2758 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2759 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2760 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2762 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2763 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2764 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2765 . creates a man page for the options.
2766 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2769 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2775 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2776 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2777 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2778 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2781 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2782 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2786 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2793 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2796 .cmdopt -B <&'type'&>
2798 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2799 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2800 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2801 clean; it ignores this option.
2805 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2806 .cindex "queue runner"
2807 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2808 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2809 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2811 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2812 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2813 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2814 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2816 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2817 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2818 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2819 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2821 When a listening daemon
2822 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2823 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2824 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2825 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2826 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2827 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2830 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2831 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2832 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2836 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2837 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2838 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2839 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2840 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2841 .cindex reload configuration
2842 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2843 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2844 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2845 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2846 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2847 because these are reread each time they are used.
2849 Either a SIGTERM or a SIGINT signal should be used to cause the daemon
2850 to cleanly shut down.
2851 Subprocesses handling recceiving or delivering messages,
2852 or for scanning the queue,
2853 will not be affected by the termination of the daemon process.
2856 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2857 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2860 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2861 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2862 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2863 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2864 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2865 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2867 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2868 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2869 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2870 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2871 test data. A line history is supported.
2873 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2874 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2875 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2876 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2877 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2878 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2879 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2881 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2882 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2883 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2884 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2886 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2887 defined and macros will be expanded.
2888 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2889 available to admin users.
2891 The word &"set"& at the start of a line, followed by a single space,
2892 is recognised specially as defining a value for a variable.
2893 .cindex "tainted data" "expansion testing"
2894 If the sequence &",t"& is inserted before the space,
2895 the value is marked as tainted.
2896 The syntax is otherwise the same as the ACL modifier &"set ="&.
2898 .cmdopt -bem <&'filename'&>
2899 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2900 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2901 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2902 of a file. For example:
2904 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2906 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2907 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2908 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2909 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2910 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2911 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2912 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2915 .cmdopt -bF <&'filename'&>
2916 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2917 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2918 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2919 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2920 system filters are recognized.
2922 .cmdopt -bf <&'filename'&>
2923 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2924 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2925 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2926 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2927 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2928 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2929 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2930 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2933 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2934 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2935 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2937 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2939 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2940 variables that are used by the user filter.
2942 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2947 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2948 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2949 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2952 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2953 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2954 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2955 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2957 When testing a filter file,
2958 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2959 .cindex "envelope from"
2960 .cindex "envelope sender"
2961 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2962 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2963 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2964 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2965 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2968 .cmdopt -bfd <&'domain'&>
2969 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2970 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2971 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2974 .cmdopt -bfl <&'local&~part'&>
2975 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2976 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2977 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2978 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2979 actually being delivered.
2981 .cmdopt -bfp <&'prefix'&>
2982 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2983 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2984 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2987 .cmdopt -bfs <&'suffix'&>
2988 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2989 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2990 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2993 .cmdopt -bh <&'IP&~address'&>
2994 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2995 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2996 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2997 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2998 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2999 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
3000 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
3001 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
3002 after a full stop. For example:
3004 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
3005 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
3007 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
3008 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
3009 conversion to the canonical form is
3010 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
3012 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
3013 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
3014 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
3015 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
3016 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
3020 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
3021 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
3022 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
3025 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
3026 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
3027 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
3029 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
3030 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
3031 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
3032 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
3033 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
3034 session were authenticated.
3036 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
3037 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
3038 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
3040 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
3041 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
3042 specialized SMTP test program such as
3043 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
3045 .cmdopt -bhc <&'IP&~address'&>
3046 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
3047 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
3048 updating the callout cache database.
3051 .cindex "alias file" "building"
3052 .cindex "building alias file"
3053 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
3054 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
3055 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
3056 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3057 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3060 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3061 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3062 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3063 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3064 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3065 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3068 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3070 .cindex "querying exim information"
3071 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3072 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3073 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3074 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3075 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3078 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3079 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3080 recognised DSCP names.
3083 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3084 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3085 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3086 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3087 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3088 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3089 way to guarantee a correct response.
3092 .cindex "local message reception"
3093 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3094 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3095 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3096 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3097 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3098 if no other conflicting option is present.
3100 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3101 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3102 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3103 suppressing this for special cases.
3105 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3106 the non-SMTP ACL. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for details.
3108 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3109 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3110 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3113 .cindex "message" "format"
3114 .cindex "format" "message"
3115 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3116 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3117 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3118 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3119 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3121 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3122 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3124 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3125 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3126 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3127 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3128 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3130 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3131 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3132 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3133 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3134 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3136 .cmdopt -bmalware <&'filename'&>
3137 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3138 .cindex "malware scan test"
3139 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3140 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3141 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3142 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3143 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3144 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3145 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3147 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3148 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3149 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3150 This option requires admin privileges.
3152 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3153 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3154 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3157 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3158 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3159 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3160 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3161 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3162 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3163 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3165 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3166 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3167 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3168 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3169 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3171 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3172 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3173 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3174 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3178 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3179 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3180 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3181 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3182 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3183 arguments, for example:
3185 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3187 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3188 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3189 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3190 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3191 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3192 users, the output is as in this example:
3194 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3196 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3197 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3199 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3200 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3201 backward compatibility.)
3202 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3203 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3205 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3206 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3207 name will not be output.
3209 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3210 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3211 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3212 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3213 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3214 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3215 written directly into the spool directory.
3217 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3219 exim -bP +local_domains
3221 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3222 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3224 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3225 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3226 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3227 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3228 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3229 that driver are output. For example:
3231 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3233 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3234 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3235 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3236 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3237 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3240 .cindex "environment"
3241 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3242 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3245 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3246 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3247 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3248 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3249 The output format is one item per line.
3250 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3251 the exit status will be nonzero.
3254 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3255 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3256 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3257 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3258 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3259 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3260 to allow any user to see the queue.
3262 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3264 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3265 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3268 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3269 .cindex "size" "of message"
3270 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3271 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3272 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3273 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3274 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3275 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3276 before the sender address.
3278 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3279 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3280 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3282 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3283 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3284 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3285 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3286 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3291 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3292 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3293 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3298 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3299 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3300 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3301 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3305 .cindex queue "list of message IDs"
3306 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but only outputs message ids
3311 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3312 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3313 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3314 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3317 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3320 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpi%&.
3323 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3327 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3328 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3329 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3330 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3334 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3335 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3336 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3337 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3338 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3340 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3341 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3343 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3344 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3345 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3346 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3347 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3348 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3349 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3350 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3351 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3353 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3354 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3358 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3359 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3360 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3361 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3362 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3363 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3364 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3367 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3368 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3369 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3370 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3371 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3372 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3373 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3374 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3375 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3377 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3378 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3379 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3381 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3382 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see section &<<SECnonSMTP>>&).
3383 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3384 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3386 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3387 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3388 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3390 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3391 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3392 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3393 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3394 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3396 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3397 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3400 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3401 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3402 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3403 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3404 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3405 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3406 messages to the MTA.
3409 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3410 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3411 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3412 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3413 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3414 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3415 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3419 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3420 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3421 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3422 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3423 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3424 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3425 the listening daemon.
3428 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3429 .cindex "address" "testing"
3430 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3431 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3432 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3433 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3434 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3436 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3437 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3439 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3440 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3443 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3444 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3445 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3446 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3447 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3450 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3451 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3452 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3453 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3455 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3456 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3457 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3458 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3461 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3462 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3464 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3465 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3466 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3467 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3468 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3469 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3473 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3474 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3475 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3476 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3477 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3478 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3480 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3481 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3482 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3483 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3484 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3485 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3486 dynamic testing facilities.
3489 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3490 .cindex "address" "verification"
3491 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3492 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3493 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3494 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3495 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3496 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3498 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3499 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3500 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3502 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3503 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3505 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3506 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3509 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3510 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3511 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3512 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3513 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3515 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3516 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3517 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3518 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3519 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3520 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3523 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3524 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3525 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3528 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3529 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3530 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3531 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3533 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3534 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3535 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3536 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3539 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3540 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3546 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3547 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3548 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3549 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3551 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3552 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3553 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3554 each port only when the first connection is received.
3556 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3557 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3559 .cmdopt -C <&'filelist'&>
3560 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3561 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3562 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3563 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3564 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3565 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3566 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3567 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3568 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3570 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3571 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3572 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3573 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3574 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3575 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3576 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3577 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3578 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3580 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3581 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3582 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3583 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3584 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3585 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3586 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3588 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3589 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3590 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3591 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3592 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3593 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3594 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3596 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3597 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3598 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3601 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3602 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3603 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3604 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3605 specified by this option.
3608 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3610 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3611 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3612 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3613 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3614 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3615 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3617 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3618 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3619 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3620 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3621 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3622 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3623 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3625 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3626 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3627 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3633 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3634 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3637 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3639 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3640 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3643 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3645 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3646 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3647 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3648 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3649 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3650 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3651 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3654 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3655 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3656 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3657 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3658 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3659 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3660 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3662 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
3663 .irow acl "ACL interpretation"
3664 .irow auth "authenticators"
3665 .irow deliver "general delivery logic"
3666 .irow dns "DNS lookups (see also resolver)"
3667 .irow dnsbl "DNS black list (aka RBL) code"
3668 .irow exec "arguments for &[execv()]& calls"
3669 .irow expand "detailed debugging for string expansions"
3670 .irow filter "filter handling"
3671 .irow hints_lookup "hints data lookups"
3672 .irow host_lookup "all types of name-to-IP address handling"
3673 .irow ident "ident lookup"
3674 .irow interface "lists of local interfaces"
3675 .irow lists "matching things in lists"
3676 .irow load "system load checks"
3677 .irow local_scan "can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3678 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)"
3679 .irow lookup "general lookup code and all lookups"
3680 .irow memory "memory handling"
3681 .irow noutf8 "modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing"
3682 .irow pid "modifier: add pid to debug output lines"
3683 .irow process_info "setting info for the process log"
3684 .irow queue_run "queue runs"
3685 .irow receive "general message reception logic"
3686 .irow resolver "turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output"
3687 .irow retry "retry handling"
3688 .irow rewrite "address rewriting""
3689 .irow route "address routing"
3690 .irow timestamp "modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines"
3691 .irow tls "TLS logic"
3692 .irow transport "transports"
3693 .irow uid "changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid"
3694 .irow verify "address verification logic"
3695 .irow all "almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&"
3697 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3698 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3699 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3700 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3701 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3702 turn everything off.
3704 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3705 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3706 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3707 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3708 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3711 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3712 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3713 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3714 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3715 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3718 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3719 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3722 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3723 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3724 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3725 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3726 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3727 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3729 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3730 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3732 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3734 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3735 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3736 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3737 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3740 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3741 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3742 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3745 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3746 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3747 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3748 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3749 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3750 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3751 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3752 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3755 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3756 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3757 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3758 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3759 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3761 .cmdopt -F <&'string'&>
3762 .cindex "sender" "name"
3763 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3764 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3765 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3766 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3767 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3768 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3770 .cmdopt -f <&'address'&>
3771 .cindex "sender" "address"
3772 .cindex "address" "sender"
3773 .cindex "trusted users"
3774 .cindex "envelope from"
3775 .cindex "envelope sender"
3776 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3777 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3778 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3779 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3782 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3783 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3784 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3785 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3788 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3789 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3790 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3791 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3792 examples of shell commands:
3794 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3795 exim -f "" user@domain
3797 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3798 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3801 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3802 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3803 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3804 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3807 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3808 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3809 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3810 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3811 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3812 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3815 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3816 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3818 control = suppress_local_fixups
3820 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3821 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3824 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3827 .cmdopt -h <&'number'&>
3828 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3829 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3830 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3834 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3835 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3836 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3837 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
3838 Solaris 2.4 (SunOS 5.4) Sendmail has a similar &%-i%& processing option
3839 &url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf),
3840 p. 1M-529), and therefore a &%-oi%& command line option, which both are used
3841 by its &'mailx'& command.
3843 .cmdopt -L <&'tag'&>
3844 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3845 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3846 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3847 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3848 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3849 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3851 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3853 .cmdopt -M <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3854 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3855 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3856 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3857 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3858 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3859 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3860 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3863 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3864 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3865 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3866 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3867 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3868 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3870 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3871 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3872 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3873 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3875 .cmdopt -Mar <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3876 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3877 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3878 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3879 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3880 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3881 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3882 can be used only by an admin user.
3884 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&&&
3886 &~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3887 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3889 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3890 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3891 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3892 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3893 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3894 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3895 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3896 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3899 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3900 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3901 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3904 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3905 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3906 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3909 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3910 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3911 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3913 .cmdopt -MCG <&'queue&~name'&>
3914 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3915 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3916 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3919 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3920 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3921 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3924 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3925 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3926 which Exim is connected advertised limits on numbers of mails, recipients or
3928 The limits are given by the following three arguments.
3931 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3932 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3933 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3936 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3937 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the connection
3938 t a remote server is via a SOCKS proxy, using addresses and ports given by
3939 the following four arguments.
3941 .cmdopt -MCQ <&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3942 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3943 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3944 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3945 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3946 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3947 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3949 .cmdopt -MCq <&'recipient&~address'&>&~<&'size'&>
3950 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3951 by Exim to implement quota checking for local users.
3954 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3955 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3956 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3960 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3961 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3962 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3964 .vitem &%-MCr%&&~<&'SNI'&> &&&
3968 These options are not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3969 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MCt%& option, and passes on the fact that
3970 a TLS Server Name Indication was sent as part of the channel establishment.
3971 The argument gives the SNI string.
3972 The "r" variant indicates a DANE-verified connection.
3974 .cmdopt -MCt <&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3975 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3976 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3977 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3978 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3980 .cmdopt -Mc <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3981 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3982 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3983 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3984 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3985 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3986 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3987 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3988 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3989 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3990 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3991 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3992 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3993 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3995 .cmdopt -Mes <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3996 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3997 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3998 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3999 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
4000 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
4001 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
4002 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
4003 This option can be used only by an admin user.
4005 .cmdopt -Mf <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4006 .cindex "freezing messages"
4007 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
4008 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
4009 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
4010 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
4011 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
4012 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
4015 .cmdopt -Mg <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4016 .cindex "giving up on messages"
4017 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
4018 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
4019 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
4020 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
4021 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
4022 is sent to the sender.
4023 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
4026 .cmdopt -MG <&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4028 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
4029 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
4030 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
4031 queue to the given named queue.
4032 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
4033 string to define the default queue.
4034 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
4035 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
4037 .cmdopt -Mmad <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4038 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
4039 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
4040 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
4041 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
4042 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4044 .cmdopt -Mmd <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4045 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4046 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
4047 .cindex "removing recipients"
4048 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4049 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4050 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4051 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4052 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4053 can be used only by an admin user.
4055 .cmdopt -Mrm <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4056 .cindex "removing messages"
4057 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4058 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4059 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4060 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4061 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4062 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4063 placed in the queue.
4068 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4069 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4070 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4074 .cmdopt -Mset <&'message&~id'&>
4075 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4076 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4077 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4078 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4079 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4080 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4081 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4082 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4083 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4085 .cmdopt -Mt <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4086 .cindex "thawing messages"
4087 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4088 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4089 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4090 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4091 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4092 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4095 .cmdopt -Mvb <&'message&~id'&>
4096 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4097 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4098 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4099 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4101 .cmdopt -Mvc <&'message&~id'&>
4102 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4103 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4104 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4105 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4106 only by an admin user.
4108 .cmdopt -Mvh <&'message&~id'&>
4109 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4110 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4111 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4112 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4113 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4115 .cmdopt -Mvl <&'message&~id'&>
4116 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4117 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4118 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4119 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4122 This is a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail
4123 (&url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf)
4124 p. 1M-258), so Exim treats it that way too.
4127 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4128 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4129 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4130 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4131 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4132 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4133 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4136 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4137 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4138 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4139 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4140 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4141 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4142 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4146 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4147 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4148 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4149 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4151 .cmdopt -O <&'data'&>
4152 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4155 .cmdopt -oA <&'file&~name'&>
4156 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4157 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4158 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4162 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4163 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4164 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4165 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4166 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4167 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4170 .cindex "background delivery"
4171 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4172 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4173 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4174 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4175 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4176 processes to finish.
4178 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4179 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4180 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4181 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4183 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4184 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4185 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4186 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4189 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4190 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4191 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4192 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4193 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4194 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4196 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4197 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4200 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4201 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4203 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4204 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4205 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4206 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4210 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4214 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4215 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4216 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4217 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4218 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4219 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4220 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4221 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4222 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4223 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4227 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4228 .cindex "first pass routing"
4229 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4230 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4231 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4232 configuration file is in effect.
4234 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4235 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4236 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4237 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4238 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4239 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4240 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4241 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4242 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4246 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4247 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4248 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4251 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4253 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4254 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4255 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4256 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4259 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4260 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4261 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4262 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4263 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4266 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4267 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4268 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4269 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4270 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4273 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4274 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4278 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4279 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4283 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4284 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4285 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4286 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4287 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4288 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4291 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4293 .cmdopt -oMa <&'host&~address'&>
4294 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4295 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4296 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4297 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4298 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4299 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4301 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4302 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4304 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4306 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4307 followed by a colon and the port number:
4309 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4311 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4312 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4313 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4314 whichever one is last.
4316 .cmdopt -oMaa <&'name'&>
4317 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4318 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4319 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4320 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4321 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4322 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4324 .cmdopt -oMai <&'string'&>
4325 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4326 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4327 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4328 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4329 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4330 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4332 .cmdopt -oMas <&'address'&>
4333 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4334 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4335 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4336 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4337 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4338 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4339 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4340 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4342 .cmdopt -oMi <&'interface&~address'&>
4343 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4344 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4345 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4346 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4347 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4349 .cmdopt -oMm <&'message&~reference'&>
4350 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4351 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4352 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4353 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4354 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4355 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4356 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4358 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4359 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4360 is sending the bounce.
4362 .cmdopt -oMr <&'protocol&~name'&>
4363 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4364 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4365 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4366 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4367 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4368 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4369 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4370 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4371 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4372 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4374 .cmdopt -oMs <&'host&~name'&>
4375 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4376 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4377 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4378 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4379 uses the name it is given.
4381 .cmdopt -oMt <&'ident&~string'&>
4382 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4383 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4384 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4385 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4386 used, when there is no default.
4389 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4390 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4391 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4392 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4395 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4396 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4397 whatever that means.
4399 .cmdopt -oP <&'path'&>
4400 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4401 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4402 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4403 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4404 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4405 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4406 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4409 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4410 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4411 This option is not intended for general use.
4412 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4413 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4414 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4416 .cmdopt -or <&'time'&>
4417 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4418 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4419 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4420 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4421 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4423 .cmdopt -os <&'time'&>
4424 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4425 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4426 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4427 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4428 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4429 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4432 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4434 .cmdopt -oX <&'number&~or&~string'&>
4435 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4436 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4437 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4438 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4439 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4440 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4441 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4442 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4445 .cindex "daemon notifier socket"
4446 This option controls the creation of an inter-process communications endpoint
4448 It is only relevant when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option is also
4450 Normally the daemon creates this socket, unless a &%-oX%& and &*no*& &%-oP%&
4451 option is also present.
4452 If this option is given then the socket will not be created. This is required
4453 if the system is running multiple daemons, in which case it should
4455 The features supported by the socket will not be available in such cases.
4457 The socket is currently used for
4459 fast ramp-up of queue runner processes
4461 caching compiled regexes
4463 obtaining a current queue size
4467 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4468 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4469 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4470 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4474 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4475 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4476 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4477 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4480 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4482 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4484 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4486 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4487 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4488 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4489 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4490 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4491 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4494 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4495 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4496 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4497 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4498 and &%-S%& options).
4500 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4501 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4502 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4503 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4504 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4505 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4506 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4509 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4510 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4511 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4512 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4513 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4516 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4517 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4518 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4519 this to be repeated periodically.
4521 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4522 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4523 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4524 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4526 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4527 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4528 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4530 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4531 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4532 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4533 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4537 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4538 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4539 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4540 .cindex "first pass routing"
4541 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
4542 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4543 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4544 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4547 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4549 the &%queue_fast_ramp%& option is true
4550 and a daemon-notifier socket is available
4551 then in the first phase of the run,
4552 once a threshold number of messages are routed for a given host,
4553 a delivery process is forked in parallel with the rest of the scan.
4555 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4556 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4557 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred.
4559 After the first queue scan complete,
4560 a second, normal queue scan is done, with routing and delivery taking
4562 Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4563 delivered down a single SMTP
4564 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4565 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4566 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4567 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4569 Two-phase queue runs should be used on systems which, even intermittently,
4570 have a large queue (such as mailing-list operators).
4571 They may also be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4574 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4576 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4577 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4578 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4579 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4580 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4582 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4584 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4585 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4586 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4587 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4588 their retry times are tried.
4590 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4592 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4593 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4596 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4598 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4599 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4600 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4603 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4606 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4607 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4608 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4609 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4610 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4611 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4612 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4614 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4615 will specify a queue to operate on.
4618 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4620 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4623 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4624 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4625 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4626 starting message id. For example:
4628 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4630 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4631 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4632 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4634 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4636 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4637 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4638 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4639 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4640 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4641 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4643 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4644 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4645 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4646 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4647 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4648 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4649 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4650 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4651 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4653 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4655 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4656 process every 30 minutes.
4658 .cindex "named queues" "queue runners"
4659 It is possible to set up runners for multiple named queues within one daemon,
4662 exim -qGhipri/2m -q10m -qqGmailinglist/1h
4665 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4666 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4668 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4670 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4673 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4675 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4677 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4679 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4680 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4681 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4682 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4683 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4684 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4685 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4687 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4688 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4689 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4690 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4691 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4692 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4694 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4695 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4697 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4699 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4700 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4701 applied to each queue run.
4703 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4704 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4705 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4706 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4707 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4708 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4709 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4710 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4711 address will be skipped.
4713 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4714 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4715 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4718 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4719 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4720 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&), its default
4721 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4722 an arbitrary command instead.
4725 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4727 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4729 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4730 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4731 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4732 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4733 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4734 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4736 .cmdopt -Tqt <&'times'&>
4737 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4738 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4739 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4742 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4746 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4747 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4748 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4749 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4750 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4752 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4753 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4754 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4755 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4756 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4757 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4758 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4759 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4760 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4761 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4762 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4764 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4765 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4766 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4767 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4768 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4769 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4771 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4772 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4773 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4774 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4775 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4776 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4777 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4778 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4779 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4782 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4783 compatibility with Sendmail.
4785 .cmdopt -tls-on-connect
4786 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4787 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4788 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4789 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4790 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4791 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4795 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4796 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4797 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4798 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4799 set. Exim ignores this option.
4802 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4803 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4804 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4805 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4806 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4807 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4811 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4812 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4813 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4816 .cmdopt -X <&'logfile'&>
4817 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4818 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4820 .cmdopt -z <&'log-line'&>
4821 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4822 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4823 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4831 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4832 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4833 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4834 . creates a man page for the options.
4835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4838 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4845 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4846 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4849 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4850 "The runtime configuration file"
4852 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4853 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4854 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4855 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4856 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4857 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4858 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4859 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4860 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4863 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4864 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4865 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4866 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4867 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4868 actually alter the string.
4870 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4871 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4872 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4873 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4874 existing file in the list.
4877 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4878 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4879 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4880 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4881 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4882 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4883 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4884 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4885 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4886 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4888 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4889 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4890 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4891 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4892 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4894 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4895 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4896 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4897 compromise the Exim user account.
4899 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4900 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4901 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4902 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4903 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4904 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4909 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4910 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4911 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4912 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4913 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4914 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4915 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4916 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4917 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4918 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4919 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4921 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4922 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4923 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4924 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4925 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4926 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4927 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4928 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4929 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4932 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4933 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4934 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4935 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4936 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4938 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4939 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4940 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4941 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4942 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4943 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4945 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4946 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4947 necessarily be discarded.
4948 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4949 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4950 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4951 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4952 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4953 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4955 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4956 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4957 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4958 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4959 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4960 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4961 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4963 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4964 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4965 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4969 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4970 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4971 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4972 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4973 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4974 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4975 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4976 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4979 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4982 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4983 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4984 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4986 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4987 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4988 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4990 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4991 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4992 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4994 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4995 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4996 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4997 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
5000 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
5001 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
5002 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
5004 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
5005 want to use this feature, you must set
5007 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
5009 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
5010 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
5013 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
5014 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
5015 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
5016 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
5018 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
5019 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
5020 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
5021 and does not introduce a comment.
5023 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
5024 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
5025 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
5026 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
5027 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5029 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5030 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5031 change settings as required.
5033 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5034 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5035 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5036 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5037 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5042 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5043 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5044 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5045 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5046 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5047 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5050 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5051 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5053 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5054 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5055 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5056 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5057 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5060 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5061 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5062 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5063 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5065 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5066 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5069 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5072 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5073 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5078 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5079 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5080 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5081 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5082 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5083 definition, and must be of the form
5085 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5087 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5088 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5089 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5090 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5091 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5093 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5094 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5095 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5097 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5098 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5099 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5100 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5101 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5102 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5103 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5106 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5107 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5109 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5110 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5111 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5112 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5113 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5114 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5117 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5118 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5119 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5124 MAC == updated value
5126 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5127 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5128 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5129 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5133 MAC == MAC and something added
5135 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5136 from a number of other files.
5138 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5139 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5140 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5141 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5142 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5147 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5148 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5149 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5150 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5152 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5153 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5155 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5157 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5159 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5160 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5161 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5164 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5165 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5166 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5167 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5168 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5171 The following classes of macros are defined:
5173 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5174 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5175 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5176 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5177 &` _EXP_COND_* `& expansion conditions
5178 &` _EXP_ITEM_* `& expansion items
5179 &` _EXP_OP_* `& expansion operators
5180 &` _EXP_VAR_* `& expansion variables
5181 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5182 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5183 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5184 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5185 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5186 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5187 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5188 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5191 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5194 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5195 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5196 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5197 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5198 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5199 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5200 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5202 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5203 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5204 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5208 message_size_limit = 50M
5210 message_size_limit = 100M
5213 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5214 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5215 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5216 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5217 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5219 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5220 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5221 in this line"& will always be true.
5223 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5224 to clarify complicated nestings.
5228 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5229 .cindex "common option syntax"
5230 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5231 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5232 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5233 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5234 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5235 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5236 space) and then the value. For example:
5238 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5240 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5241 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5242 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5243 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5244 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5245 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5246 word &"hide"&. For example:
5248 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5250 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5252 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5254 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5255 all instances of the same driver.
5257 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5258 that are found in option settings.
5261 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5262 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5263 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5264 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5265 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5266 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5267 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5268 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5269 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5270 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5271 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5272 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5277 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5282 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5287 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5288 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5289 .cindex "format" "integer"
5290 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5291 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5292 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5293 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5296 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5297 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5298 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5300 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5301 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5302 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5306 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5307 .cindex "integer format"
5308 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5309 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5310 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5311 Such options are always output in octal.
5314 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5315 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5316 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5317 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5318 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5322 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5323 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5324 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5325 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5326 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5336 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5337 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5338 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5342 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5343 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5344 .cindex "format" "string"
5345 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5346 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5347 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5348 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5349 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5350 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5351 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5352 therefore equivalent:
5354 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5355 trusted_users = uucp:\
5356 # This comment line is ignored
5359 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5360 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5361 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5362 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5363 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5366 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5367 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5368 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5370 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5371 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5375 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5376 character, that character replaces the pair.
5378 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5379 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5380 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5381 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5382 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5383 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5386 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5387 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5388 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5389 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5390 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5391 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5392 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5393 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5394 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5395 within a quoted configuration string.
5398 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5399 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5400 .cindex "format" "user name"
5401 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5402 .cindex "format" "group name"
5403 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5404 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5405 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5406 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5409 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5410 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5411 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5412 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5413 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5414 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5415 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5416 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5417 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5418 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5419 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5421 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5422 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5423 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5424 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5425 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5426 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5429 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5431 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5433 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5434 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The spaces around the first
5435 colon in the example above are necessary. If they were not there, the list would
5436 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5438 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5439 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5440 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5441 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5442 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5443 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5444 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5445 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5447 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5449 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5450 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5451 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5453 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5454 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5455 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5456 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5457 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5458 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5459 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5460 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5461 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5463 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5465 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5466 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5467 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5468 the value in quotes. For example:
5470 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5472 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5473 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5474 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5475 enclosing an empty list item.
5479 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5480 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5481 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5482 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5484 senders = user@domain :
5486 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5487 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5488 items, the second of which is empty:
5490 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5492 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5493 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5494 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5495 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5499 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5500 is at the end of the list.
5505 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5506 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5507 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5508 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5509 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5510 a sequence of lines like this:
5512 <&'instance name'&>:
5517 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5518 followed by three options settings:
5523 transport = local_delivery
5525 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5526 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5527 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5528 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5529 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5530 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5532 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5533 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5535 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5536 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5537 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5538 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5539 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5542 .cindex "generic options"
5543 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5544 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5545 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5546 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5547 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5548 .cindex "private options"
5549 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5550 they all have default values.
5552 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5553 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5554 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5556 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5557 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5558 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5559 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5560 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5561 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5562 configuration lines:
5567 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5568 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5569 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5570 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5576 command_timeout = 10s
5578 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5579 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5582 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5583 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5584 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5592 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5593 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5595 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5596 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5597 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5598 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5599 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5600 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5601 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5602 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5603 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5604 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5605 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5609 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5610 All macros should be defined before any options.
5612 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5614 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5616 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5617 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5618 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5619 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5621 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5622 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5623 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5626 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5627 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5628 in the file, after the macros.
5629 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5631 # primary_hostname =
5633 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5634 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5635 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5636 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5638 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5640 domainlist local_domains = @
5641 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5642 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5644 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5645 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5646 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5647 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5649 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5650 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5653 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5654 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5655 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5656 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5657 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5658 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5660 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5661 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5662 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5663 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5664 domain is permitted.
5666 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5667 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5668 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5669 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5670 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5671 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5673 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5674 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5675 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5677 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5679 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5680 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5682 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5683 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5684 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5685 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5686 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5687 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5688 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5689 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5690 contents of a message to be checked.
5692 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5694 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5695 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5697 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5698 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5699 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5700 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5702 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5704 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5705 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5706 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5708 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5709 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5710 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5711 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5712 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5713 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5714 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5716 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5718 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5719 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5721 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5722 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5723 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5724 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5725 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5726 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5727 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5728 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5729 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5730 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5731 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5732 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5733 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5734 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5735 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5736 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5738 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5739 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5740 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5741 which should be used in preference to 587.
5742 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5744 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5746 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5749 # qualify_recipient =
5751 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5752 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5753 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5754 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5755 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5756 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5758 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5759 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5760 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5761 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5763 # allow_domain_literals
5765 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5766 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5767 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5768 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5769 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5770 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5772 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5776 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5777 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5778 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5779 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5780 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5781 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5782 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5783 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5785 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5786 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5791 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5792 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5793 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5794 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5795 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5796 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5799 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5800 1413 (hence their names):
5803 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5805 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5806 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5807 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5808 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5809 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5810 information, you can change this.
5812 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5813 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5818 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5819 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5820 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5821 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5823 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5824 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5826 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5827 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5829 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5832 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5833 +tls_certificate_verified
5836 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5838 # percent_hack_domains =
5840 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5841 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5842 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5844 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5845 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5846 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5847 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5848 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5849 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5850 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5851 always bounce messages.
5853 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5854 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5856 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5857 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5858 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5859 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5860 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5862 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5863 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5864 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5865 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5866 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5869 # split_spool_directory = true
5872 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5873 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5874 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5875 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5876 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5877 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5878 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5880 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5883 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5884 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5885 that are not 8-bit clean.
5887 # accept_8bitmime = false
5890 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5891 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5892 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5893 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5894 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the &%timezone%& runtime
5895 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5897 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5898 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5902 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5903 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5904 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5905 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5906 It starts with the line
5910 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5911 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5912 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5914 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5915 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5916 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5917 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5918 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5919 result of the ACL processing.
5923 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5928 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5929 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5930 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5931 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5932 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5933 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5935 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5936 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5937 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5940 deny domains = +local_domains
5941 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5942 message = Restricted characters in address
5944 deny domains = !+local_domains
5945 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5946 message = Restricted characters in address
5948 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5949 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5950 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5951 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5952 in Internet mail addresses.
5954 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5955 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5956 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5957 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5958 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5959 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5960 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5961 policy of being as safe as possible.
5963 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5964 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5965 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5966 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5967 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5968 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5970 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5971 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5972 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5973 have to modify this rule.
5975 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5976 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5977 common convention of local parts constructed as
5978 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5979 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5980 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5981 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5982 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5983 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5985 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5986 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5987 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5988 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5989 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5990 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5991 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5993 accept local_parts = postmaster
5994 domains = +local_domains
5996 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5997 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5998 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5999 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6000 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6002 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
6003 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
6004 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
6006 require verify = sender
6008 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
6009 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
6010 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
6011 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
6012 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
6013 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
6014 discusses the details of address verification.
6016 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
6017 control = submission
6019 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
6020 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
6021 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
6022 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
6023 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
6024 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
6025 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
6026 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
6027 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
6029 accept authenticated = *
6030 control = submission
6032 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6033 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6034 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6035 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6036 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6037 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6039 require message = relay not permitted
6040 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6042 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6043 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6045 require verify = recipient
6047 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6048 fails, the address is rejected.
6050 # deny dnslists = black.list.example
6051 # message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6052 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6055 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6056 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6057 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6058 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6060 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6061 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6062 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6065 # require verify = csa
6067 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6068 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6073 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6074 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6078 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6079 of this ACL are commented out:
6082 # message = This message contains a virus \
6085 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6086 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6087 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6088 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6090 # warn spam = nobody
6091 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6092 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6093 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6094 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6096 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6097 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6098 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6099 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6100 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6101 whatever the spam score.
6105 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6108 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6109 .cindex "default" "routers"
6110 .cindex "routers" "default"
6111 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6116 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6117 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6118 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6119 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6120 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6123 # driver = ipliteral
6124 # domains = !+local_domains
6125 # transport = remote_smtp
6127 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6128 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6129 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6130 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6131 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6133 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6134 macro has been defined, per
6136 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6145 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6146 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6147 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6148 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6152 driver = manualroute
6153 domains = ! +local_domains
6154 transport = smarthost_smtp
6155 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6156 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6159 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6160 specified by the line
6162 domains = ! +local_domains
6164 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6165 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6166 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6167 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6168 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6169 passed on to the following routers.
6171 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6172 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6173 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6174 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6176 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6177 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6178 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6179 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6180 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6181 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6182 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6187 domains = ! +local_domains
6188 transport = remote_smtp
6189 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6192 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6194 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6195 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6196 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6197 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6198 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6200 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6201 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6202 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6203 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6204 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6205 the address fails and is bounced.
6207 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6208 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6209 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6210 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6211 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6212 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6213 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6220 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6222 file_transport = address_file
6223 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6225 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6226 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6227 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6228 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6229 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6232 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6233 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6234 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6235 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6240 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6241 # local_part_suffix_optional
6242 file = $home/.forward
6247 file_transport = address_file
6248 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6249 reply_transport = address_reply
6251 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6252 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6253 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6254 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6255 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6258 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6259 # local_part_suffix_optional
6261 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6262 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6263 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6264 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6265 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6266 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6267 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6269 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6270 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6271 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6272 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6274 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6275 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6276 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6277 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6278 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6279 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6280 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6282 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6283 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6284 There are two reasons for doing this:
6287 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6288 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6291 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6292 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6293 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6294 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6298 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6299 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6300 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6301 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6303 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6304 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6305 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6307 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6309 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6315 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6316 # local_part_suffix_optional
6317 transport = local_delivery
6319 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6320 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6321 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6322 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6323 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6326 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6327 .cindex "default" "transports"
6328 .cindex "transports" "default"
6329 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6330 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6331 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6335 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6339 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6344 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6345 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6346 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6347 with over-long lines.
6349 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6350 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6351 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6352 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6354 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6355 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6356 usual federated system.
6361 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6365 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6366 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6367 hosts_require_tls = *
6368 tls_verify_hosts = *
6369 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this this will have no effect,
6370 # but if you have to comment it out then this will at least log whether
6371 # you succeed or not:
6372 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6374 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6375 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6376 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6377 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6378 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6379 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6381 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6382 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6385 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6392 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6393 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6394 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6395 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6396 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6397 then no other options are defined.
6398 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6399 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6400 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6401 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6402 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6403 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6404 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6405 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6406 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6407 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6408 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6410 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6412 All other options are defaulted.
6416 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6423 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6424 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6426 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6427 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6428 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6429 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6430 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6432 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6433 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6434 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6435 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6436 show how this can be done.
6438 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6439 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6440 similarly-named options above.
6446 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6447 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6448 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6449 be returned to the sender.
6457 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6458 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6459 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6464 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6469 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6470 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6471 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6472 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6473 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6474 introduced by the line
6478 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6481 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6483 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6484 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6485 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6486 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6487 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6489 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6490 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6491 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6494 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6495 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6499 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6500 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6504 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6505 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6506 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6508 begin authenticators
6510 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6511 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6512 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6513 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6514 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6515 to support most MUA software.
6517 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6520 # driver = plaintext
6521 # server_set_id = $auth2
6522 # server_prompts = :
6523 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6524 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6526 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6529 # driver = plaintext
6530 # server_set_id = $auth1
6531 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6532 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6533 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6536 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6537 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6538 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6539 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6540 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6541 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6542 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6543 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6545 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6546 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6547 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6548 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6550 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6551 usercode and password are in different positions.
6552 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6554 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6561 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6563 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6565 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6566 uses the PCRE2 regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6567 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6568 regular expressions is discussed in
6569 online Perl manpages, in
6570 many Perl reference books, and also in
6571 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6572 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6573 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6574 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6575 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6577 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6578 are supported by PCRE2 is included in the PCRE2 distribution, and no further
6579 description is included here. The PCRE2 functions are called from Exim using
6580 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE2 options set), except that
6581 the PCRE2_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6584 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6585 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6586 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6587 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6589 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6591 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6592 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6593 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6594 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6595 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6596 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6599 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6600 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6601 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6602 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6603 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6604 match anywhere in the subject string.
6606 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6607 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6609 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6611 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6614 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6616 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6617 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6621 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6622 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6624 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6625 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6626 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6627 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6628 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6629 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6632 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6633 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6634 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6635 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6636 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6637 The key for the lookup is &*specified*& as part of the string to be expanded.
6639 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6640 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6641 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6642 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6643 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6644 Depending on the lookup type (see below)
6645 the key for the lookup may need to be &*specified*& as above
6646 or may be &*implicit*&,
6647 given by the context in which the list is being checked.
6650 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6651 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6652 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6653 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6654 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6655 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6657 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6658 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6659 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6660 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6661 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6663 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6664 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6667 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6668 The key for an expansion-style lookup must be given explicitly.
6669 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6670 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6671 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6672 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6674 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6675 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6677 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6678 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6679 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6680 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a lookup expansion"
6681 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6684 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6685 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6687 The file could contains lines like this:
6692 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6693 matches the list item.
6695 The key for a list-style lookup is implicit, from the lookup context, if
6696 the lookup is a single-key type (see below).
6697 For query-style lookup types the query must be given explicitly.
6700 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6701 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6703 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6705 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6706 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6707 causes a second lookup to occur.
6709 The lookup type may optionally be followed by a comma
6710 and a comma-separated list of options.
6711 Each option is a &"name=value"& pair.
6712 Whether an option is meaningful depends on the lookup type.
6714 All lookups support the option &"cache=no_rd"&.
6715 If this is given then the cache that Exim manages for lookup results
6716 is not checked before doing the lookup.
6717 The result of the lookup is still written to the cache.
6719 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6720 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6721 lookup is permitted.
6724 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6725 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6726 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6727 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6730 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6731 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6732 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6733 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6734 The file string may not be tainted.
6736 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6737 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a single-key lookup"
6738 All single-key lookups support the option &"ret=key"&.
6739 If this is given and the lookup
6740 (either underlying implementation or cached value)
6741 returns data, the result is replaced with a non-tainted
6742 version of the lookup key.
6745 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6746 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6747 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6748 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6750 For the string-expansion kind of lookups, the query is given in the first
6751 bracketed argument of the &${lookup ...}$& expansion.
6752 For the list-argument kind of lookup the query is given by the remainder of the
6753 list item after the first semicolon.
6755 .cindex "tainted data" "quoting for lookups"
6756 If tainted data is used in the query then it should be quoted by
6757 using the &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& expansion operator
6758 appropriate for the lookup.
6761 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6762 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6763 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6768 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6769 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6770 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6775 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6776 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6777 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6778 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6781 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6782 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6783 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6784 The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6785 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6786 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6787 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6788 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6789 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6791 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6792 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6793 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6794 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6796 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6797 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6798 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6799 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6802 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6803 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6804 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6805 Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6806 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6807 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6808 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6810 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6811 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6812 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6813 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6814 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6815 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6816 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6819 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6820 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6822 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6823 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6824 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6825 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6826 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6827 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6828 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6831 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6832 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6833 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6835 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6836 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6837 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6838 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6839 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6840 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6841 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6842 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6843 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6844 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6847 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6848 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6849 The given file must be an absolute directory path; this is searched for an entry
6850 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6851 Unless the options (below) permit a path,
6852 the key may not contain any forward slash characters.
6853 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6854 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6855 The result is regarded as untainted.
6857 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6858 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6859 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6861 Three options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6863 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6864 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6866 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6868 The default result is just the requested entry.
6870 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6871 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6872 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6874 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6876 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6879 The "key" option relaxes the restriction that only a simple path component can
6880 be searched for, to permit a sequence of path components. Example:
6882 ${lookup {foo/bar} dsearch,key=path {/etc}}
6884 If this option is used, a ".." component in the key is specifically disallowed.
6885 The default operation is that the key may only be a single path component.
6887 An example of how this
6888 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6889 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6891 .subsection iplsearch
6892 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6893 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6894 The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6895 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6896 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6897 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6898 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6900 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6901 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6902 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6903 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6905 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6906 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6907 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6908 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6909 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6911 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6912 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6913 lookup types support only literal keys.
6915 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6916 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name
6917 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6919 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6920 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6921 notation before executing the lookup.)
6923 One option is supported, "ret=full", to request the return of the entire line
6924 rather than omitting the key portion.
6925 Note however that the key portion will have been de-quoted.
6929 .cindex json "lookup type"
6930 .cindex JSON expansions
6931 The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6932 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6933 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6934 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6935 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6936 of the JSON structure.
6937 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6938 nunbered array element is selected.
6939 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6940 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6941 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
6943 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6949 .cindex database lmdb
6950 The given file is an LMDB database.
6951 LMDB is a memory-mapped key-value store,
6952 with API modeled loosely on that of BerkeleyDB.
6953 See &url(https://symas.com/products/lightning-memory-mapped-database/)
6954 for the feature set and operation modes.
6956 Exim provides read-only access via the LMDB C library.
6957 The library can be obtained from &url(https://github.com/LMDB/lmdb)
6958 or your operating system package repository.
6959 To enable LMDB support in Exim set LOOKUP_LMDB=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
6961 You will need to separately create the LMDB database file,
6962 possibly using the &"mdb_load"& utility.
6966 .cindex "linear search"
6967 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6968 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6969 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6970 The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6971 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6972 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6973 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6974 in the file is used.
6976 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6977 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6978 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6979 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6980 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6985 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6986 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6987 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6988 wildcarding of any kind.
6990 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6991 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6992 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6993 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6994 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6995 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6996 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6997 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6998 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
7001 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
7002 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
7003 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
7004 The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
7005 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
7006 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
7007 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
7008 aliases; the full map names must be used.
7010 .subsection (n)wildlsearch
7011 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
7012 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
7013 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
7014 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
7015 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
7016 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
7017 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
7018 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
7019 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
7021 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
7022 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
7023 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
7024 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
7027 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
7029 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
7030 *fish data for anythingfish
7033 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
7034 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
7036 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
7038 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
7039 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
7040 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
7042 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7044 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
7045 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
7046 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
7048 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7051 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
7052 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
7053 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
7054 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
7055 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
7057 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
7058 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
7059 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
7060 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
7061 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
7064 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
7065 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
7066 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
7069 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
7071 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
7074 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
7075 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
7076 be followed by optional colons.
7078 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
7079 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
7080 lookup types support only literal keys.
7083 .cindex "spf lookup type"
7084 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
7085 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
7086 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
7087 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
7090 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
7091 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
7092 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
7093 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
7094 many of them are given in later sections.
7097 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7098 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
7099 This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7100 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7101 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7104 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7105 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7106 This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7109 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7110 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7111 This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7112 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7113 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7114 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7115 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7118 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7119 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7120 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7121 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7124 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7125 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7126 This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7127 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7130 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7131 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7132 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7133 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7136 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7137 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7138 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7139 This is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7140 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7141 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7142 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7143 password value. For example:
7145 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7149 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7150 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7151 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7152 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7155 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7156 .cindex lookup Redis
7157 The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7158 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7161 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7162 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7163 The format of the query is
7164 an SQL statement that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7167 This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7168 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7171 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7172 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7173 &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7174 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7175 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7176 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7177 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7178 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7179 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7181 require condition = \
7182 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7184 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7185 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7186 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7187 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7191 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7192 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7193 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7194 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7195 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7196 options such as a list of local domains.
7198 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7199 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7200 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7201 or may give up altogether.
7205 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7206 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7207 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7208 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7209 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7210 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7211 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7212 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7214 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7215 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7216 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7218 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7219 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7220 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7222 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7223 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7224 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7225 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7226 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7227 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7228 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7229 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7230 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7231 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7233 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7235 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7236 looks up these keys, in this order:
7242 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7243 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7244 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7245 Exim move on to try the next key.
7249 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7250 .cindex "partial matching"
7251 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7252 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7253 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7254 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7255 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7256 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7257 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7258 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7259 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7260 a key in a DBM file is
7262 *.dates.fict.example
7264 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7265 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7266 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7269 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7270 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7271 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7273 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7274 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7275 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7276 partial matching keys
7277 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7278 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7279 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7281 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7282 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7283 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7284 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7285 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7286 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7289 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7290 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7291 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7292 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7293 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7294 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7296 2250.dates.fict.example
7297 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7298 *.dates.fict.example
7301 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7304 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7305 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7306 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7307 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7308 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7309 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7311 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7313 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7314 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7315 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7316 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7318 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7320 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7321 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7323 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7324 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7325 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7328 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7330 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7331 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7333 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7334 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7335 for &"*"& on its own.
7337 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7341 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7342 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7343 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7344 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7345 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7346 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7347 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7349 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7350 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7351 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7352 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7353 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7355 When the lookup is done from a string-expansion,
7356 the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild and non-wild parts of the key
7357 during the expansion of the replacement text.
7358 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
7363 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7364 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7365 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7366 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7367 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7368 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7369 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7371 If an option &"cache=no_rd"& is used on the lookup then
7372 the cache is only written to, cached data is not used for the operation
7373 and a real lookup is done.
7375 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7376 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7377 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7378 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7379 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7380 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7382 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7383 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7389 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7390 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7391 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7392 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7393 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7394 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7398 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7399 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7401 [name="$local_part"]
7403 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7404 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7405 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7406 of the following form is provided:
7408 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7410 For example, the way to write the NIS+ query is
7412 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7414 .cindex "tainted data" "in lookups"
7415 &*All*& tainted data used in a query-style lookup must be quoted
7416 using a mechanism appropriate for the lookup type.
7417 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7418 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7419 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7424 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7425 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7426 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7427 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7428 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7429 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7430 an expansion string could contain:
7432 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7434 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7435 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7436 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7437 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7439 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7440 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7441 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7443 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7444 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7445 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7446 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7447 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7449 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7451 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7452 white space is ignored.
7453 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7454 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7455 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7457 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7458 When the type is PTR,
7459 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7460 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7462 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7464 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7465 altered and nothing is added.
7467 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7468 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7469 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7470 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7471 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7472 The field separator can be modified as above.
7474 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7475 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7476 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7477 unless a field separator is specified.
7478 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7480 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7482 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7483 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7484 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7486 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7487 white space is ignored.
7489 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7490 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7491 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7492 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7495 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7498 .subsection "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" SECTdnsdb_mod
7499 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7500 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7501 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7502 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7503 each followed by a comma,
7504 that may appear before the record type.
7506 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7507 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7508 a defer-option modifier.
7509 The possible keywords are
7510 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7511 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7512 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7513 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7514 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7515 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7516 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7518 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7519 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7521 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7522 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7524 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7525 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7526 The possible keywords are
7527 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7528 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7530 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7531 is not labelled as authenticated data
7532 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7533 The default is &"lax"&.
7535 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7537 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7538 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7539 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7540 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7542 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7544 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7545 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7546 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7548 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7549 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7551 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7552 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7553 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7556 .subsection "Pseudo dnsdb record types" SECID66
7557 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7558 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7559 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7560 the pseudo-type MXH:
7562 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7564 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7567 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7568 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7569 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7570 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7571 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7572 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7573 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7574 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7576 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7577 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7579 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7580 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7581 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7583 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7584 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7585 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7586 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7587 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7590 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7591 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7592 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7593 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7594 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7595 result of a successful lookup such as:
7597 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7599 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7600 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7601 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7603 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7604 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7605 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7606 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7608 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7612 .subsection "Multiple dnsdb lookups" SECID67
7613 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7614 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7615 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7616 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7618 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7619 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7620 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7622 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7623 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7624 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7625 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7627 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7628 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7629 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7634 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7635 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7636 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7637 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7638 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7639 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7640 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7641 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7642 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7643 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7644 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7645 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7647 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7648 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7649 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7650 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7651 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7653 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7654 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7656 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7657 the way they handle the results of a query:
7660 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7663 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7664 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7666 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7667 from all of them are returned.
7671 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7672 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7673 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7674 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7677 .subsection "Format of LDAP queries" SECTforldaque
7678 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7679 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7680 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7682 data = ${lookup ldap \
7683 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7684 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7686 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7687 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7688 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7689 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7691 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7692 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7693 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7695 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7696 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7697 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7698 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7699 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7700 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7701 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7702 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7706 .subsection "LDAP quoting" SECID68
7707 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7708 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7709 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7710 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7711 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7713 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7714 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7722 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7723 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7727 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7729 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7733 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7735 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7737 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7739 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7740 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7741 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7745 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7746 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7747 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7749 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7753 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7755 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7757 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7759 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7760 authentication below.
7763 .subsection "LDAP connections" SECID69
7764 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7765 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7766 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7767 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7770 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7772 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7773 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7774 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7775 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7776 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7777 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7778 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7779 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7780 failures, and timeouts.
7782 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7783 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7784 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7785 doubled. For example
7787 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7789 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7790 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7791 the local host) is used.
7793 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7794 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7795 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7796 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7799 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7800 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7801 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7802 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7804 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7806 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7807 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7809 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7811 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7812 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7813 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7814 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7815 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7816 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7817 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7820 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7821 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7822 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7825 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7828 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7832 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7833 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7837 .subsection "LDAP authentication and control information" SECID70
7838 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7839 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7840 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7841 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7842 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7843 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7844 them. The following names are recognized:
7845 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
7846 .irow DEREFERENCE "set the dereferencing parameter"
7847 .irow NETTIME "set a timeout for a network operation"
7848 .irow USER "set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind"
7849 .irow PASS "set the password, likewise"
7850 .irow REFERRALS "set the referrals parameter"
7851 .irow SERVERS "set alternate server list for this query only"
7852 .irow SIZE "set the limit for the number of entries returned"
7853 .irow TIME "set the maximum waiting time for a query"
7855 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7856 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7857 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7858 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7860 .cindex LDAP timeout
7861 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7862 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7863 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7864 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7865 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7866 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7867 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7868 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7869 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7870 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7872 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7873 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7875 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7876 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7877 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7878 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7879 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7880 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7881 alternate list (colon-separated).
7883 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7884 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7887 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7888 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7891 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7892 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7893 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7894 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7896 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7897 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7898 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7900 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7901 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it to the LDAP library.
7903 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7904 quoting has two advantages:
7907 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7908 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7910 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7913 For example, a setting such as
7915 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7917 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7919 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7920 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7921 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7922 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7926 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7927 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7932 .subsection "Format of data returned by LDAP" SECID71
7933 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7934 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7935 as a sequence of values, for example
7937 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7939 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7940 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7941 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7942 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7943 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7946 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7947 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7948 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7949 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7951 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7952 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7953 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7954 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7955 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7956 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7957 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7958 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7959 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7961 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7962 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7963 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7964 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7965 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7968 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7971 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7974 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7975 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7977 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7978 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7980 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7981 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7984 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7985 results of LDAP lookups.
7986 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7987 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7988 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7989 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7990 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7991 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7996 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7997 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7998 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7999 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
8000 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
8001 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
8002 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
8003 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
8005 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
8007 might return the string
8009 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
8010 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
8012 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
8014 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
8020 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
8021 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
8022 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
8026 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
8027 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
8028 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8029 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8030 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8031 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8032 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8033 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8034 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8035 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8036 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8037 .cindex lookup Redis
8038 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
8040 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
8043 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
8046 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
8047 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
8049 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
8054 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
8056 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
8057 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
8058 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
8062 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
8063 with a newline between the data for each row.
8066 .subsection "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" SECID72
8067 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8068 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8069 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8070 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8071 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8072 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8073 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8074 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8075 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8076 .cindex lookup Redis
8077 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
8078 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
8079 or &%redis_servers%&
8080 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8082 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
8083 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
8084 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
8085 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
8086 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
8087 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
8088 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
8089 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
8091 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
8092 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
8093 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
8094 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
8096 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
8098 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
8099 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
8100 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
8102 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
8103 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
8105 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
8106 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
8107 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
8108 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
8109 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
8110 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
8112 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
8113 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
8114 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8116 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8117 host, database number, and password.
8119 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8120 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8121 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8123 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8125 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8128 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8129 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8130 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8131 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8133 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8134 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8136 .subsection "Specifying the server in the query" SECTspeserque
8137 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8138 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8139 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8141 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8143 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8145 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8146 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8147 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8150 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8152 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8153 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8154 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8156 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8157 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8158 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8161 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8165 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8167 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8169 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8170 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8171 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8173 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8176 A now-deprecated syntax places the servers specification before the query,
8177 semicolon separated:
8179 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8181 The new version avoids issues with tainted
8182 arguments explicitly expanded as part of the query.
8183 The entire string within the braces becomes tainted,
8184 including the server sepcification - which is not permissible.
8185 If the older sytax is used, a warning message will be logged.
8186 This syntax will be removed in a future release.
8188 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8191 .subsection "Special MySQL features" SECID73
8192 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8193 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8194 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8195 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8196 the default value is &"exim"&.
8197 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8199 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8200 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8202 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8203 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8205 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8208 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8209 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8211 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8212 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8213 is zero because no rows are affected.
8215 To get an encryted connection, use a Mysql option file with the required
8216 parameters for the connection.
8219 .subsection "Special PostgreSQL features" SECID74
8220 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8221 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8222 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8223 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8226 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8228 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8229 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8230 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8232 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8233 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8236 .subsection "More about SQLite" SECTsqlite
8237 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8238 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8239 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8240 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8241 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8243 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8244 There are two ways of
8245 specifying the file.
8246 The first is by using the &%sqlite_dbfile%& main option.
8247 The second, which allows separate files for each query,
8248 is to use an option appended, comma-separated, to the &"sqlite"&
8249 lookup type word. The option is the word &"file"&, then an equals,
8251 The filename in this case cannot contain whitespace or open-brace charachters.
8253 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8254 separated by white space.
8256 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8257 the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8258 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8261 In all the above cases the filename must be an absolute path.
8263 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8265 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8267 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8269 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8271 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8272 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8274 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8275 quote, which it doubles.
8277 .cindex timeout SQLite
8278 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8279 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8280 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8281 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8282 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8283 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8284 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8287 .subsection "More about Redis" SECTredis
8288 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8289 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8290 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8293 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8294 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8297 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8298 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8299 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8300 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8303 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8304 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8305 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8312 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8315 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8316 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8317 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8318 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8319 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8320 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8321 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8322 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8323 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8325 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8326 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8327 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8328 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8330 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8331 support all the complexity available in
8332 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8336 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8337 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8338 In some contexts additional information is stored
8339 about the list element that matched:
8342 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8343 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8345 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8346 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8348 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8349 will store a result in the &$domain_data$& variable.
8351 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8352 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8354 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8355 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8358 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8359 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8364 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8365 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8366 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8367 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
8368 &*Note*&: As a result, if any componend was tainted then the
8369 entire result string becomes tainted.
8371 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8372 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8375 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8376 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8377 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8378 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8379 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8382 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8383 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8384 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8386 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8387 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8388 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8389 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8390 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8392 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8393 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8395 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8396 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8397 senders based on the receiving domain.
8402 .subsection "Negated items in lists" SECID76
8403 .cindex "list" "negation"
8404 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8405 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8406 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8407 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8408 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8409 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8411 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8412 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8413 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8414 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8415 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8417 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8419 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8420 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8421 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8423 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8425 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8426 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8427 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8429 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8430 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8435 .subsection "File names in lists" SECTfilnamlis
8436 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8437 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8438 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8439 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8440 filenames are not allowed,
8441 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8442 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8446 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8447 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8449 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8450 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8451 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8453 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8457 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8458 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8459 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8460 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8462 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8463 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8465 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8467 and the file contains the lines
8472 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8473 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8477 .subsection "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" SECID77
8478 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8479 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8480 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8481 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8482 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8483 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8484 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8486 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8487 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8488 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8489 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8494 .subsection "Named lists" SECTnamedlists
8495 .cindex "named lists"
8496 .cindex "list" "named"
8497 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8498 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8499 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8500 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8501 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8502 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8503 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8505 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8507 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8508 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8509 configured with the line
8511 domains = +local_domains
8513 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8514 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8518 domains = ! +local_domains
8519 transport = remote_smtp
8522 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8523 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8524 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8525 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8527 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8528 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8530 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8532 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8533 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8534 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8536 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8537 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8538 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8540 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8541 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8543 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8544 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8545 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8547 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8549 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8550 referenced lists if you can.
8552 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8553 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8554 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8555 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8556 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8557 word &"hide"&. For example:
8559 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8563 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8564 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8565 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8567 domains = +local_domains
8569 on several of your routers
8570 or in several ACL statements,
8571 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8572 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8573 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8574 the same each time they are referenced.
8576 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8577 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8578 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8579 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8583 .subsection "Named lists compared with macros" SECID78
8584 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8585 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8586 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8587 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8590 ALIST = host1 : host2
8591 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8593 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8595 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8597 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8600 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8601 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8603 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8605 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8609 .subsection "Named list caching" SECID79
8610 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8611 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8612 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8613 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8614 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8615 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8616 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8617 message. For example:
8619 domainlist special_domains = \
8620 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8622 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8623 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8624 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8625 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8626 same list each time.
8628 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8629 cache the result anyway. For example:
8631 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8633 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8634 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8638 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8639 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8640 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8641 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8642 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8645 .cindex "primary host name"
8646 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8647 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8648 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8649 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8650 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8651 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8652 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8653 differ only in their names.
8655 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8659 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8660 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8661 .cindex "domain literal"
8662 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8663 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8664 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8665 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8666 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8667 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8668 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8670 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8675 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8676 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8677 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8678 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8679 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8680 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8681 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8682 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8683 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8684 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8685 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8687 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8688 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8689 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8690 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8691 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8693 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8694 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8695 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8696 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8697 on a router). For example:
8699 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8701 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8702 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8704 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8705 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8706 contain negative items.
8708 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8709 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8710 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8712 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8713 an.other.domain : ...
8715 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8716 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8718 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8719 an.other.domain ? ...
8721 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8725 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8726 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8727 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8728 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8729 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8730 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8731 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8732 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8733 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8736 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8737 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8738 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8741 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8742 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8743 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8744 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8745 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8746 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8747 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8748 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8749 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8751 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8752 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8753 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8754 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8755 expression by expansion, of course).
8757 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8758 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8759 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8764 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8765 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8766 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8767 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8768 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8769 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8771 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8773 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8774 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8775 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8776 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8777 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8778 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8779 other statements in the same ACL.
8780 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8781 .cindex "de-tainting" "using ACL domains condition"
8782 The value will be untainted.
8784 &*Note*&: If the data result of the lookup (as opposed to the key)
8785 is empty, then this empty value is stored in &$domain_data$&.
8786 The option to return the key for the lookup, as the value,
8787 may be what is wanted.
8791 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8792 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8794 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8796 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8797 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8800 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8801 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8802 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8803 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8804 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8805 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8809 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8810 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8811 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8812 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8814 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8815 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8817 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8818 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8819 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8820 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8821 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8822 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8823 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
8824 The value will be untainted.
8827 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8828 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8829 followed by a comma and options,
8830 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8831 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=" sign.
8834 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8835 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8836 between the pattern and the domain.
8838 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8839 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8840 Note that this is commonly untainted
8841 (depending on the way the list was created).
8842 Specifically, explicit text in the configuration file in not tainted.
8843 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8844 the domain, for later operations.
8846 However if the list (including one-element lists)
8847 is created by expanding a variable containing tainted data,
8848 it is tainted and so will the match value be.
8852 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8854 domainlist funny_domains = \
8857 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8858 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8859 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8860 nis;domains.byname : \
8861 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8863 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8864 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8865 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8866 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8867 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8872 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8873 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8874 .cindex "list" "host list"
8875 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8876 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8877 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8878 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8879 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8880 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8881 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8884 .subsection "Special host list patterns" SECID80
8885 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8886 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8887 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8888 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8889 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8892 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8893 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8894 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8898 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by IP address" SECThoslispatip
8899 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8900 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8901 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8902 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8903 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8904 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8907 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8908 inspecting its IP address:
8911 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8912 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8913 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8914 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8915 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8916 with the IP address of the subject host.
8918 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8919 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8920 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8921 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8922 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8925 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8926 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8927 domain name, as just described.
8930 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8931 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8932 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8933 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8934 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8935 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8936 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8937 that can never match a client host.
8940 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8941 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8942 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8943 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8945 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8949 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8950 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length, for
8955 , it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8956 host under the given mask. This allows an entire network of hosts to be
8957 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8958 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8959 significant end of the address.
8961 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8962 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8963 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8964 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8968 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8969 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8972 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8974 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8975 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8977 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8978 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8981 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8983 could make use of a file containing
8988 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8989 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8990 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8992 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8995 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
9001 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
9003 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
9004 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
9005 address, the pattern takes this form:
9007 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9011 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
9013 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
9014 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
9015 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
9016 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
9017 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
9018 returned by the lookup is not used.
9020 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9021 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
9022 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
9023 patterns of this form:
9025 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9029 net24-dbm;/networks.db
9031 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
9032 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
9033 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
9034 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
9035 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
9037 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
9038 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
9039 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
9040 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
9041 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
9042 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
9043 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
9044 converted using colons and not dots.
9045 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
9046 addresses are always used.
9047 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
9049 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
9050 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
9051 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
9054 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
9055 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
9056 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
9057 case the IP address is used on its own.
9061 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by host name" SECThoslispatnam
9062 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
9063 .cindex "unknown host name"
9064 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9065 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
9066 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
9067 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
9068 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
9071 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
9072 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
9073 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
9074 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
9075 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
9076 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
9077 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
9079 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
9080 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
9082 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
9083 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
9084 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
9085 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
9086 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
9087 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
9088 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
9089 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
9090 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
9092 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
9093 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9095 .cindex "host" "alias for"
9096 .cindex "alias for host"
9097 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
9098 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
9101 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9102 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
9103 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
9104 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
9105 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
9108 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
9109 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
9110 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
9111 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
9112 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
9113 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
9114 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
9119 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
9120 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
9121 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
9122 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
9123 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9125 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9127 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9128 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9129 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9136 .subsection "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" SECTbehipnot
9137 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9138 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9139 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9140 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9141 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9143 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9144 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9146 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9147 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9148 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9149 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9150 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9151 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9152 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9153 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9154 not recognized in an indirected file).
9157 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9158 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9160 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9162 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9163 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9166 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9167 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9170 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9173 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9174 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9175 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9178 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9179 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9182 .subsection "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9184 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9186 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9187 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9188 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9191 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9192 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9193 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9195 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9197 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9198 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9199 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9200 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9201 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9202 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9203 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9206 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9207 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9209 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9210 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9212 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9213 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9214 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9219 .subsection "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9221 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9222 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9223 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9224 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9225 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9226 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9227 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9228 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9229 host lists such as whitelists.
9233 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9235 .cindex "unknown host name"
9236 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9237 If a pattern is of the form
9239 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9243 dbm;/host/accept/list
9245 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9246 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9249 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9250 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9251 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"&
9252 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
9253 There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9254 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9255 lookup, both using the same file.
9259 .subsection "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" SECID81
9260 If a pattern is of the form
9262 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9264 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9265 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9266 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9268 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9269 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9271 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9272 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9273 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9276 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9277 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9278 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9280 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9281 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9282 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9283 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9284 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9285 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9291 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9292 .cindex "list" "address list"
9293 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9294 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9295 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9296 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9297 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9298 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9299 using this option setting:
9303 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9304 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9305 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9306 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9308 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9311 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9313 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9314 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9315 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9316 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9317 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9318 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9319 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9321 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9322 *@+hostile_domains:\
9323 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9324 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9326 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9327 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9328 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9329 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9330 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9332 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9333 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9334 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9335 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9336 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9338 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9341 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9342 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9346 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9347 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9348 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9349 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9350 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9351 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9352 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9354 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9355 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9357 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9358 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9361 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9362 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9363 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9366 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9367 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9368 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9370 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9371 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9372 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9373 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9375 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9376 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9378 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9379 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9380 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9381 default. For example, with this lookup:
9383 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9385 the file could contains lines like this:
9387 user1@domain1.example
9390 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9393 nimrod@jaeger.example
9397 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9398 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9400 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9402 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9403 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9405 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9406 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9407 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9411 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9412 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9417 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9418 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9419 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9420 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9421 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9422 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9423 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9424 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9425 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9427 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9428 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9429 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9430 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9431 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9434 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9436 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9438 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9440 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9442 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9443 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9444 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9445 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9446 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9447 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9449 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9452 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9455 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9456 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9457 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9458 might have entries like
9460 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9461 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9464 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9465 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9466 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9467 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9469 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9470 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9471 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9474 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9475 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9476 can only return a single list of local parts.
9479 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9480 in these two examples:
9483 senders = *@+my_list
9485 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9486 example it is a named domain list.
9491 .subsection "Case of letters in address lists" SECTcasletadd
9492 .cindex "case of local parts"
9493 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9494 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9495 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9496 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9497 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9498 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9499 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9500 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9503 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9504 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9505 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9506 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9507 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9508 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9509 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9512 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9513 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9514 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9515 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9516 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9517 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9518 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9519 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9523 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9524 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9525 .cindex "local part" "list"
9526 These behave in the same way as domain and host lists, with the following
9529 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9530 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9531 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9532 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9533 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9534 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9535 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9536 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9538 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9539 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9540 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9541 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9542 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9543 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9544 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9546 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9551 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9552 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9554 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9555 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9556 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9557 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9559 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9560 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9561 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9562 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9563 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9564 escape character, as described in the following section.
9566 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
9567 If any porttion of the result string is tainted, the entire result is.
9569 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9570 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9571 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9572 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9573 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9575 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9576 .cindex "tainted data" definition
9577 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9578 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9579 is not permitted (including acessing a file using a tainted name).
9581 Common ways of obtaining untainted equivalents of variables with
9583 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
9584 come down to using the tainted value as a lookup key in a trusted database.
9585 This database could be the filesystem structure,
9586 or the password file,
9587 or accessed via a DBMS.
9588 Specific methods are indexed under &"de-tainting"&.
9592 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9593 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9594 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9595 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9596 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9597 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9598 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9599 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9601 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9602 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9603 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9604 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9606 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9608 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9609 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9614 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9615 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9616 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9617 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9618 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9619 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9620 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9623 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9624 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9625 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9628 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9629 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9630 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9632 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9633 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9634 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9635 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9636 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9637 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9638 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9641 When reading lines from the standard input,
9642 macros can be defined and ACL variables can be set.
9646 set acl_m_myvar = bar
9648 Such macros and variables can then be used in later input lines.
9650 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9651 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9652 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9655 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9656 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9657 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9658 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9660 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9662 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9663 Exim message identifier. For example:
9665 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9667 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9668 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9671 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9672 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9673 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9674 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9675 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9676 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9677 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9678 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9679 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9680 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9681 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9682 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9688 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9689 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9690 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9691 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9692 white space is significant.
9695 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9696 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9697 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9702 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9703 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9704 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9705 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9706 given, the expansion fails.
9708 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9709 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9710 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9711 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9715 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9716 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9717 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9718 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9719 string easier to understand.
9721 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9722 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9723 expansion item below.
9726 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9727 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9728 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9729 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9730 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9731 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9732 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9733 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9734 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9735 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9736 the result of the expansion.
9737 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9738 the expansion result is an empty string.
9739 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9742 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9743 .cindex authentication "results header"
9744 .chindex Authentication-Results:
9745 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9746 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9747 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9749 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9750 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9751 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9760 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9762 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9764 This is safe even if no authentication results are available
9765 and would generally be placed in the DATA ACL.
9768 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9769 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9770 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9771 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9772 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9773 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9774 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9775 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9779 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9780 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9785 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9789 If the field is found,
9790 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9791 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9792 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9793 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9795 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9796 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9799 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9801 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9802 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9804 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9805 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9806 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9807 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9808 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9809 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9810 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9811 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9813 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9814 take an optional modifier of "int"
9815 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9816 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9817 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9819 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9820 newline-separated by default,
9821 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9822 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9823 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9825 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9826 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9827 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9828 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9829 if so the element tags are omitted.
9831 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9833 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9834 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9836 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9837 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9841 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9842 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9843 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9845 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9848 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9849 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9850 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9851 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9852 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9853 must have the following type:
9855 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9857 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9858 function should return one of the following values:
9860 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9861 into the expanded string that is being built.
9863 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9864 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9866 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9867 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9869 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9871 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9872 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9873 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9876 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9877 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9878 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9879 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9881 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9882 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9883 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9885 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9886 appear, for example:
9888 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9890 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9891 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9893 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9895 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9898 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9899 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9902 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9903 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9904 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9905 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9906 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9907 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9908 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9909 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9911 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9914 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9915 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9916 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9917 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9918 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9919 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9920 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9921 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9922 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9924 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9925 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9926 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9929 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9930 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9932 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9933 appear, for example:
9935 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9937 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9938 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9940 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9941 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9942 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9943 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9944 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9945 .cindex JSON expansions
9946 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9947 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9948 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9949 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9951 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9954 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9955 the spaces are optional.
9956 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9957 For the &"json"& variant,
9958 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9960 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9961 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9962 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9964 The results of matching are handled as above.
9967 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9968 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9969 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9970 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9971 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9972 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9973 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9974 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9975 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9976 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9977 <&'string3'&> as before.
9979 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9980 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9981 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9982 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9983 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9984 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9985 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9986 provided. For example:
9988 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9992 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9994 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9995 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9998 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9999 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10000 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10001 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10002 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
10003 .cindex JSON expansions
10004 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10005 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10007 Field selection and result handling is as above;
10008 there is no choice of field separator.
10009 For the &"json"& variant,
10010 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10012 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10013 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10016 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
10017 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
10018 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
10020 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10021 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10023 in this list, its value is placed in &$item$&, and then the condition is
10025 Any modification of &$value$& by this evaluation is discarded.
10026 If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
10027 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
10028 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
10029 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
10031 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
10033 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
10034 to what it was before.
10035 See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10038 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10039 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10040 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10041 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
10042 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
10043 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
10045 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
10046 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
10047 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
10048 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10050 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10052 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
10053 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
10054 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
10055 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
10056 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
10058 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
10060 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
10061 letters appear. For example:
10063 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
10064 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
10065 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
10068 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10069 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10070 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10071 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10072 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10073 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10074 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10075 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10076 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
10077 .vindex "&$header_$&"
10078 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
10079 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
10080 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
10081 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
10082 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
10083 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
10084 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
10088 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
10089 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
10090 lines) may be present.
10092 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
10093 the data in the header line is interpreted.
10096 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
10097 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
10098 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
10101 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
10102 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
10103 are multiple headers with a given name.
10104 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
10105 list-processing facilities can be used.
10106 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
10107 the content is &"raw"&.
10110 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
10111 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
10112 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
10113 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
10114 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
10115 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
10116 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
10117 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
10120 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
10121 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
10122 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
10123 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
10124 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
10125 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
10128 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
10129 command of the following form:
10131 headers charset "UTF-8"
10133 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
10134 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
10135 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
10136 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
10137 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
10140 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
10141 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
10142 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
10143 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
10145 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
10146 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
10147 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
10148 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
10149 router or transport are not accessible.
10151 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
10152 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
10153 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
10154 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
10155 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
10156 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10157 point they are added.
10158 When any of the above ACLs are
10159 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10161 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10162 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10163 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10164 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10165 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10166 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10167 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10170 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10171 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10172 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10173 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10174 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10175 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10176 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10177 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10179 .cindex "tainted data" "message headers"
10180 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10181 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10184 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10185 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10187 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10188 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10189 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10190 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10191 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10192 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10193 present. For example:
10195 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10197 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10200 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10202 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10203 an Exim configuration:
10205 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10207 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10210 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10211 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10212 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10214 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10215 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10216 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10217 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10218 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10219 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10222 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10223 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10224 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10225 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10226 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10227 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10229 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10231 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10232 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10233 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10234 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10235 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10237 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10238 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10239 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10241 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10245 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10250 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10251 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10252 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10253 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10254 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10255 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10259 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10260 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10261 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10262 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10263 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10264 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10265 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10266 some of the braces:
10268 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10270 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10271 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10272 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10273 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10276 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10277 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10278 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10279 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10280 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10281 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10282 apart from an optional leading minus,
10283 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10285 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10286 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10288 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10289 If the number is negative, the fields are
10290 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10291 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10292 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10294 If the modulus of the
10295 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10296 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10300 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10304 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10306 yields &"result: 42"&.
10308 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10309 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10311 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10314 .vitem &*${listquote{*&<&'separator'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10315 .cindex quoting "for list"
10316 .cindex list quoting
10317 This item doubles any occurrence of the separator character
10318 in the given string.
10319 An empty string is replaced with a single space.
10320 This converts the string into a safe form for use as a list element,
10321 in a list using the given separator.
10324 .vitem "&*${lookup&~{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10325 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10326 "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10327 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10328 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10329 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10330 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10331 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10332 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10333 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10334 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10336 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10337 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10338 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10339 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10340 out by the system administrator.
10342 .vindex "&$value$&"
10343 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10344 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10345 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10346 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10347 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10348 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10349 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10350 original lookup fails.
10352 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10353 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10354 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10355 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10356 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10357 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10358 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10359 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10361 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10362 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10363 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10364 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10366 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10367 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10368 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10369 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10371 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10373 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10375 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10376 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10378 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10383 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10384 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10386 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10387 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10389 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10390 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10391 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10392 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10394 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10396 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10397 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10398 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10400 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10401 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10402 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10403 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10404 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10405 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10406 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10408 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10410 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10411 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10412 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10413 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10416 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10418 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10422 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10423 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10424 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10425 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10426 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10427 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10428 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10429 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10431 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10432 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the entire expansion is
10433 forced to fail, in the same way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item
10434 does (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). Whatever you return is evaluated
10435 in a scalar context, thus the return value is a scalar. For example, if you
10436 return a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10439 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10440 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10441 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10443 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10444 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10447 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10448 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10449 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10450 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10451 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10452 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10453 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10454 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10456 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10457 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10458 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10459 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10460 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10461 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10462 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10463 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10464 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10465 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10467 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10468 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10469 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10470 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10472 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10473 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10474 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10475 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10476 is the expansion of the third argument.
10478 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10479 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10480 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10482 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10483 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10484 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10485 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10486 The filename and end-of-line (eol) string are first expanded separately. The file is
10487 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10488 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10489 newlines are left in the string.
10490 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10491 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10492 the string expansion fails.
10494 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10495 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10499 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10500 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10501 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10502 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10503 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10504 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10505 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10508 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10509 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10511 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10512 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10513 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10514 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10515 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10518 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10520 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10521 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10522 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10523 (unless it is an empty string; no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10524 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10525 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10526 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10528 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10531 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10532 and must be present if any options are given.
10533 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10536 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10539 The following option names are recognised:
10542 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10543 request in the same process.
10544 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10545 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10546 will be invalidated.
10550 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10551 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10552 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10556 Controls the use of Server Name Identification on the connection.
10557 Any nonempty value will be the SNI sent; TLS will be forced.
10561 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10562 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10563 If it is enabled, a shutdown as described above is never done.
10567 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10568 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10569 turns them into spaces:
10571 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10573 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10574 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10575 addition, the following errors can occur:
10578 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10580 Failure to connect the socket;
10582 Failure to write the request string;
10584 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10587 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10588 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10589 errors occurs. For example:
10591 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10594 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10595 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10596 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10597 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10598 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10600 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10601 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10604 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10605 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10606 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10607 .vindex "&$value$&"
10609 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10610 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10611 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10612 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10613 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10614 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10615 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10616 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10617 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10618 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10620 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10622 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10625 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10627 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10628 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10631 . A bit of a special-case logic error in writing an expansion;
10632 . probably not worth including in the mainline of documentation.
10633 . If only we had footnotes (the html output variant is the problem).
10636 . &*Note*&: if an &'expansion condition'& is used in <&'string3'&>
10637 . and that condition modifies &$value$&,
10638 . then the string expansions dependent on the condition cannot use
10639 . the &$value$& of the reduce iteration.
10642 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10643 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10644 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10646 .vitem "&*${run<&'options'&> {*&<&'command&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10647 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10648 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10649 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10650 This item runs an external command, as a subprocess.
10651 One option is supported after the word &'run'&, comma-separated
10652 and without whitespace.
10654 If the option &'preexpand'& is not used,
10655 the command string before expansion is split into individual arguments by spaces
10656 and then each argument is separately expanded.
10657 Then the command is run
10658 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10659 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10660 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10661 The command name may not be tainted, but the remaining arguments can be.
10663 &*Note*&: if tainted arguments are used, they are supplied by a
10664 potential attacker;
10665 a careful assessment for security vulnerabilities should be done.
10667 If the option &'preexpand'& is used,
10668 the command string is first expanded as a whole.
10669 The expansion result is split apart into individual arguments by spaces,
10670 and then the command is run as above.
10671 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10672 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10673 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10674 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10675 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10676 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10677 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10678 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10679 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10681 Neither the command nor any argument may be tainted.
10683 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10684 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10685 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10686 .vindex "&$value$&"
10687 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10688 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10689 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10690 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10691 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10694 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10695 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10696 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10697 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10699 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10700 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10701 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10704 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10705 log_message = Output of id: $value
10707 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10708 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10710 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10712 Note that &$value$& will not persist beyond the reception of a single message.
10714 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10715 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10716 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10718 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10719 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10723 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10724 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10727 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10728 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10729 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10730 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10732 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10733 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10736 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10737 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10738 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10739 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10740 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10741 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10742 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10743 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10745 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10747 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10748 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10749 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10751 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10753 yields &"defabc"&, and
10755 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10757 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10758 the regular expression from string expansion.
10760 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10761 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10764 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10765 .cindex sorting "a list"
10766 .cindex list sorting
10767 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10768 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10769 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10770 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10771 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10772 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10773 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10774 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10775 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10776 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10777 to give values for comparison.
10779 The item result is a sorted list,
10780 with the original list separator,
10781 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10785 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10787 sorts a list of numbers, and
10789 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10791 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10795 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
10796 SRS encoding. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
10800 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'start'&>&*}{*&<&'len'&>&*}{*&<&'subject'&>&*}}*&
10801 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10802 .cindex "substring extraction"
10803 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10804 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10805 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10806 if <&'start'&> and <&'len'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10807 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10809 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<subject>}
10811 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10812 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10815 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10816 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10817 length required. For example
10819 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10821 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10822 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10823 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10824 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10826 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10827 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10828 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10830 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10832 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10833 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10834 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10836 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10838 yields an empty string, but
10840 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10844 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10845 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10846 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10847 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10850 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10852 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10854 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10858 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10859 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10860 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10861 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10862 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10863 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10864 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10865 replacement list. For example
10867 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10869 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10870 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10871 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10874 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10880 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10881 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10882 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10883 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10884 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10885 following operations can be performed:
10888 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10889 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10890 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10891 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10892 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10893 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10895 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10898 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10899 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10900 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10901 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10902 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10903 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10904 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10905 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10906 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10908 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10909 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10910 character. For example:
10912 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10914 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10915 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10916 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10917 separator explicitly:
10919 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10922 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10923 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10924 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10927 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10928 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10929 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10930 email address separator. For the example header line:
10932 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10934 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10935 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10936 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10937 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10938 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10939 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10940 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10942 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10943 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10945 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10946 Last:user@example.com
10947 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10949 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10953 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10954 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10955 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10956 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10957 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10958 Only lowercase letters are used.
10960 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10961 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10962 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10963 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10964 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10966 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10967 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10968 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10969 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10970 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10971 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10972 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10973 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10974 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10976 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10977 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10978 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10979 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10980 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10981 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10984 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10985 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10986 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10987 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10988 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10989 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10991 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10992 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10995 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10996 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10997 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10998 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10999 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
11002 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11003 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
11004 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
11005 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
11006 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11009 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11010 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
11011 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
11012 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
11013 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
11014 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
11015 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
11017 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11018 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
11019 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
11020 If the string contains any characters with the most significant bit set,
11021 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
11022 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
11025 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11026 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
11027 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
11028 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
11029 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
11030 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
11031 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
11032 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
11033 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
11034 C programming language):
11036 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
11037 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
11038 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
11039 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
11040 .irow "" "and (&&)"
11042 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
11044 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
11045 space is permitted before or after operators.
11047 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
11048 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
11049 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
11050 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
11051 times, which often do have leading zeros.
11053 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
11055 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
11056 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
11059 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
11060 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
11061 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
11062 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
11063 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
11064 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
11065 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
11066 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
11067 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
11068 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
11069 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
11072 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
11076 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
11079 {$recipients_count} \
11080 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
11083 message = Too many bad recipients
11085 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
11086 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
11089 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11090 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
11091 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
11094 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
11096 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
11097 and then re-expands what it has found.
11100 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11102 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
11103 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
11104 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
11105 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
11106 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
11107 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
11108 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
11109 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
11110 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
11112 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
11113 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
11114 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
11115 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
11116 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
11117 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
11118 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
11121 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11122 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
11123 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
11124 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
11125 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
11126 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11128 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11130 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
11131 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
11135 .vitem &*${headerwrap_*&<&'cols'&>&*_*&<&'limit'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11136 .cindex header "wrapping operator"
11137 .cindex expansion "header wrapping"
11138 This operator line-wraps its argument in a way useful for headers.
11139 The &'cols'& value gives the column number to wrap after,
11140 the &'limit'& gives a limit number of result characters to truncate at.
11141 Either just the &'limit'& and the preceding underbar, or both, can be omitted;
11142 the defaults are 80 and 998.
11143 Wrapping will be inserted at a space if possible before the
11144 column number is reached.
11145 Whitespace at a chosen wrap point is removed.
11146 A line-wrap consists of a newline followed by a tab,
11147 and the tab is counted as 8 columns.
11151 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
11152 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
11153 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
11154 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
11155 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
11156 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
11160 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11161 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
11162 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
11163 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
11164 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
11165 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
11166 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
11169 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11170 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
11171 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11172 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
11173 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
11174 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11175 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11177 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11178 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
11179 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11180 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
11181 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
11182 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
11183 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
11184 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11185 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11188 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11189 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11190 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11191 .cindex "lower casing"
11192 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11193 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
11194 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
11198 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11200 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11201 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
11202 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
11203 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
11204 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
11205 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
11207 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11209 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11210 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11211 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11212 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11215 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11216 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11217 .cindex "list" "item count"
11218 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11219 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11220 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11223 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11224 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11225 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11226 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11227 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11228 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11229 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11230 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11231 matching list is returned.
11232 &*Note*&: Neither string-expansion of lists referenced by named-list syntax elements,
11233 nor expansion of lookup elements, is done by the &%listnamed%& operator.
11236 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11237 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11238 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11239 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
11240 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
11242 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11245 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*& &&&
11246 &*${mask_n:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11247 .cindex "masked IP address"
11248 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11249 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11250 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11251 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11252 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11253 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11254 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11255 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11256 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11258 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11260 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&.
11262 Since this operation is expected to
11263 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the
11266 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11267 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11269 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11273 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11275 If the optional form &*mask_n*& is used, IPv6 address result are instead
11276 returned in normailsed form, using colons and with zero-compression.
11277 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11280 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11282 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11283 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11284 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11285 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11286 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11288 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11289 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11292 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11293 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11294 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11295 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11296 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11297 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11299 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11301 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11304 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11305 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11306 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11307 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11308 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11309 is an empty string or
11310 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11311 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11312 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11313 respectively For example,
11321 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11322 variable or a message header.
11324 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11325 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11326 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11327 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
11328 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11329 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11330 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11332 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11333 will likely use the quoting form.
11334 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11337 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11338 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11339 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11340 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11341 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11343 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11349 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11350 yields an unchanged string.
11353 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11354 .cindex "random number"
11355 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11356 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11357 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11358 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11359 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11360 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11361 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11362 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11366 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11367 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11368 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11369 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11370 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11371 for DNS. For example,
11373 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11374 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11379 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11383 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11384 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11385 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11386 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11387 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
11388 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11389 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11390 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11391 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11394 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11396 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11397 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11401 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11402 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11403 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11404 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11405 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
11406 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11407 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11408 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11410 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11411 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11412 to use this operator as well.
11416 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11417 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11418 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11419 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11420 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11421 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11422 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11425 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11426 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11427 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11428 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11429 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11430 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11431 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11433 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11434 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11437 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11438 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11439 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11440 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11441 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11442 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11443 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11444 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11445 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11446 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11448 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11450 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11451 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11453 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11454 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11455 Finally, if an underbar
11456 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11457 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11458 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11461 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11462 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11463 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11464 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11465 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11466 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11468 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11470 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11471 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11472 with 256 being the default.
11474 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11475 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11476 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11477 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11480 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11481 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11482 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11483 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11484 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11485 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11486 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11487 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11488 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11489 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11490 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11491 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11492 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11494 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11495 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11496 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11498 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11499 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11500 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11504 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11505 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11506 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11507 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11508 The item is replaced by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11509 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11510 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11513 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11514 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11515 .cindex "substring extraction"
11516 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11517 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11518 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11519 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11521 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11523 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11524 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11525 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11527 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11528 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11529 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11530 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11533 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11534 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11535 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11536 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11537 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11538 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11541 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11542 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11543 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11544 .cindex "upper casing"
11545 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11546 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11547 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11548 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11550 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11551 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11552 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11553 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11554 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11555 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11556 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11557 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11558 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11559 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11560 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11561 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11562 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11563 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11565 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11567 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11568 literal question mark).
11570 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11571 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11572 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11573 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11574 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11575 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11577 .cindex internationalisation
11578 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11579 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11580 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11581 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11582 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11583 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11586 .vitem &*${xtextd:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11587 .cindex "text forcing in strings"
11588 .cindex "string" "xtext decoding"
11590 .cindex "&%xtextd%& expansion item"
11591 This performs xtext decoding of the string (per RFC 3461 section 4).
11602 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11603 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11604 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11605 while expanding strings:
11608 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11609 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11610 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11611 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11614 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11615 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11616 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11617 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11619 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
11621 .irow "== " "equal"
11622 .irow "> " "greater"
11623 .irow ">= " "greater or equal"
11625 .irow "<= " "less or equal"
11629 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11631 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11632 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11633 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11634 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11635 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11638 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11639 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11640 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11643 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11644 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11645 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11646 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11647 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11648 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11649 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11650 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11651 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11652 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11653 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11654 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11655 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11656 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11658 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11659 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11660 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11661 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11662 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11663 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11665 An empty string is treated as false.
11666 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11667 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11668 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11670 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11671 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11674 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11678 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11679 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11680 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11681 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11682 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11683 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11684 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11685 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11687 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11689 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11690 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11691 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11692 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11693 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11694 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11695 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11696 included in the binary.
11698 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11699 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11700 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11701 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11702 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11703 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11704 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11705 string in LDAP form is:
11707 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11709 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11710 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11712 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11714 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11719 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11720 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11721 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11722 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11723 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11724 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11728 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11729 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11730 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11731 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11732 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11733 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11736 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11737 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11738 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11739 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11740 whatever its length.
11743 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11744 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11745 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11746 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11748 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11749 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11750 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11751 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11752 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11753 support &[crypt16()]&.
11755 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11756 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11757 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11758 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11759 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11761 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11762 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11763 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11765 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11766 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11767 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11768 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11769 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11771 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11772 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11773 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11774 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11775 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11776 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11778 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11780 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11781 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11783 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11784 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11785 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11786 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11787 exists in the message. For example,
11789 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11791 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11792 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11794 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11795 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11796 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11797 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11798 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11799 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11800 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11801 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11802 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11803 case is defined per the system C locale.
11805 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11806 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11807 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11808 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11809 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11810 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11811 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11812 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11814 &*Note:*& Testing a path using this condition is not a sufficient way of
11816 Consider using a dsearch lookup.
11818 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11819 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11820 .cindex "first delivery"
11821 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11822 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11823 .cindex retry condition
11824 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11825 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11828 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11829 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11830 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11831 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11832 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11834 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11835 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11836 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11837 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11838 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11839 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11841 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11842 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11843 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11845 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11846 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11847 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11849 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11850 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11851 that the condition must be false for at least one item.
11855 ${if forany{$recipients_list}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11857 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11858 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11860 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11862 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11863 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11864 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11865 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11866 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11867 .cindex JSON expansions
11868 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11869 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11870 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11871 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11872 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11874 The array separator is not changeable.
11875 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11876 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11880 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11881 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11882 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11883 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11884 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11885 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11886 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11887 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11888 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11890 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11892 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11893 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11894 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11895 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11896 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11897 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11898 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11899 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11900 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11902 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11905 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
11906 SRS decode. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
11909 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*& &&&
11910 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*&
11911 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11912 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11913 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11914 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11916 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11918 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11919 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11921 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11922 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11923 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11924 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11927 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
11928 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
11929 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
11930 .cindex "de-tainting" "using an inlist expansion condition"
11931 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
11933 ${if inlist {$h_mycode:} {0 : 1 : 42} {$value}}
11935 can be used for de-tainting.
11936 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
11939 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11940 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11941 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11942 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11943 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11944 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11945 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11946 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11947 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11948 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11949 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11951 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11952 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11953 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11954 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11955 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11957 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11958 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11960 This is no longer the case.
11962 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11963 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11965 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11967 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11969 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11970 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11971 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11972 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11973 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11974 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11975 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11976 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11977 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11978 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11979 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11980 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11981 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11985 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11986 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11987 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11988 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11989 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11990 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11991 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11992 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11993 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11995 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11997 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11998 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11999 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12000 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12001 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
12002 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
12003 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12004 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
12005 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
12007 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12010 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12011 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
12012 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
12013 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
12014 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
12015 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
12016 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
12017 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
12018 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
12019 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
12020 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
12023 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
12025 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
12026 backslashes is also required.
12028 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
12029 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
12030 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
12031 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
12032 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
12033 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
12034 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
12035 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
12037 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
12038 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
12039 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
12040 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
12041 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
12042 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
12043 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
12044 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
12046 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12047 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
12048 See &*match_local_part*&.
12050 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12051 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
12052 See &*match_local_part*&.
12054 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12055 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
12056 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
12057 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
12058 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
12059 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
12061 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
12063 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
12066 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
12068 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
12070 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
12071 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
12072 in a single test such as
12073 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12074 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
12075 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
12076 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
12078 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
12080 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
12082 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
12084 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists
12085 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&),
12086 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
12087 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
12088 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
12089 masks. For example:
12091 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
12093 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
12094 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
12095 address mask, for example:
12097 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
12099 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
12100 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
12102 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
12106 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12107 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12109 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
12111 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12112 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12113 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12115 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12116 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
12117 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
12118 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
12119 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
12120 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
12121 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
12122 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
12125 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
12127 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
12128 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
12129 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
12130 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
12132 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
12134 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
12135 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
12136 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
12137 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
12140 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12141 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12142 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12143 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a match_local_part expansion condition"
12144 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12146 ${if match_local_part {$local_part} {alice : bill : charlotte : dave} {$value}}
12148 can be used for de-tainting.
12149 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12151 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12152 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12154 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
12155 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
12156 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
12157 matched using &%match_ip%&.
12159 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
12160 .cindex "PAM authentication"
12161 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
12162 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
12163 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
12164 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
12165 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
12166 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
12167 available in Solaris
12168 and in some GNU/Linux distributions.
12169 The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
12170 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
12174 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
12175 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
12177 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
12178 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
12179 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
12180 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
12181 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
12182 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
12183 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
12185 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
12186 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
12188 The &%listquote%& expansion item can be used for this.
12189 For example, the configuration
12190 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
12192 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${listquote{:}{$auth2}}}}
12194 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
12195 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
12196 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
12197 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
12200 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12201 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
12203 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
12204 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
12205 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
12206 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
12207 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
12208 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
12210 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12211 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12212 building Exim. For example:
12214 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
12216 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12217 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12218 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
12219 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
12221 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
12222 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
12223 configuration, you might have this:
12225 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
12227 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
12229 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
12231 .vitem &*queue_running*&
12232 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
12233 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
12234 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
12235 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
12236 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
12239 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
12241 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
12242 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
12243 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
12244 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
12245 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
12248 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
12249 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
12250 this library, you need to set
12252 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
12254 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
12255 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
12257 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12259 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12260 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12261 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12263 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12264 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12265 the authentication is successful. For example:
12267 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12271 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12272 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12273 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12275 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12276 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12277 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12278 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12279 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12280 by a process that is not running as root.
12282 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12283 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12284 building Exim. For example:
12286 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12288 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12289 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12290 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12292 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12293 two are mandatory. For example:
12295 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12297 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12298 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12299 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12304 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12305 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12306 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12307 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12308 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12309 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12310 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12314 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12315 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12316 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12317 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12318 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12321 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12323 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12324 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12325 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12327 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12328 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12329 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12330 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12331 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12332 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12333 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12334 parsed but not evaluated.
12336 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12341 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12342 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12343 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12344 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12345 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12346 .cindex "tainted data"
12347 Variables marked as &'tainted'& are likely to carry data supplied by
12348 a potential attacker.
12349 Variables without such marking may also, depending on how their
12350 values are created.
12351 Such variables should not be further expanded,
12353 or used as command-line arguments for external commands.
12356 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12357 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12358 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12359 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12360 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12361 In the expansion condition case
12362 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12363 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12364 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12365 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12366 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12367 matching condition.
12368 If the subject string was tainted then any captured substring will also be.
12370 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12371 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12372 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12373 any unused variables being made empty.
12375 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12376 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12377 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12378 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12379 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12380 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12381 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12382 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12383 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12384 during subsequent delivery.
12386 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12387 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12388 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12389 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12390 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12391 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12392 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12393 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12396 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12397 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12398 this variable has the number of arguments.
12400 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12401 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12402 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12403 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers of the verb.
12404 The message can be preserved by coding like this:
12406 warn !verify = sender
12407 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12409 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12410 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12412 &*Note*&: The variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
12414 .vitem &$address_data$&
12415 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12416 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12417 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12418 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12419 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12420 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12423 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12424 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12425 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12426 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12427 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12428 from the child's routing.
12430 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12431 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12432 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12435 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12436 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12437 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12439 .vitem &$address_file$&
12440 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12441 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12442 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12443 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12444 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12446 /home/r2d2/savemail
12448 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12449 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12450 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12451 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12452 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12453 to the relevant file.
12455 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12456 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12457 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12458 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12460 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth4$&"
12461 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12462 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12463 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12465 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12466 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12467 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12468 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12469 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12470 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12471 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12472 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12473 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12475 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12476 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12477 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12478 command line option.
12479 This second case also sets up information used by the
12480 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12482 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12483 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12484 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12485 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12486 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12487 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12488 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12489 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12490 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12494 .tvar &$authenticated_sender$&
12495 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12496 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12497 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12498 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12499 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12500 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12501 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12502 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12503 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12505 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12506 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12507 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12508 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12509 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12512 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12513 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12514 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12515 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12516 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12517 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12518 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12519 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12520 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&).
12521 Failure includes cancellation of a authentication attempt,
12522 and any negative response to an AUTH command,
12523 (including, for example, an attempt to use an undefined mechanism).
12525 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12526 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12527 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12528 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12529 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12530 the ACL malware condition.
12532 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12533 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12534 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12535 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12536 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12537 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12539 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12540 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12541 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12542 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12543 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12544 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12545 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12547 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12548 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12549 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12550 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12551 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12553 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12554 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12555 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12556 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12557 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12559 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12560 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12561 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12562 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12563 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12564 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12565 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12567 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12568 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12569 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12570 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12571 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12572 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12573 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12575 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12576 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12577 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12578 address that was connected to.
12580 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12581 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12582 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12583 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12584 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12586 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12587 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12588 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12589 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12590 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12591 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12593 .vitem &$config_file$&
12594 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12595 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12597 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12598 Results of DKIM verification.
12599 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12601 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12602 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12603 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12604 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12605 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12607 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12608 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12609 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12610 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12611 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12612 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12613 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12614 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12615 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12616 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12617 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12618 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12619 &$dkim_key_length$&
12620 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12621 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12623 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12624 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12625 When a message has been received this variable contains
12626 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12627 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12629 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12630 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12631 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12632 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12633 Results of DMARC verification.
12634 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12636 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12637 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12638 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12640 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12641 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12642 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12643 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12644 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12645 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12646 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12647 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12648 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12651 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12652 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12653 case for &$domain$&.
12655 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12656 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12657 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12658 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12660 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12661 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12662 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12663 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12664 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12665 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12667 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12668 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12669 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12671 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12674 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12675 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12676 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12677 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12678 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12679 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12680 the &(smtp)& transport.
12683 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12684 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12685 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12686 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12689 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12690 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12691 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12692 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12693 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12694 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12697 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12698 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12699 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12700 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12703 .cindex "tainted data"
12704 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12705 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and may not
12706 be further expanded or used as a filename.
12707 When an untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12708 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12709 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12712 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12713 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12714 When the &%domains%& condition on a router
12717 against a list, the match value is copied to &$domain_data$&.
12718 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12719 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12720 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12722 If the router routes the
12723 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12724 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12727 &$domain_data$& set in an ACL is available during
12728 the rest of the ACL statement.
12730 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12731 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12732 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12734 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12735 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12736 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12738 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12739 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12740 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12742 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12743 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12744 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12745 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12746 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12747 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12748 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12750 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12752 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12753 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12754 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12755 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12756 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12758 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12759 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12760 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12761 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12762 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12766 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12767 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12768 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12769 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12770 by a setting on the transport itself.
12772 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12773 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12774 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12778 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12779 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12780 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12781 to local and remote transports.
12783 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12784 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12785 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12786 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12787 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12788 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12789 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12792 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12793 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12794 client is connected.
12797 .vitem &$host_address$&
12798 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12799 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12800 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12801 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12803 .vitem &$host_data$&
12804 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12805 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12806 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12807 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12809 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12810 message = $host_data
12813 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12814 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12815 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12816 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12817 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12818 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12819 variables is set to &"1"&.
12822 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12823 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12826 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12827 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12828 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12831 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12832 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12833 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12834 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12835 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12836 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12837 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12838 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12839 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12840 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12842 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12843 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12844 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12847 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12848 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12849 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12851 .vitem &$host_port$&
12852 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12853 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12854 for an outbound connection.
12856 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12857 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12858 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12859 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12860 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12861 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12864 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12865 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12866 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12867 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12868 a unique name for the file.
12870 .vitem &$interface_address$& &&&
12872 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12873 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12874 These are obsolete names for &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12878 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12879 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12880 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12884 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12885 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12886 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12889 .vitem &$load_average$&
12890 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12891 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12892 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12893 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12895 .tvar &$local_part$&
12896 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12897 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12898 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12899 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12901 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12902 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12903 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12904 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12907 .cindex "tainted data"
12908 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12909 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and
12910 may not be further expanded or used as a filename.
12912 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12914 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12916 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12917 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12918 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
12919 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12920 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12921 rather than this variable.
12922 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
12923 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12924 the retrieved data.
12926 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12927 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12928 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12931 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12932 local part of the recipient address.
12934 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12935 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12936 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12938 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12941 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12942 abc\:xyz@test.example
12944 the value of &$local_part$& is
12948 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12949 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12952 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12954 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12955 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12956 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12958 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12959 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12960 When the &%local_parts%& condition on a router or ACL
12961 matches a local part list
12962 the match value is copied to &$local_part_data$&.
12963 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12964 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12965 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12967 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
12969 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
12970 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
12971 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
12972 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
12973 .cindex affix variables
12974 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12975 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12976 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12977 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12978 .cindex "tainted data"
12979 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
12980 the affix variable value is not tainted.
12982 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
12983 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
12984 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
12985 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
12987 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12988 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12989 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12990 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12992 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12993 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12994 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12996 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12997 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12998 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12999 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
13000 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
13001 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
13002 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
13003 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
13005 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
13006 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13007 This contains the expanded value of the
13008 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
13011 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
13012 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13013 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
13014 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
13015 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
13016 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
13018 .vitem &$log_space$&
13019 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13020 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
13021 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
13022 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
13023 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
13024 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
13027 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
13028 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
13029 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
13030 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
13031 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13032 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
13033 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
13034 and &"yes"& if it was.
13035 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
13036 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
13037 as authenticated data.
13039 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
13040 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
13041 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
13042 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
13043 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
13044 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
13045 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
13048 .vitem &$malware_name$&
13049 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
13050 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
13051 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
13052 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
13054 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
13055 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
13056 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
13057 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
13058 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
13059 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
13061 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13063 .vitem &$message_age$&
13064 .cindex "message" "age of"
13065 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
13066 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
13067 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
13070 .tvar &$message_body$&
13071 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13072 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13073 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
13074 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
13075 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
13076 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
13077 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
13078 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
13080 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
13081 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
13082 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
13083 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
13084 zeros are always converted into spaces.
13086 .tvar &$message_body_end$&
13087 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13088 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13089 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
13090 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
13093 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
13094 .cindex "body of message" "size"
13095 .cindex "message body" "size"
13096 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
13097 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
13098 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
13099 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
13100 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13102 If the spool file is wireformat
13103 (see the &%spool_wireformat%& main option)
13104 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
13106 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
13107 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
13108 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
13109 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
13110 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
13111 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
13112 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
13113 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
13115 .tvar &$message_headers$&
13116 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
13117 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
13118 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
13119 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
13121 .tvar &$message_headers_raw$&
13122 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
13123 contents of header lines is done.
13125 .vitem &$message_id$&
13126 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
13128 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
13129 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
13130 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
13131 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
13132 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
13133 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
13134 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
13135 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
13136 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
13137 from the body is not counted.
13139 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
13140 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
13141 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
13142 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
13143 header and the body).
13145 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
13148 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
13149 message = Too many lines in message header
13151 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
13152 message has not yet been received.
13154 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13156 .vitem &$message_size$&
13157 .cindex "size" "of message"
13158 .cindex "message" "size"
13159 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
13160 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
13161 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
13162 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
13163 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
13164 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
13165 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
13166 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
13167 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13169 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
13170 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
13171 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
13172 value may not, of course, be truthful.
13174 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
13175 &$mime_anomaly_text$& &&&
13176 &$mime_boundary$& &&&
13177 &$mime_charset$& &&&
13178 &$mime_content_description$& &&&
13179 &$mime_content_disposition$& &&&
13180 &$mime_content_id$& &&&
13181 &$mime_content_size$& &&&
13182 &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$& &&&
13183 &$mime_content_type$& &&&
13184 &$mime_decoded_filename$& &&&
13185 &$mime_filename$& &&&
13186 &$mime_is_coverletter$& &&&
13187 &$mime_is_multipart$& &&&
13188 &$mime_is_rfc822$& &&&
13189 &$mime_part_count$&
13190 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
13191 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
13192 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
13194 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
13195 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
13196 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
13198 .tvar &$original_domain$&
13199 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13200 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13201 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
13202 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
13203 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
13204 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
13205 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
13206 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
13208 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13209 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13210 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13212 .tvar &$original_local_part$&
13213 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13214 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13215 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
13216 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
13217 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
13218 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
13219 the original address.
13221 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
13222 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
13223 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
13224 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
13225 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
13227 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13228 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13229 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13231 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
13232 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
13233 .cindex "sender" "gid"
13234 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
13235 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
13236 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
13237 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
13238 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
13239 normally the gid of the Exim user.
13241 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
13242 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
13243 .cindex "sender" "uid"
13244 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
13245 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
13246 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
13247 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
13248 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
13251 .tvar &$parent_domain$&
13252 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
13253 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13255 .tvar &$parent_local_part$&
13256 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
13257 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13260 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
13262 This variable contains the current process id.
13264 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
13265 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
13266 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13267 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13268 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13269 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13270 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13271 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13272 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13273 variable"& error if encountered.
13274 &*Note*&: This value permits data supplied by a potential attacker to
13275 be used in the command for a &(pipe)& transport.
13276 Such configurations should be carefully assessed for security vulnerbilities.
13278 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13279 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13280 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13281 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13282 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13283 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13284 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13287 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13288 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13289 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13290 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13292 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13294 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13296 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13297 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13298 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13299 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13301 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$& &&&
13302 &$prvscheck_keynum$& &&&
13303 &$prvscheck_result$&
13304 These variables are used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13305 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13306 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13308 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13309 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13310 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13312 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13313 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13314 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13315 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13317 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13318 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13319 .cindex "named queues" variable
13320 .cindex queues named
13321 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13323 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13324 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13325 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13326 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13327 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13328 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13329 If there is no daemon notifier socket open, the value will be
13334 .cindex router variables
13335 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13336 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13337 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13338 and the eventual transport.
13340 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13341 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13342 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13343 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13344 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13346 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13347 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13348 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13349 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13350 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13351 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13353 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13354 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13355 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13356 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13357 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13359 .vitem &$received_count$&
13360 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13361 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13362 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13363 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13366 .tvar &$received_for$&
13367 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13368 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13369 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13370 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13372 .vitem &$received_ip_address$& &&&
13374 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13375 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13376 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, these
13377 variables are set to the address and port on the local IP interface.
13378 (The remote IP address and port are in
13379 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13380 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13383 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13384 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13385 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13386 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13387 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13389 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13391 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13392 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13393 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13394 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13395 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13396 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13397 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13398 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13399 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13401 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13402 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13403 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13404 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13405 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13406 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13408 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13409 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13410 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13412 .vitem &$received_time$&
13413 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13414 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13415 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13417 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13418 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13419 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13420 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13421 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13423 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13424 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13426 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13427 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13428 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13429 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13431 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13432 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13433 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13434 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13437 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13438 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13441 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13444 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13445 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13449 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13452 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13455 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13456 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13458 .tvar &$recipients$&
13459 .tvar &$recipients_list$&
13460 These variables both contain the envelope recipients for a message.
13462 The first uses a comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
13463 &*Note*&: an address can legitimately contain a comma;
13464 this variable is not intended for further processing.
13466 The second is a proper Exim list; colon-separated.
13468 However, the variables
13469 are not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13470 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use either of them only in these
13474 In a system filter file.
13476 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13477 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13478 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13479 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13481 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13485 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13486 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13487 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13488 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13489 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13490 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13493 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13494 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13495 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13496 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13498 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13499 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13500 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13501 these variables contain the
13502 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13503 If the subject string was tainted then so will any captured substring.
13506 .tvar &$reply_address$&
13507 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13508 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13509 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13510 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13511 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13513 .vitem &$return_path$&
13514 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13515 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13516 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13517 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13518 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13519 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13520 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13521 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13522 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13523 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13526 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13527 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13528 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13530 .vitem &$router_name$&
13531 .cindex "router" "name"
13532 .cindex "name" "of router"
13533 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13534 During the running of a router, or a transport called,
13535 this variable contains the router name.
13538 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13539 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13540 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13541 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13542 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13543 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13544 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13547 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13548 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13549 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13550 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13551 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13552 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13553 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13554 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13556 .tvar &$sender_address$&
13557 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13558 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13559 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13560 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13562 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13563 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13564 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13565 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13566 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13567 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13568 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13569 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13571 .tvar &$sender_address_domain$&
13572 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13574 .tvar &$sender_address_local_part$&
13575 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13577 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13578 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13579 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13580 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13581 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13584 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13585 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13587 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13588 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13589 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13590 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13592 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13593 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13594 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13595 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13596 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13597 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13598 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13599 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13600 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13601 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13602 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13603 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13604 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13606 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13607 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13608 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13609 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13610 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13612 .tvar &$sender_helo_name$&
13613 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13614 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13615 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13616 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13618 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13619 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13620 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13621 this variable contains that
13622 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13624 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13625 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13626 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13627 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13628 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13629 &$authenticated_id$&.
13631 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13632 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13633 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13634 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13635 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13636 resolver library states that both
13637 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13638 other times, this variable is false.
13640 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13641 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13642 library, by setting:
13647 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13648 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13649 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13650 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13651 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13652 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13657 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13658 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13660 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13661 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13663 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13664 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13665 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13666 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13669 .tvar &$sender_host_name$&
13670 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13671 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13672 other means, this variable is empty.
13674 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13675 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13676 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13677 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13678 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13679 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13680 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13682 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13683 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13684 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13685 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13687 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13688 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13689 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13692 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13693 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13694 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13695 following are true:
13698 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13700 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13701 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13702 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13704 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13705 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13706 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13708 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13709 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13710 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13712 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13713 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13714 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13715 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13717 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13719 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13720 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13724 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13725 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13726 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13727 number that was used on the remote host.
13729 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13730 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13731 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13732 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13733 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13736 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13737 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13738 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13739 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13741 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13742 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13743 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13744 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13745 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13746 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13747 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13748 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13749 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13750 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13751 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13754 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13755 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13756 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13757 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13758 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13760 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13761 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13762 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13763 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13764 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13766 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13767 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13768 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13769 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13770 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13771 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13772 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13774 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13775 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13776 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13777 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13778 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13780 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13781 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13782 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13783 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13784 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13785 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13787 .tvar &$smtp_command$&
13788 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13789 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13790 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13795 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13796 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13797 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13798 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13800 .tvar &$smtp_command_argument$&
13801 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13802 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13803 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13804 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13805 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13807 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13808 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13809 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13810 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13811 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13814 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13815 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13816 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13817 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13818 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13819 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13820 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13821 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13822 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13823 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13824 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13826 .vitem &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
13827 .vindex "&$smtp_notquit_reason$&"
13828 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, this variable is set to a string
13829 that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP connection.
13831 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13832 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13833 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13834 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13835 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13836 message is junk mail.
13838 .vitem &$spam_score$& &&&
13839 &$spam_score_int$& &&&
13841 &$spam_report$& &&&
13843 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13844 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13845 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13847 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13848 &$spf_received$& &&&
13850 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13851 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13852 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13853 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13855 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13856 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13857 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13859 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13860 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13861 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13862 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13863 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13864 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13866 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13867 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13868 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13869 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13870 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13871 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13872 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13873 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13875 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13877 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13880 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13881 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13882 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13883 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13884 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13885 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13887 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13888 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13889 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13890 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13891 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13892 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13893 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13894 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13896 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13897 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13900 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13901 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13902 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13903 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13904 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13905 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13907 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13908 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13909 .cindex certificate variables
13910 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13911 inbound connection when the message was received.
13912 It is only useful as the argument of a
13913 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13914 or a &%def%& condition.
13916 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13917 when a list of more than one
13918 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13919 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13921 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13922 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13923 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13924 inbound connection when the message was received.
13925 It is only useful as the argument of a
13926 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13927 or a &%def%& condition.
13928 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13929 which is not the leaf.
13931 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13932 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13933 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13934 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13935 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13936 or a &%def%& condition.
13938 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13939 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13940 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13941 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13942 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13943 or a &%def%& condition.
13944 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13945 which is not the leaf.
13947 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13948 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13949 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13950 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13952 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13953 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13956 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13957 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13958 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13959 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13960 and &"0"& otherwise.
13962 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13963 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13964 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13965 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13966 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13967 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13968 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13969 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13970 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13972 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13973 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13974 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13976 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13977 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13978 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13980 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13981 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13983 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13984 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13985 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13986 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13988 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13989 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13990 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13992 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13993 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13994 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13996 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13997 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13998 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13999 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
14001 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
14002 1 No response to request
14003 2 Response not verified
14004 3 Verification failed
14005 4 Verification succeeded
14008 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
14009 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
14010 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
14011 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
14012 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
14014 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
14015 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
14016 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
14017 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
14018 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14019 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
14020 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14021 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14022 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14023 which is not the leaf.
14025 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
14026 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14029 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
14030 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
14031 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14032 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
14033 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14034 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14035 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14036 which is not the leaf.
14039 .vitem &$tls_in_resumption$& &&&
14040 &$tls_out_resumption$&
14041 .vindex &$tls_in_resumption$&
14042 .vindex &$tls_out_resumption$&
14043 .cindex TLS resumption
14044 Observability for TLS session resumption. See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
14047 .tvar &$tls_in_sni$&
14048 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
14049 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14051 .cindex SNI "observability on server"
14052 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
14053 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
14054 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
14055 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
14056 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
14057 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
14058 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
14060 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
14061 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14064 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
14065 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
14066 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14068 .cindex SNI "observability in client"
14070 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
14073 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14074 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14075 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14077 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
14078 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
14079 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14080 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
14082 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
14083 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
14084 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14085 this variable is set to the protocol version.
14088 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
14089 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
14090 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
14091 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
14093 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
14094 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
14095 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14097 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
14098 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
14099 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14101 .vitem &$tod_full$&
14102 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
14103 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
14104 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
14105 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
14106 values for those that are behind (west).
14109 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14110 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
14111 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
14113 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
14114 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
14115 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
14116 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
14119 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
14120 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14121 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
14124 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
14125 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
14126 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
14127 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
14129 .vitem &$transport_name$&
14130 .cindex "transport" "name"
14131 .cindex "name" "of transport"
14132 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
14133 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
14136 .vindex "&$value$&"
14137 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
14138 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
14139 &*reduce*& expansion.
14141 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
14142 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
14143 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
14144 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
14147 .vitem &$version_number$&
14148 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
14149 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
14150 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
14152 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
14153 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
14154 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14155 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14157 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
14158 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
14159 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14160 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14169 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
14170 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
14171 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
14172 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
14173 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
14174 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
14179 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
14182 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
14183 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
14184 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
14185 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
14186 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
14187 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
14188 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
14189 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
14190 a newly created Perl interpreter.
14192 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
14193 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
14194 should usually be something like
14196 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
14198 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
14199 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
14200 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
14201 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
14202 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
14203 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
14204 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
14205 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
14209 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
14210 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
14211 a startup when Exim is entered.
14213 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
14214 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
14217 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
14218 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
14221 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
14222 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
14223 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
14224 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
14225 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
14226 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
14229 &*Note*&: This is entirely separate from Exim's tainted-data tracking.
14232 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
14233 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
14234 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
14235 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
14239 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
14240 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
14242 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
14243 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
14244 with an error message of the form
14246 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
14248 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
14249 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
14250 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
14251 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
14252 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
14253 that was passed to &%die%&.
14256 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
14257 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
14258 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
14261 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
14263 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
14264 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
14265 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
14267 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
14268 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
14269 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
14270 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
14272 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
14273 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
14274 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
14275 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
14276 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
14277 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
14278 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
14281 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
14282 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14283 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14284 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14285 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14286 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14287 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14288 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14289 avoided, but the output is lost.
14291 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14292 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14293 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14294 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14295 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14296 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14297 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14299 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14301 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14302 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14303 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14304 as the first subroutine argument.
14308 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14309 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14311 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14312 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14313 "Starting the daemon"
14314 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14315 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14316 .cindex "network interface"
14317 .cindex "interface" "network"
14318 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14319 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14320 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14321 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14322 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14323 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14324 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14325 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14326 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14327 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14328 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14331 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14332 and ports to listen on.
14334 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14335 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14336 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14337 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14338 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14339 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14340 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14341 as an error situation.
14343 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14344 for the outgoing connection.
14348 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14349 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14350 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14351 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14352 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14354 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14355 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14356 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14357 chapter describes how they operate.
14359 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14360 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14364 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14365 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14366 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14370 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14372 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14374 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14375 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14378 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14379 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14380 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14381 colons. For example:
14383 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14386 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14388 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14389 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14392 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14393 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14395 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14396 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14399 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14400 with a colon separator, for example:
14402 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14403 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14407 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14408 default setting contains just one port:
14410 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14412 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14413 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14414 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14415 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14416 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14420 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14421 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14422 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14423 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14424 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14425 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14427 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14429 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14431 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14433 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14437 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14438 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14439 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14440 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14441 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14442 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14445 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14446 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14447 If there are any items that do not
14448 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14449 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14450 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14451 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14455 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14458 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14460 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14461 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14462 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14466 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14467 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14468 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14469 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14470 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14471 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14472 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14473 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14474 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14475 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14476 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14477 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14478 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14481 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14482 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14483 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14485 The common use of this option is expected to be
14487 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14490 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14491 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14493 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14494 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14495 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14496 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14497 connections via the daemon.)
14502 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14503 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14504 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14505 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14506 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14507 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14508 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14509 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14511 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14513 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14514 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14515 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14516 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14517 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14518 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14520 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14522 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14523 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14524 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14525 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14526 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14528 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14529 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14530 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14531 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14532 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14533 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14534 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14535 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14536 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14537 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14538 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14539 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14541 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14542 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14543 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14544 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14545 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14549 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14550 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14552 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14553 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14555 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14556 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14557 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14558 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14560 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14562 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14564 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14566 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14567 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14569 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14570 IPv4 loopback address only:
14572 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14574 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14576 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14578 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14582 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14583 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14584 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14585 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14588 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14589 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14590 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14591 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14593 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14594 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14595 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14596 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14597 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14598 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14599 used for listening. Consider this example:
14601 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14603 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14605 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14607 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14608 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14611 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14612 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14613 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14614 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14615 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14616 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14617 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14618 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14622 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14623 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14624 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14625 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14626 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14627 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14633 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14634 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14636 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14637 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14638 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14639 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14642 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14643 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14645 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14646 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14647 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14649 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14650 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14651 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14652 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14656 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14657 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14658 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14659 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14660 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14661 listed in more than one group.
14663 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14665 .row &%add_environment%& "environment variables"
14666 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14667 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14668 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14669 .row &%keep_environment%& "environment variables"
14670 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14671 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14672 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14673 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14674 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14675 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14676 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14677 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14681 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14683 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14684 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14685 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14686 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14687 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14688 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14693 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14695 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14696 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14697 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14698 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14699 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14700 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14701 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14702 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14703 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14704 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14705 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14706 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14711 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14713 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14714 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14715 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14716 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14717 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14718 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14719 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14720 .row &%panic_coredump%& "request coredump on fatal errors"
14721 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14722 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14723 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14724 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14725 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14726 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14727 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14728 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14733 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14735 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14736 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14737 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14738 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14743 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14745 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14746 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14747 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14748 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14749 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14750 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14751 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14752 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14753 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14754 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14755 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14756 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14757 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14758 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14759 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14764 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14766 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14767 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14772 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14774 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14775 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14776 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14781 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14783 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14784 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14785 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14786 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14787 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14788 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14789 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14790 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14791 .row &%smtp_backlog_monitor%& "level to log listen backlog"
14796 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14798 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14799 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14800 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14801 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14802 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14803 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14804 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14805 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14806 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14807 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14808 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14809 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14810 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14811 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14812 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14813 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14815 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14816 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14817 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14818 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14819 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14824 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14826 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14827 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14828 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14829 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14830 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14831 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14832 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14833 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14834 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14835 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14836 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14837 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14838 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14839 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14840 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14841 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14842 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14843 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14844 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14845 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14846 .row &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
14847 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14848 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14850 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14851 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14852 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14853 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14854 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14855 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14856 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14857 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14858 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14859 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14860 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14861 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14862 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14863 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14864 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14865 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14866 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14867 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14868 .row &%proxy_protocol_timeout%& "timeout for proxy protocol negotiation"
14869 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14870 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14871 .row &%spf_smtp_comment_template%& "template for &$spf_smtp_comment$&"
14876 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14878 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14880 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14882 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14883 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14884 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14889 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14891 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14892 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14893 .row &%hosts_require_alpn%& "mandatory ALPN"
14894 .row &%hosts_require_helo%& "mandatory HELO/EHLO"
14895 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14896 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14897 .row &%tls_alpn%& "acceptable protocol names"
14898 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14899 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14900 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14901 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14902 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14903 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14904 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14905 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14906 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14907 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14908 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14909 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14910 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14915 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14917 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14918 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14919 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14920 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14921 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14922 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14923 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14924 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14929 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14931 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14932 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14933 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14934 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14935 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14936 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14937 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14938 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14944 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14946 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14953 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14954 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14957 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14958 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14959 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
14960 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14961 .row &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& "DMARC sender for report messages"
14962 .row &%dmarc_history_file%& "DMARC results log"
14963 .row &%dmarc_tld_file%& "DMARC toplevel domains file"
14964 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14965 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14966 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14967 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14968 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14969 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14970 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14971 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14972 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14973 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14974 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14975 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14976 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14977 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14979 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14980 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14981 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14982 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14983 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14984 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14985 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14986 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14987 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14988 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14989 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14990 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14991 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14992 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14993 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14994 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14999 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
15001 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
15002 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
15003 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
15004 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
15005 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
15006 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
15007 .row &%limits_advertise_hosts%& "advertise LIMITS to these hosts"
15008 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15009 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15010 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
15011 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
15012 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
15013 .row &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%& "advertise WELLKNOWN to these hosts"
15018 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
15020 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
15021 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
15022 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
15023 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
15025 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15026 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15027 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
15028 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
15029 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
15030 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
15031 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15032 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
15033 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
15034 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
15039 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
15041 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
15042 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
15044 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
15045 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
15046 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
15047 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
15048 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
15053 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
15055 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
15056 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
15057 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
15058 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
15059 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
15060 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
15061 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
15062 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
15063 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
15064 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
15065 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
15066 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
15067 .row &%queue_fast_ramp%& "parallel delivery with 2-phase queue run"
15068 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
15069 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
15070 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
15071 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
15072 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
15073 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
15074 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
15075 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
15076 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
15077 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
15078 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
15079 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
15084 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
15086 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
15087 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
15088 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
15089 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
15090 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
15091 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
15092 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
15093 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
15094 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
15095 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
15096 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
15097 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
15098 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
15099 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15100 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
15105 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
15106 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
15109 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
15111 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15112 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15113 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
15114 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
15115 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
15116 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
15117 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
15118 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
15120 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
15121 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
15122 It now defaults to true.
15123 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
15125 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
15128 To log received 8BITMIME status use
15130 log_selector = +8bitmime
15133 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
15134 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
15135 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15136 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
15137 read and is on the point of being accepted. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for
15140 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15141 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
15142 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
15145 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
15146 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
15147 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15148 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
15149 non-SMTP message. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for further details.
15151 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
15152 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
15153 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
15154 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
15156 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15157 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15159 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
15160 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
15161 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
15162 See section &<<SECconnectACL>>& for further details.
15164 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
15165 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
15166 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
15167 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
15168 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECdataACLS>>& for further details.
15170 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
15171 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
15172 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
15173 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
15174 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
15175 This option defines the ACL that,
15176 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
15177 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
15178 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
15179 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>& for further details.
15181 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
15182 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
15183 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
15184 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
15185 of a received message.
15186 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
15188 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
15189 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
15190 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
15191 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15193 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
15194 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
15195 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
15196 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15198 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
15199 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
15200 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
15201 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
15202 command is received. See section &<<SECheloACL>>& for further details.
15205 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
15206 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
15207 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
15208 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15210 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
15211 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
15212 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
15214 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15215 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15217 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15218 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
15219 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
15220 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
15221 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
15223 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
15224 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
15225 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
15226 ends without a QUIT command being received.
15227 See section &<<SECTNOTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15229 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
15230 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
15231 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15234 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
15235 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
15236 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
15237 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15239 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
15240 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
15241 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
15242 received. See section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15244 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
15245 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
15246 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
15247 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15249 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
15250 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
15251 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
15252 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15254 .option acl_smtp_wellknown main string&!! unset
15255 .cindex "WELLKNOWN, ACL for"
15256 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP WELLKNOWN command is
15257 received. See section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>& for further details.
15259 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
15260 .cindex "environment" "set values"
15261 This option adds individual environment variables that the
15262 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
15263 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
15265 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
15267 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15268 .cindex "admin user"
15269 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
15270 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
15271 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
15272 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
15273 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
15274 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
15275 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
15277 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
15278 .cindex "domain literal"
15279 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
15280 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
15281 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
15282 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
15284 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
15285 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
15286 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
15287 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
15288 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
15289 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
15290 the local host's IP addresses.
15292 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
15293 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
15294 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
15295 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
15296 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
15297 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
15298 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
15299 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
15300 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
15302 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
15303 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
15304 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
15305 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15306 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15307 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15308 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15310 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15311 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15312 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15314 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15315 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15316 this option can be left as default.
15318 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15319 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15320 suitable setting is:
15322 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15323 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15325 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15327 dns_check_names_pattern =
15329 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15332 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15333 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15334 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15335 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15336 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15337 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15338 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15339 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15340 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15341 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15342 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15343 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15345 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15346 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15347 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15348 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15349 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15350 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15352 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15353 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15354 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15355 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15357 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15359 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15360 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15361 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15362 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15365 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15366 .cindex "thawing messages"
15367 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15368 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15369 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15370 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15371 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15372 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15374 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15375 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15376 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15379 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15380 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15381 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15383 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15385 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15386 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15389 .option bi_command main string unset
15391 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15392 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15393 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15394 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15397 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15398 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15399 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15400 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15401 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15402 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15403 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15404 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15405 absolute and untainted.
15406 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15409 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15410 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15411 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15412 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15414 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15415 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15416 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15417 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15418 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15419 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15420 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15421 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15422 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15423 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15425 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15426 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15427 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15428 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15429 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15430 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15431 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15432 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15433 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15434 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15436 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15437 during reception of a message.
15438 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15440 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15443 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15444 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15445 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15446 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15449 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15450 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15451 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15452 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15453 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15454 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15455 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15456 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15457 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15459 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15460 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15461 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15462 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15463 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15466 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15467 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15468 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15469 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15470 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15471 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15472 connection. A typical setting might be:
15474 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15476 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15478 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15480 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15483 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15484 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15485 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15486 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15487 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15488 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15491 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15492 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15493 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15494 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15497 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15498 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15499 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15500 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15503 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15504 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15505 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15506 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15509 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15510 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15511 callout verification. The default value is
15513 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15515 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15518 .options check_log_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15519 check_log_space main integer 10M
15520 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15522 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15523 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15524 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15525 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15526 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15527 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15528 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15529 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15530 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15531 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15534 .options check_spool_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15535 check_spool_space main integer 10M
15536 .cindex "checking disk space"
15537 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15538 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15539 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15540 message is accepted.
15542 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15543 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15544 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15545 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15546 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15547 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15548 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15549 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15552 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15553 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15555 check_spool_space = 100M
15556 check_spool_inodes = 100
15558 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15559 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15562 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15563 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15564 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15566 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15567 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15568 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15569 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15570 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15571 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15573 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15574 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15575 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15577 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15578 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15579 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15581 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15582 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15583 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15584 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15586 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15587 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15588 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15589 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15590 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15592 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15594 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15595 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15596 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15597 administrative user.
15598 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15600 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15601 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15602 .cindex memory debugging
15603 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15604 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15605 it should normally be left as default.
15607 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15608 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15609 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15610 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15611 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15612 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15614 .options daemon_startup_retries main integer 9 &&&
15615 daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15616 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15617 These options control the retrying done by
15618 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15619 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15620 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15621 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15623 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15624 .cindex "warning of delay"
15625 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15626 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15627 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15628 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15629 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15630 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15631 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15632 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15635 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15637 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15638 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15639 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15640 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15644 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15645 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15647 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15649 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15650 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15651 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15653 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15654 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15655 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15656 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15657 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15658 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15659 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15660 not sent. The default is:
15662 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15663 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15664 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15665 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15668 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15669 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15670 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15671 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15673 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15674 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15675 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15676 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15677 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15678 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15679 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15680 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15682 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15683 .cindex "load average"
15684 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15685 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15686 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15687 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15688 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15691 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15692 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15693 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15694 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15695 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15696 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15697 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15698 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15700 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15701 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15702 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15703 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15704 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15705 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15706 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15707 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15709 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15710 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15711 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15712 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15715 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15716 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15717 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15718 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15719 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15720 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15721 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15724 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15725 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15726 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15727 and an order of processing.
15728 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15730 Acceptable values include:
15737 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15739 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15740 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15741 and an order of processing.
15742 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15745 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15746 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15747 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15748 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15750 The default enforces the RFC 8301 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15752 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15753 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15756 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15757 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15758 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15759 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15760 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15761 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15764 .option dmarc_forensic_sender main string&!! unset &&&
15765 dmarc_history_file main string unset &&&
15766 dmarc_tld_file main string unset
15767 .cindex DMARC "main section options"
15768 These options control DMARC processing.
15769 See section &<<SECDMARC>>& for details.
15772 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15773 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15774 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15775 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15776 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15777 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15778 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15779 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15780 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15781 by a setting such as this:
15783 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15785 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does,
15786 except for TLSA lookups (where knowing about such failures
15787 is security-relevant).
15788 It also applies when the
15789 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15790 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15791 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15792 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15793 options are applied after this global option.
15795 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15796 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15797 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15798 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15799 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15800 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15801 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15802 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15803 value of this option. The default pattern is
15805 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15806 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15808 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15809 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15810 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15811 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15812 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15815 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15816 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15817 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15819 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15820 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15821 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15822 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15824 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15825 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15826 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15827 not do it internally.
15828 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15829 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15831 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15832 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15833 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15836 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15837 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15838 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15839 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15840 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15841 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15843 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15845 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
15846 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
15847 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
15848 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
15849 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
15850 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
15856 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15857 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15858 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15859 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15860 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15861 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15862 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15863 domain matches this list.
15865 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15866 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15867 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15868 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15869 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15870 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15873 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15874 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15875 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15876 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15877 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15878 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15879 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15880 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15881 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15882 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15883 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15884 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15886 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15889 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15890 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15893 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15894 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15895 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15896 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15897 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15898 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15899 match with this expanded domain list.
15901 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15902 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15903 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15904 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15905 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15906 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15908 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15909 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15910 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15912 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15913 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15914 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15915 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15916 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15918 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15919 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15920 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15921 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15922 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15923 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15924 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15925 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15928 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15930 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15931 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15932 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15935 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15936 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15937 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15938 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15940 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15941 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15942 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15943 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15944 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
15945 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15946 and accepted from, these hosts.
15947 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ORCPT options on RCPT TO commands,
15948 and RET and ENVID options on MAIL FROM commands.
15949 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15950 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15952 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
15953 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
15955 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15956 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15957 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15958 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15959 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15960 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15962 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15964 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15965 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15967 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15968 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15969 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15970 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15971 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15972 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15973 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15974 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15975 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15978 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15979 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15980 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15981 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15982 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15983 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15984 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15985 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15986 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15988 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15989 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15990 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15991 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15992 are examined. For example:
15994 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15995 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15996 postmaster@mydomain.example
15998 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15999 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16000 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
16001 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
16002 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
16003 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
16004 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
16007 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
16008 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
16009 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
16011 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
16013 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
16014 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
16015 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
16016 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
16017 overrides the default.
16019 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
16020 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
16021 and warning messages. For example:
16023 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
16025 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
16026 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
16027 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
16028 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
16032 .option event_action main string&!! unset
16034 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
16035 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
16038 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
16039 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
16040 .cindex "Exim group"
16041 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16042 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
16043 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
16044 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
16045 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
16049 .option exim_path main string "see below"
16050 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
16051 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
16052 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
16053 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
16054 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
16056 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
16057 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
16058 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
16059 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
16062 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
16063 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
16064 .cindex "Exim user"
16065 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16066 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
16067 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
16068 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
16070 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
16071 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
16072 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
16073 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
16076 .option exim_version main string "current version"
16077 .cindex "Exim version"
16078 .cindex customizing "version number"
16079 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
16080 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
16081 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
16084 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
16085 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
16086 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
16087 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
16090 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16091 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16093 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
16094 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
16096 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
16097 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
16098 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
16099 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
16100 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
16101 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
16102 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
16103 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
16104 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
16105 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
16109 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
16110 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
16111 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
16112 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
16113 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
16114 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
16115 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
16116 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
16119 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
16120 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
16121 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
16122 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
16126 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
16127 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16128 .cindex "frozen messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16129 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
16130 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
16131 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
16132 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
16133 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
16134 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
16135 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
16136 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
16137 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
16138 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
16139 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
16140 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
16141 logging that you require.
16144 .options gecos_name main string&!! unset &&&
16145 gecos_pattern main string unset
16147 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
16148 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
16149 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
16150 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
16151 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
16152 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
16153 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
16154 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
16156 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
16157 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
16158 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
16161 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
16162 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
16163 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
16164 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
16166 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
16171 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
16172 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
16173 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
16174 implementations of TLS.
16177 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
16178 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
16179 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
16182 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
16187 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
16188 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
16189 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
16190 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
16191 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
16192 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
16196 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
16197 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
16198 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
16199 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
16200 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
16201 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
16202 sections are rejected.
16205 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
16206 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
16207 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
16208 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
16209 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
16210 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
16211 zero means &"no limit"&.
16216 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16217 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
16218 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
16219 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
16220 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
16221 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
16222 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
16223 if you want to do semantic checking.
16224 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
16228 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
16229 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
16230 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
16231 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
16232 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
16233 non-ip-literal EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
16234 hyphens, and dots. For examplem if you really must allow underscores,
16237 helo_allow_chars = _
16239 This option does not apply to names that look like ip-literals.
16240 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
16243 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
16244 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16245 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16246 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
16247 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
16248 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
16249 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
16253 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16254 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
16255 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
16256 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
16257 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
16258 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
16259 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
16260 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
16261 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
16262 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
16263 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
16264 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
16266 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
16267 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
16268 EHLO command either:
16271 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
16273 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
16274 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
16275 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
16276 calling host address, or
16278 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
16281 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
16282 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
16283 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
16285 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
16286 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16287 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
16289 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16290 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
16291 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
16292 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
16293 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
16294 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
16295 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
16296 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
16297 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16300 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16301 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16302 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16303 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16304 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16305 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16306 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16307 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16308 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16310 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16311 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16312 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16313 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16314 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16316 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16317 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16318 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16319 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16322 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16323 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16324 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16325 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16326 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16327 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16328 default configuration file contains
16332 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16333 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16335 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16336 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16337 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16339 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16340 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16341 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16342 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16343 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16344 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16347 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16348 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16349 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16350 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16351 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16354 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16355 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16356 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16357 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16361 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16362 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16363 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16364 as soon as the connection is made.
16365 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16366 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16367 connections immediately.
16369 If the connection is on a TLS-on-connect port then the TCP connection is
16370 just dropped. Otherwise, an SMTP error is sent first.
16372 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16373 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16374 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16375 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16376 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16379 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16380 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16381 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16382 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16383 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16384 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16385 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16386 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16387 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16389 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16391 The hosts affected by this option also do not log "no MAIL in SMTP connection"
16392 lines, as may commonly be produced by a monitoring system.
16395 .option hosts_require_alpn main "host list&!!" unset
16396 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in server"
16398 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
16399 If the TLS library supports ALPN
16400 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any client
16401 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
16402 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
16404 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
16405 managed by this option, and should be done separately.
16408 .option hosts_require_helo main "host list&!!" *
16409 .cindex "HELO/EHLO" requiring
16410 Exim will require an accepted HELO or EHLO command from a host matching
16411 this list, before accepting a MAIL command.
16414 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16415 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16416 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16417 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16420 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16421 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16422 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16423 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16424 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16426 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16427 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16429 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16430 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16431 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16432 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16433 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16434 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16435 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16438 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16439 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16440 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16441 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16442 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16446 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16447 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16448 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16449 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16450 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16451 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16453 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16454 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16455 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16456 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16457 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16458 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16459 for frozen messages. For example,
16461 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16463 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16464 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16465 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16466 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16467 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16468 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16471 .options ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
16472 ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16473 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16474 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16475 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16476 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16477 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16478 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16479 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16480 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16481 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16485 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16486 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16487 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16488 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16489 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16490 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16491 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16492 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16493 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16495 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16496 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16498 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16499 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16500 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16501 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16503 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16504 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16505 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16508 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16509 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16510 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16514 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16515 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16516 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16517 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16521 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16522 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16523 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16524 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16525 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16526 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16527 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16528 and constrained to be a directory.
16531 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16532 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16533 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16534 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16535 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16536 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16537 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16538 and constrained to be a file.
16541 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16542 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16543 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16544 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16545 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16546 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16549 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16550 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16551 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16552 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16553 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16554 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16555 identity to be proven.
16558 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16559 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16560 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16561 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16562 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16565 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16566 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16567 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16568 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16569 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16573 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16574 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16575 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16576 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16577 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16578 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16582 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16583 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16584 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16585 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16586 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16588 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16589 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16590 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16593 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16594 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16595 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16596 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16597 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16598 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16599 has been built with LDAP support.
16603 .option limits_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16604 .cindex LIMITS "suppressing advertising"
16605 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
16606 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16607 LIMITS extension (RFC 9422) to specific hosts.
16608 If permitted, Exim as a servier will advertise in the EHLO response
16609 the limit for RCPT commands set by the &%recipients_max%& option (if it is set)
16610 and the limit for MAIL commands set by the &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%&
16613 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16614 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16615 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16616 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16617 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16618 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16619 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16621 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16622 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16623 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16625 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16626 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16627 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16628 and the default qualify domain.
16630 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16631 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16632 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16633 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16635 .cindex "envelope from"
16636 .cindex "envelope sender"
16637 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16638 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16639 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16641 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16642 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16643 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16648 .options local_from_prefix main string unset &&&
16649 local_from_suffix main string unset
16650 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16651 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16652 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16653 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16654 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16655 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16658 local_from_prefix = *-
16660 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16662 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16664 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16665 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16669 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16670 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16671 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16672 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16673 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16674 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16675 &%local_interfaces%& is
16677 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16679 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16681 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16684 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16685 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16686 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16687 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16688 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16689 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16690 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16691 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16695 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16696 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16697 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16698 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16699 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16700 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16701 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16702 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16707 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16708 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16709 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16710 .cindex multiple "systems sharing a spool"
16711 .cindex "multiple hosts" "sharing a spool"
16712 .cindex "shared spool directory"
16713 .cindex "spool directory" sharing
16714 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16715 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16716 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required
16717 (eg. because they share a spool directory),
16718 each host must set a different
16719 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16720 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16721 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16722 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16723 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16724 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number%& is set, the final four
16725 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16726 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16727 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16731 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16732 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16733 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16734 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16735 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16736 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16737 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16738 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16739 A path must start with a slash.
16740 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16741 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16742 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16743 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16744 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16745 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16746 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16747 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16750 .option log_selector main string unset
16751 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16752 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16753 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16754 minus characters. For example:
16756 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16758 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16759 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16762 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16763 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16764 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16765 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16766 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16767 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16768 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16769 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16770 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16771 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16772 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16773 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16774 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16777 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16778 .cindex "too many open files"
16779 .cindex "open files, too many"
16780 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16781 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16782 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16783 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16784 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16785 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16786 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16787 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16788 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16789 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16790 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16791 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16794 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16795 .cindex "length of login name"
16796 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16797 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16798 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16799 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16800 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16801 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16804 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16805 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16806 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16807 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16808 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16809 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16810 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16811 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16814 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16815 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16816 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16817 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16818 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16819 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16820 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16823 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16824 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16825 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16826 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16827 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16828 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16829 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16830 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16831 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16832 empty string, the option is ignored.
16835 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16836 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16837 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16838 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16839 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16840 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16841 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16842 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16843 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16844 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16845 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16846 colons will become hyphens.
16849 .option message_logs main boolean true
16850 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16851 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16852 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16853 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16854 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16855 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16856 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16857 which is not affected by this option.
16860 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16861 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16862 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16863 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16864 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16865 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16866 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16867 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16868 optionally followed by K or M.
16870 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
16871 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
16872 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
16873 service extension keyword.
16875 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16876 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16877 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16878 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16879 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16881 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16882 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16883 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16884 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16885 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16886 message that an individual transport can process.
16888 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16889 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16890 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16891 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16892 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16893 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16894 some problems may result.
16896 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16897 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16898 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16901 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16902 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16903 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16905 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16907 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16908 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16909 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16910 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16911 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16914 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16915 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16916 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16917 contains a full description of this facility.
16921 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16922 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16923 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16924 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16925 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16928 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16929 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16930 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16931 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16932 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16935 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16936 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16937 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16938 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16939 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16941 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16942 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16945 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16947 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16948 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16952 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
16953 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
16954 listens for work and information-requests.
16955 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
16956 should need to modify the default.
16958 The option is expanded before use.
16959 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
16960 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
16962 it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
16965 If this option is set as empty,
16966 or the command line &%-oY%& option is used, or
16967 the command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&,
16968 then a notifier socket is not created.
16971 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16972 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16973 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16974 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16975 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16977 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16978 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16979 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16980 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16981 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16982 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16983 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16985 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16986 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16987 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16988 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16989 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16991 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16993 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16994 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16995 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16996 some now infamous attacks.
17000 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
17001 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
17002 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
17004 # Disable older protocol versions:
17005 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
17008 Possible options may include:
17012 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
17014 &`cipher_server_preference`&
17016 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
17020 &`legacy_server_connect`&
17022 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
17024 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
17026 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
17028 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
17030 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
17034 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
17048 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
17052 &`single_ecdh_use`&
17054 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
17056 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
17058 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
17062 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
17065 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
17066 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
17067 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
17068 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
17069 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
17070 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
17073 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
17074 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
17075 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
17076 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
17077 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
17080 .option panic_coredump main boolean false
17081 This option is rarely needed but can help for some debugging investigations.
17082 If set, when an internal error is detected by Exim which is sufficient
17083 to terminate the process
17084 (all such are logged in the paniclog)
17085 then a coredump is requested.
17087 Note that most systems require additional administrative configuration
17088 to permit write a core file for a setuid program, which is Exim's
17089 common installed configuration.
17091 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17092 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
17093 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
17094 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
17095 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
17096 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
17097 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
17098 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
17099 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
17100 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
17103 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
17104 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
17105 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
17106 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
17107 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
17108 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
17109 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
17112 .options perl_at_start main boolean false &&&
17113 perl_startup main string unset
17115 These options are available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
17116 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of their use.
17118 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
17120 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
17123 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
17124 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
17125 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
17126 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
17127 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
17128 PostgreSQL support.
17131 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
17132 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
17133 .cindex "pid file, path for"
17134 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
17135 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
17138 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
17140 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
17142 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
17143 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
17144 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
17147 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17148 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
17149 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
17150 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
17151 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
17152 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
17153 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
17154 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
17155 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
17156 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
17158 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17159 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
17160 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
17161 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPECONNECT
17162 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
17163 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
17164 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
17165 commands are acceptable.
17166 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
17168 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
17170 The SMTP service extension keyword advertised is &"PIPECONNECT"&;
17171 it permits the client to pipeline
17172 TCP connection and hello command (inclear phase),
17173 or TLS-establishment and hello command (encrypted phase),
17174 on later connections to the same host.
17177 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
17178 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
17179 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
17180 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
17181 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
17182 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
17183 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
17184 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
17185 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
17187 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
17188 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
17189 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
17190 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
17191 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
17192 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
17193 volume of mail. Use with care!
17196 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
17197 .cindex "name" "of local host"
17198 .cindex "host" "name of local"
17199 .cindex "local host" "name of"
17200 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17201 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
17202 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
17203 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
17204 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
17205 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
17207 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
17208 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
17209 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
17210 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
17211 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
17212 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
17215 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
17216 .cindex "printing characters"
17217 .cindex "8-bit characters"
17218 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
17219 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
17220 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
17221 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
17222 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
17225 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
17226 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
17227 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
17228 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
17229 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
17233 .option process_log_path main string unset
17234 .cindex "process log path"
17235 .cindex "log" "process log"
17236 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
17237 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
17238 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
17239 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
17240 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
17241 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
17242 different spool directories.
17245 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
17246 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17250 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
17251 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
17252 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17255 .option proxy_protocol_timeout main time 3s
17256 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
17257 This option sets the timeout for proxy protocol negotiation.
17258 For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
17261 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
17262 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
17263 .cindex "address" "qualification"
17264 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
17265 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
17266 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
17267 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
17268 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
17269 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
17271 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
17272 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
17273 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
17274 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
17275 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
17276 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
17277 &%primary_hostname%& value.
17280 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
17281 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
17282 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
17286 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17287 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
17288 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17289 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
17290 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
17291 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
17292 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
17293 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
17296 .option queue_fast_ramp main boolean true
17297 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
17298 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
17299 If set to true, two-phase queue runs, initiated using &%-qq%& on the
17300 command line, may start parallel delivery processes during their first
17301 phase. This will be done when a threshold number of messages have been
17302 routed for a single host.
17305 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
17306 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17308 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
17309 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
17310 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
17311 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17314 .option queue_only main boolean false
17315 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17316 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
17317 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
17318 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
17319 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
17320 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
17322 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
17323 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
17324 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
17325 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
17328 .option queue_only_file main "string list" unset
17329 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17330 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
17331 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
17332 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
17333 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
17334 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
17335 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
17336 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
17338 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
17340 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
17341 &_/some/file_& exists.
17344 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
17345 .cindex "load average"
17346 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17347 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
17348 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
17349 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
17350 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
17351 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
17352 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17355 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
17356 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
17357 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
17358 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17361 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17362 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17363 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17364 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17365 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17366 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17367 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17368 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17369 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17370 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17371 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17372 re-evaluated for each message.
17375 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17376 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17377 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17378 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17379 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17380 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17383 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17384 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17385 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17386 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17387 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17388 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17389 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17390 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17391 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17392 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17393 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17394 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17395 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17399 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17400 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17401 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17402 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17403 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17404 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17405 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17406 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17407 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17409 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17410 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17411 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17412 the daemon's command line.
17414 .cindex queues named
17415 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17416 To set limits for different named queues use
17417 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17419 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17420 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17421 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17422 .cindex "first pass routing"
17423 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17424 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17425 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17426 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17427 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17428 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17429 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17430 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17431 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17432 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17436 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17437 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17438 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17439 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17440 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17441 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17442 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17444 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17445 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17446 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17447 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17448 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17449 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17450 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17451 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17452 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
17454 The default setting is:
17457 received_header_text = Received: \
17458 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17459 {${if def:sender_ident \
17460 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17461 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17462 by $primary_hostname \
17463 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17464 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17465 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17466 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17467 ${if def:sender_address \
17468 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17469 id $message_exim_id\
17470 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17473 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17474 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17475 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17476 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17477 header lines such as the following:
17479 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17480 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17481 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17482 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17483 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17484 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17485 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17487 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17488 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17489 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17490 message was accepted.
17493 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17494 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17495 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17496 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17497 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17498 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17499 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17500 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17503 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17504 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17505 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17506 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17507 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17508 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17509 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17510 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17511 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17512 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17513 option was not set.
17516 .option recipients_max main integer&!! 50000
17517 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17518 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17519 If the value resulting from expanding this option
17520 is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17521 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17522 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17523 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17524 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17527 For SMTP message the expansion is done after the connection is
17528 accepted (but before any SMTP conversation) and may depend on
17529 the IP addresses and port numbers of the connection.
17530 &*Note*&: If an expansion is used for the option,
17531 care should be taken that a resonable value results for
17534 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17535 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17536 RCPT commands in a single message.
17539 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17540 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17541 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17542 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17543 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17544 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17545 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17548 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 4
17549 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17550 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17551 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17552 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17553 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17554 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17555 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17556 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17557 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17558 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17559 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17560 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17561 tagged with its process id.
17563 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17564 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17565 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17566 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17569 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option,
17570 and the &%serialize_hosts%& smtp transport option.
17572 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17573 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17574 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17575 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17576 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17577 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17578 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17579 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17580 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17581 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17582 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17584 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17585 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17586 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17587 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17590 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17591 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17592 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17593 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17594 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17596 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17598 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17599 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17602 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17603 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17604 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17605 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17606 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17610 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17611 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17612 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17613 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17614 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17615 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17616 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17620 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17621 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17622 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
17623 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17624 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17625 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17626 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17627 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17628 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17629 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17632 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17633 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17636 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17638 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17639 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17640 an item in the list.
17641 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17644 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17645 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17646 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17647 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17648 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17651 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17652 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17653 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17654 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17655 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17656 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17657 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17658 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17659 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17660 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17663 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17664 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17665 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17666 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17667 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17668 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17669 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17673 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17674 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17675 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17676 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17677 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17678 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17679 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17680 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17681 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17682 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17683 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17687 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17688 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17689 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17691 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17692 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17693 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17694 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17695 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17696 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17698 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17699 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17700 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17701 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17704 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17705 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17706 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17707 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17708 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17709 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17710 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17711 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17713 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17714 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17715 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17716 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17717 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17718 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17719 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17720 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17723 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17724 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17725 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17726 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17730 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17731 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17732 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17733 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17734 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17735 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17736 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17737 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17738 . the option name to split.
17740 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer&!! 1000 &&&
17741 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17742 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17743 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17744 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17745 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17746 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17747 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17748 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17750 The option is expanded after the HELO or EHLO is received
17751 and may depend on values available at that time.
17752 An empty or zero value after expansion removes the limit.
17755 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17756 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17757 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17758 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17759 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17760 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17761 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17762 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17763 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17764 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17765 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17767 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17768 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17769 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17770 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17771 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17772 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17776 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17777 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17778 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17779 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17780 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17781 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17782 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17783 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17784 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17785 to all messages received in the same connection.
17787 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17788 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17789 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17790 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17793 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17795 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17796 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17797 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17798 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17799 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17800 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17801 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17802 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17803 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17804 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17805 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17806 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17807 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17810 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17811 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17812 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17813 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17814 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17815 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17816 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17817 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17818 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17819 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17820 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17823 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17824 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17825 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17826 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17829 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17830 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17831 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17832 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17833 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17834 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17835 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17836 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17837 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17839 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17840 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17841 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17842 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17844 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17845 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17846 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17847 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17848 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17851 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17852 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17855 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17856 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17857 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17858 &%helo_data%& value.
17860 .option smtp_backlog_monitor main integer 0
17861 .cindex "connection backlog" monitoring
17862 If this option is set to greater than zero, and the backlog of available
17863 TCP connections on a socket listening for SMTP is larger than it, a line
17864 is logged giving the value and the socket address and port.
17865 The value is retrived jsut before an accept call.
17866 This facility is only available on Linux.
17868 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17869 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17870 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17871 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17872 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17873 If a connect ACL does not supply a message,
17874 this string (which is expanded every time it is used) is output as the initial
17875 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17877 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17878 $version_number $tod_full
17880 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error;
17881 a forced fail just closes the connection.
17882 If you want to create a
17883 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17884 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17885 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17886 multiline response).
17889 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17890 .cindex "checking disk space"
17891 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17892 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17893 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17894 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17895 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17896 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17897 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17900 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17901 .cindex "connection backlog" "set maximum"
17902 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17903 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17904 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17905 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17906 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17907 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17908 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17909 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17910 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17911 attacks by SYN flooding.
17914 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17915 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17916 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17917 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17918 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17919 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17920 fewer, but they still exist.
17922 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17923 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17924 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17925 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17926 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17927 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17928 does detect many instances.
17930 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17931 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17932 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17933 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17937 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17938 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17939 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
17940 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17941 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17942 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17943 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17944 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17945 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17948 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17949 $sender_host_address
17951 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
17952 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
17953 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
17954 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
17956 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17957 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17958 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17959 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17960 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17964 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17965 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17966 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17967 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17968 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17971 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17972 .cindex "load average"
17973 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17974 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17975 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17976 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17977 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17978 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17982 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17983 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17984 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17985 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17986 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17988 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17990 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17991 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17992 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17993 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17994 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17996 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17997 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17998 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17999 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
18000 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
18001 not count towards the limit.
18005 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
18006 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
18007 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
18008 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
18009 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
18012 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
18013 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
18017 .options smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
18018 smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset &&&
18019 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
18020 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
18021 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
18022 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
18023 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
18024 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
18027 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
18028 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
18029 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
18030 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
18032 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
18033 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
18034 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
18035 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
18039 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
18041 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
18042 fractional parts are allowed here.
18044 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
18046 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
18047 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
18050 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
18051 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
18053 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
18054 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
18056 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
18057 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
18058 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
18059 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
18063 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
18064 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
18065 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
18066 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
18067 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
18068 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
18069 the message is abandoned.
18070 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
18072 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
18073 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
18075 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
18076 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
18078 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
18079 expanded before use and may depend on
18080 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
18084 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
18085 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
18086 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
18087 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
18088 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
18091 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18092 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
18093 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
18096 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
18097 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
18098 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
18099 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
18100 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
18101 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
18102 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
18103 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
18104 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
18105 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
18107 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
18108 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
18112 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18113 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
18114 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
18115 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
18116 the availability thereof is advertised in
18117 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18118 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
18121 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
18122 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
18123 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
18124 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
18128 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
18129 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
18130 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
18132 .option spf_smtp_comment_template main string&!! "Please%_see%_http://www.open-spf.org/Why"
18133 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support. It
18134 allows the customisation of the SMTP comment that the SPF library
18135 generates. You are strongly encouraged to link to your own explanative
18136 site. The template must not contain spaces. If you need spaces in the
18137 output, use the proper placeholder. If libspf2 can not parse the
18138 template, it uses a built-in default broken link. The following placeholders
18139 (along with Exim variables (but see below)) are allowed in the template:
18143 &*%{L}*&: Envelope sender's local part.
18145 &*%{S}*&: Envelope sender.
18147 &*%{O}*&: Envelope sender's domain.
18149 &*%{D}*&: Current(?) domain.
18151 &*%{I}*&: SMTP client Ip.
18153 &*%{C}*&: SMTP client pretty IP.
18155 &*%{T}*&: Epoch time (UTC).
18157 &*%{P}*&: SMTP client domain name.
18159 &*%{V}*&: IP version.
18161 &*%{H}*&: EHLO/HELO domain.
18163 &*%{R}*&: Receiving domain.
18165 The capitalized placeholders do proper URL encoding, if you use them
18166 lowercased, no encoding takes place. This list was compiled from the
18169 A note on using Exim variables: As
18170 currently the SPF library is initialized before the SMTP EHLO phase,
18171 the variables useful for expansion are quite limited.
18174 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
18175 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
18176 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
18177 .cindex "directories, multiple"
18178 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
18179 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
18180 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
18181 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
18182 arrival of the message.
18184 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
18185 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
18186 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
18187 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
18188 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
18190 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
18191 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
18192 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
18193 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
18194 automatically deleted.
18196 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
18197 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
18198 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
18199 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
18200 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
18201 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
18202 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
18203 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
18204 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
18207 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
18208 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
18209 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
18210 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
18211 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
18212 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
18213 &$primary_hostname$&.
18215 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
18216 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
18217 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
18218 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
18219 as failures in the configuration file.
18221 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
18222 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
18224 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
18225 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
18226 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
18227 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
18228 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
18229 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
18232 The following variables will not have useful values:
18234 $max_received_linelength
18239 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
18240 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
18241 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
18242 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
18244 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
18245 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
18246 The transmission benefit is maintained.
18248 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
18249 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
18250 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
18251 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
18253 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
18254 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
18255 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
18256 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
18257 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
18258 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
18260 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
18261 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
18262 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
18263 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
18264 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
18265 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
18266 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
18269 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
18270 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
18271 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
18272 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
18273 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
18274 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
18275 domain causes a syntax error.
18276 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
18280 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
18281 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
18282 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
18283 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
18284 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
18285 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
18286 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
18287 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
18288 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
18289 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
18290 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
18291 the LOG_ALERT priority.
18294 .option syslog_facility main string unset
18295 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
18296 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18297 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
18298 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
18299 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18300 details of Exim's logging.
18303 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
18304 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
18305 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
18306 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
18307 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
18308 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
18309 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18313 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
18314 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
18315 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18316 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
18317 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18321 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
18322 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
18323 .cindex timestamps syslog
18324 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
18325 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18326 details of Exim's logging.
18329 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
18330 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
18331 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
18332 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
18333 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
18334 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
18335 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
18336 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
18337 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
18338 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
18339 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
18340 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
18343 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
18344 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18345 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
18346 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
18347 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
18348 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18351 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
18352 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
18353 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
18354 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
18355 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18357 .option system_filter_group main string unset
18358 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
18359 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
18360 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
18361 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
18363 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
18364 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
18365 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18366 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
18367 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
18368 contains the pipe command.
18371 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
18372 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
18373 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
18374 is used in a system filter.
18377 .option system_filter_user main string unset
18378 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
18379 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
18380 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
18381 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
18382 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
18383 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
18384 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
18385 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
18386 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
18388 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
18389 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
18390 transport option overrides.
18393 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
18394 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
18395 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
18396 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
18397 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
18398 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
18399 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
18400 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
18401 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
18402 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
18403 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
18404 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
18408 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
18409 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
18410 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
18411 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
18412 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
18413 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
18414 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
18415 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
18416 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
18417 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18419 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18420 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18421 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18424 .option timezone main string unset
18425 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18426 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18427 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18428 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18429 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18430 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18434 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18435 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18436 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18437 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18438 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18439 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18442 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18443 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18444 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18445 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18446 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18447 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18448 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18449 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18450 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18451 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18452 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18453 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18456 .option tls_alpn main "string list&!!" "smtp : esmtp"
18457 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
18459 .cindex ALPN "set acceptable names for server"
18460 If this option is set,
18461 the TLS library supports ALPN,
18462 and the client offers either more than one
18463 ALPN name or a name which does not match the list,
18464 the TLS connection is declined.
18467 .option tls_certificate main "string list&!!" unset
18468 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18469 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18470 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18471 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18472 Commonly only one file is needed.
18473 The server's private key is also
18474 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18475 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18477 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18478 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18479 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18480 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18482 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18483 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18485 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18486 when a list of more than one
18487 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18488 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18490 .cindex SNI "selecting server certificate based on"
18491 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18492 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18493 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18494 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18496 If this option is unset or empty a self-signed certificate will be
18498 Under Linux this is generated at daemon startup; on other platforms it will be
18499 generated fresh for every connection.
18501 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18502 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18503 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18504 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18505 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18507 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18509 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18510 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18511 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18513 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18516 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18517 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18518 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18519 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18520 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18521 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18523 The value must be at least 1024.
18525 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18526 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18527 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18529 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18532 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18533 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18534 larger prime than requested.
18537 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18538 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18539 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18540 to be used by Exim.
18542 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
18543 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18544 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18545 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18547 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18548 then it names a file from which DH
18549 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18550 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18551 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18552 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18553 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18554 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18556 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18559 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18560 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18561 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18562 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18564 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18565 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18567 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18568 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18569 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18571 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18572 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
18573 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18574 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18575 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18577 The available standard primes are:
18578 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18579 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18580 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18581 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18583 The available additional primes are:
18584 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18586 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18587 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18588 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18589 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
18590 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18592 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18593 they are still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18594 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18595 Two of them in particular (&`ike1`& and &`ike22`&) are called out by RFC 8247
18596 as MUST NOT use for IPSEC, and two more (&`ike23`& and &`ike24`&) as
18598 Because of this, Exim regards them as deprecated; if either of the first pair
18599 are used, warnings will be logged in the paniclog, and if any are used then
18600 warnings will be logged in the mainlog.
18601 All four will be removed in a future Exim release.
18603 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18604 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18605 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18606 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18607 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18610 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18611 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18612 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18613 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18614 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18615 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18616 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18619 .option tls_eccurve main string list&!! &`auto`&
18620 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18621 This option selects EC curves for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18622 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS
18623 (the equivalent can be done using a priority string for the
18624 &%tls_require_ciphers%& option).
18626 After expansion it must contain
18627 one or (only for OpenSSL versiona 1.1.1 onwards) more
18628 EC curve names, such as &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-521`&.
18629 Consult your OpenSSL manual for valid curve names.
18631 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18632 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18633 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18635 If the option expands to an empty string, the effect is undefined.
18638 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18639 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18640 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18642 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18643 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18644 Certificate Authority.
18646 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18647 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18649 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18650 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18651 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18652 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18653 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18655 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18656 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18658 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18659 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18660 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18661 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18662 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18663 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18664 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18666 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18667 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18668 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18669 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18671 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18674 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18675 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18676 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18677 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18681 .option tls_privatekey main "string list&!!" unset
18682 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18683 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18684 files which contains the server's private keys.
18685 If this option is unset, or if
18686 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18687 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18688 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18690 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18693 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18694 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18695 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18696 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18697 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18698 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18702 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18703 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18704 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18705 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18706 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18707 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18708 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18709 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18710 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18711 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18712 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18715 .option tls_resumption_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18716 .cindex TLS resumption
18717 This option controls which connections to offer the TLS resumption feature.
18718 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
18721 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18722 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18723 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18724 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18727 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18728 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18729 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18730 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18732 or the absolute path to
18733 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18734 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18736 The "system" value for the option will use a
18737 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18738 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18739 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18742 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18743 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18745 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18747 either by file or directory
18748 are added to those given by the system default location.
18750 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18751 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18752 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18753 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18754 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18755 use the explicit directory version. (If your peer is Exim up to 4.85,
18756 using GnuTLS, you may need to send the CAs (thus using the file
18757 variant). Otherwise the peer doesn't send its certificate.)
18759 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18761 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18765 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18766 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18767 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18768 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18769 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18770 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18771 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18772 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18774 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18775 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18776 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18778 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18779 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18780 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18781 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18783 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18784 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18785 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18786 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18787 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18788 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18789 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18792 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18796 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18797 .cindex "trusted groups"
18798 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18799 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18800 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18801 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18802 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18803 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18804 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18807 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18808 .cindex "trusted users"
18809 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18810 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18811 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18812 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18813 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18814 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18815 Exim user are trusted.
18817 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18818 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18819 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18820 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18821 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18822 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18823 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18824 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18825 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18828 .option unknown_username main string unset
18829 See &%unknown_login%&.
18831 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18832 .cindex "trusted users"
18833 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18834 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18835 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18836 .cindex "envelope from"
18837 .cindex "envelope sender"
18838 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18839 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18840 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18841 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18842 is used) is ignored.
18844 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18845 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18847 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18849 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18850 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18851 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18852 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18853 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18854 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18855 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18856 followed by a hyphen
18857 by a setting like this:
18859 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18861 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18862 restriction, you can use
18864 untrusted_set_sender = *
18866 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18867 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18868 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18869 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18870 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18871 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18872 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18873 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18875 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18876 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18877 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18878 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18882 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18883 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18884 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18885 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18886 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18887 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18888 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18889 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18890 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18891 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18893 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18894 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18896 The pattern can be seen by running
18898 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18900 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18901 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18902 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18903 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18904 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18905 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18908 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18909 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18912 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
18913 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18914 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18915 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18916 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18917 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18918 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18919 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
18920 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
18921 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
18922 absolute and untainted.
18923 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18926 .option wellknown_advertise_hosts main boolean unset
18927 .cindex WELLKNOWN advertisement
18928 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" WELLKNOWN
18929 This option enables the advertising of the SMTP WELLKNOWN extension.
18930 See also the &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL (&<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&).
18932 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18933 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18934 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18935 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18936 .ecindex IIDconfima
18937 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18942 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18943 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18945 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18946 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18947 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18948 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18949 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
18951 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18952 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18953 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18954 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18955 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18957 The name of a router is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
18958 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
18962 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18963 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18964 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18965 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18966 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18967 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18968 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18970 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18971 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18972 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18973 routers, and the eventual transport.
18975 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18976 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18977 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18978 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18979 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18981 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18982 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18983 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18984 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18985 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18987 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18988 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18989 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18991 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18993 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18995 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18997 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18998 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
19000 See also the &%set%& option below.
19002 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
19003 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19004 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
19005 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
19006 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
19007 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
19008 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
19012 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
19014 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
19015 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
19016 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
19017 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
19018 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
19023 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
19024 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
19025 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
19026 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
19027 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
19028 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
19029 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
19030 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
19031 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
19032 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
19035 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
19037 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
19040 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
19042 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
19043 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
19044 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
19045 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
19048 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
19049 .cindex "case of local parts"
19050 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
19051 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
19052 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
19053 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
19054 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
19055 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
19056 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
19059 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19060 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
19061 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
19062 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
19063 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
19064 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
19065 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
19066 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
19067 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
19069 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
19070 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
19071 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
19072 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
19076 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
19077 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
19078 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
19079 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
19081 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
19082 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
19083 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
19084 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
19085 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
19087 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
19088 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router check_local_user option"
19089 &$local_part_data$& is set to an untainted version of the local part and
19090 &$home$& is set from the password data. The latter can be tested in other
19091 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
19092 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
19093 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
19094 the router is skipped.
19096 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
19097 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
19098 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
19099 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
19100 setting to achieve this. For example:
19102 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
19104 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
19105 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
19106 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
19110 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
19111 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
19112 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
19113 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
19114 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
19115 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
19116 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
19117 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
19119 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
19120 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
19122 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
19123 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
19125 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
19126 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
19127 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
19129 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19131 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
19133 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
19136 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
19138 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19139 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
19143 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
19144 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
19145 be specified using &%condition%&.
19147 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
19148 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
19149 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
19150 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19151 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19152 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
19153 Router rules processing behavior.
19155 This is best illustrated in an example:
19157 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
19158 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
19160 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19163 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19166 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
19167 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
19168 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
19169 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
19170 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
19171 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
19172 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
19173 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
19175 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
19176 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
19177 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
19178 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
19181 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
19182 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
19183 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
19184 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
19185 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
19188 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
19189 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19190 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19191 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
19192 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
19193 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19194 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19195 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19196 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
19197 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
19198 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
19199 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
19200 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
19201 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
19205 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
19206 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
19207 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
19208 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
19209 transport option of the same name.
19211 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
19212 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19213 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19214 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19215 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19216 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
19217 the DNSSEC request bit set.
19218 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19220 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
19221 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19222 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19223 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19224 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19225 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
19226 the DNSSEC request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
19227 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
19228 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19231 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
19232 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
19233 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
19234 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
19236 The data returned by the list check
19237 is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
19238 expansions of the driver's private options and in the transport.
19239 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
19240 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
19242 A complex example, using a file like:
19248 and checking both domain and local_part
19250 domains = ${domain:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19251 local_parts = ${local_part:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19256 .option driver routers string unset
19257 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
19261 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
19262 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19263 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19264 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
19265 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
19266 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
19267 Not effective on redirect routers.
19271 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
19272 .cindex "envelope from"
19273 .cindex "envelope sender"
19274 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
19275 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
19276 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
19277 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
19278 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
19279 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
19280 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
19282 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
19283 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
19284 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
19287 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
19288 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
19289 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
19290 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
19292 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
19293 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
19294 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
19295 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
19301 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
19302 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
19303 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
19304 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
19305 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
19307 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19308 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
19309 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
19310 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
19311 setting &%return_path%&.
19313 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
19314 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
19315 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
19319 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
19320 .cindex "address" "testing"
19321 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
19322 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
19323 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
19324 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
19325 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
19326 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
19327 on for the system alias file.
19328 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19331 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
19332 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
19333 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
19337 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
19338 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
19339 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
19340 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19344 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
19345 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19346 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
19350 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
19351 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19352 verifying a sender, verification fails.
19356 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
19357 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
19358 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
19359 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19360 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
19361 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
19362 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
19363 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
19364 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
19366 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
19367 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
19368 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
19369 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
19370 transport for further details.
19373 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
19374 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
19375 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19376 .cindex "transport" "local"
19377 .cindex "router" "setting group"
19378 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19379 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
19381 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19382 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19383 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
19384 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
19385 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19389 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
19390 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
19391 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
19392 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19393 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19394 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19395 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
19396 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
19397 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
19398 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
19399 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
19400 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
19401 &"see"& the added header lines.
19403 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
19404 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
19405 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
19406 failures are treated as configuration errors.
19408 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19409 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19411 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19412 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19414 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19415 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
19416 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19417 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
19418 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
19419 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
19420 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
19421 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
19422 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
19423 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19427 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
19428 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19429 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
19430 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19431 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19432 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19433 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
19434 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
19435 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
19437 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
19438 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
19439 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
19440 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
19441 &"see"& the original header lines.
19443 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
19444 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
19445 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
19448 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19449 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19451 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19452 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19454 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19455 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
19456 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
19457 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
19459 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
19460 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
19461 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19465 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
19466 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
19467 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
19468 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
19469 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19470 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19471 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19474 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19478 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19480 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19481 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19482 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19483 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19484 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19485 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19487 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19488 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19490 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19491 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19493 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19494 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19496 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19497 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19498 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19499 domain that is being routed.
19501 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19502 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19505 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19506 .cindex "additional groups"
19507 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19508 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19509 .cindex "transport" "local"
19510 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19511 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19512 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19513 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19514 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19518 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19519 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19520 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19521 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19522 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19523 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19524 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19527 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19528 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19529 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19530 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19531 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19532 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19533 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19534 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19535 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19537 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19538 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19539 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19540 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19541 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19542 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19543 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19544 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19545 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19546 the relevant transport.
19548 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19549 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19550 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19552 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19553 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19554 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19557 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19558 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19559 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19560 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19561 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19565 local_part_prefix = real-
19567 transport = local_delivery
19569 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19570 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19572 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19573 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19576 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19577 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19578 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19579 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19582 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19583 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19587 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19588 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19589 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19590 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19591 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19592 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19593 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19594 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19595 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19599 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19600 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19604 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19605 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19606 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19607 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19608 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19610 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19611 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19614 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain_data
19616 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19617 the data returned by the list check
19618 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19619 expansions of the router's private options or in the transport.
19620 You might use this option, for
19621 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19622 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19623 each virtual domain:
19627 local_parts = postmaster
19628 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19632 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19633 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19634 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19635 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19636 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19637 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19638 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19639 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19640 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19641 redirect addresses.
19645 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19646 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19647 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19648 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19649 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19650 delivery to be deferred.
19652 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19653 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19655 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19656 means of the setting
19660 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19661 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19662 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19664 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19665 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19666 controls what happens next.
19669 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19670 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19671 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19672 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19673 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19674 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19675 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19676 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19678 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19679 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19680 applies to all of them.
19684 .option pass_router routers string unset
19685 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19686 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19687 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19688 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19689 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19690 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19691 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19692 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19693 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19694 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19698 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19699 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19700 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19701 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19702 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19703 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19705 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19706 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19707 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19708 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19712 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19713 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19714 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19715 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19716 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19717 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19718 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19720 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19721 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19722 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19723 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19724 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19726 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19727 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19728 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19729 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19730 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19733 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19734 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19737 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19738 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19739 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19740 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19741 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19742 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19743 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19744 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19746 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19747 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19748 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19749 operates as follows:
19751 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19752 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19753 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19754 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19757 require_files = mail:/some/file
19758 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
19760 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19761 &%require_files%& condition fails.
19763 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19764 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19765 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19766 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19768 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19769 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19770 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19771 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19772 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19774 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19775 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19776 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19777 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19778 check again in that process.
19780 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19781 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19782 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19783 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19784 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19785 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19786 as if the file did not exist. For example:
19788 require_files = +/some/file
19790 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19791 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19792 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19796 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19797 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19798 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19799 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19800 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19801 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19802 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19803 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19806 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19807 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19808 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19809 &%check_local_user%&,
19812 &%local_part_prefix%&,
19813 &%local_part_suffix%&,
19816 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19817 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19820 Failing to set this option when it is needed
19821 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19822 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19824 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19825 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19826 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19830 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19831 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19832 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19834 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19835 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19836 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19837 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19838 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19839 cause the router to defer.
19841 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19842 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19844 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19846 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19847 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19849 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19850 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19851 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19852 of these values that is set:
19855 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19857 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19859 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19861 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19864 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19865 router, but not for the transport.
19869 .option self routers string freeze
19870 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19871 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19872 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19873 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19874 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19875 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19877 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19878 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19879 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19880 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19881 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19883 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19884 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19885 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19886 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19887 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19892 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19894 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19895 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19896 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19897 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19899 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19900 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19901 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19906 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19907 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19908 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19909 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19910 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19911 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19917 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19918 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19919 be passed to the next router.
19922 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19925 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19926 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19927 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19928 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19929 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19930 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19935 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19936 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19937 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19938 address matches something on the list.
19939 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19942 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19943 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19944 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19945 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19946 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19947 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19948 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19952 .option set routers "string list" unset
19953 .cindex router variables
19954 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19955 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19956 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19959 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19960 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19961 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19962 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19963 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19965 This is done immediately after all the preconditions, before the
19966 evaluation of the &%address_data%& option.
19967 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19968 The variables can be used by the router options
19969 (not including any preconditions)
19970 and by the transport.
19971 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19972 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19974 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19975 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19978 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19979 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19980 .cindex "packet radio"
19981 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19982 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19983 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19984 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19985 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19986 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19987 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19988 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19990 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19991 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19992 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19993 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19994 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19995 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19996 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19997 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19998 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19999 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
20001 translate_ip_address = \
20002 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
20005 The file would contain lines like
20007 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
20008 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
20010 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
20015 .option transport routers string&!! unset
20016 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
20017 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
20018 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
20019 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
20020 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
20021 delivery is deferred.
20023 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
20024 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
20025 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
20029 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
20030 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20031 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
20032 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
20033 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
20034 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
20035 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
20036 overridden by a setting on the transport.
20037 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20038 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20039 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
20045 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
20046 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20047 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
20048 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
20049 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
20050 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
20051 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
20052 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
20053 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20054 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20056 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
20057 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
20058 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
20059 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
20060 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
20062 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
20068 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
20069 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
20070 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
20071 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
20072 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
20073 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
20074 delivery to be deferred.
20076 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
20077 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
20078 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
20079 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
20080 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
20081 sometimes true and sometimes false).
20083 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
20084 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
20085 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
20086 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
20087 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
20088 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
20089 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
20090 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
20092 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
20093 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
20094 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
20095 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
20096 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
20097 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
20098 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
20099 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
20100 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
20101 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
20103 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
20104 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
20105 subsequent routers.
20108 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
20109 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20110 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20111 .cindex "transport" "local"
20112 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
20113 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
20114 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
20115 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
20116 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
20117 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
20118 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
20119 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
20120 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
20121 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
20122 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
20123 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
20127 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
20128 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
20129 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
20132 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
20133 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
20135 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
20136 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
20137 delivering in cutthrough mode or
20138 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
20139 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
20140 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
20141 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
20143 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
20144 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
20145 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
20149 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
20150 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
20152 delivering in cutthrough mode
20153 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
20154 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20156 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20159 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
20160 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
20161 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
20162 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20164 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20165 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
20166 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
20173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20174 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20176 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
20177 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
20178 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
20179 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
20180 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
20181 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
20182 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
20183 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
20184 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
20188 domains = mydomain.example
20190 transport = local_delivery
20192 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
20193 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
20194 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
20195 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
20202 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20203 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20205 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
20206 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
20207 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
20208 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
20209 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
20210 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
20212 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
20213 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
20214 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
20215 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
20218 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
20219 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
20220 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
20221 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
20222 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
20223 generic option, the router declines.
20225 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
20226 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
20227 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
20229 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20230 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20231 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
20232 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
20233 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
20234 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
20237 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
20238 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
20239 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
20240 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
20241 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
20242 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
20244 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
20245 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
20246 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
20247 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
20248 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
20249 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
20250 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
20251 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
20252 case routing fails.
20255 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
20256 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
20257 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
20258 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
20259 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
20261 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
20262 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
20264 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
20266 The domain does not exist in DNS
20268 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
20269 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
20270 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
20272 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
20274 MX record points to a non-existent host.
20276 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
20277 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
20279 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
20280 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
20282 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
20283 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
20285 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
20286 not be found in the MX records (see below)
20292 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
20293 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
20294 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
20296 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
20297 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
20298 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
20299 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
20300 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
20301 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
20302 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20305 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
20306 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
20307 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
20308 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
20309 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
20310 required. For example,
20314 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
20315 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
20316 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
20317 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
20318 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
20321 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
20322 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
20323 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
20324 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
20325 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
20326 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
20328 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
20329 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
20330 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
20331 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
20332 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
20333 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
20334 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
20335 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
20337 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
20338 when there is a DNS lookup error.
20343 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20344 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
20345 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
20346 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
20347 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
20348 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
20349 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
20350 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
20354 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
20355 .cindex IPv6 disabling
20356 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
20357 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20358 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20359 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20360 only A records are used.
20362 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
20363 .cindex IPv4 preference
20364 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
20365 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20366 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20367 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20368 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
20370 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20371 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
20372 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
20373 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
20374 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
20375 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
20376 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
20379 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
20381 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
20382 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
20383 the address record.
20386 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20387 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20388 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
20389 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20394 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
20395 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20396 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
20397 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
20398 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
20399 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
20400 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
20401 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
20402 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
20407 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
20408 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
20409 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
20410 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
20411 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
20412 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
20413 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
20414 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
20415 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
20416 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
20417 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
20419 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
20420 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
20423 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
20424 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
20425 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
20426 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
20427 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
20431 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
20432 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20433 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
20434 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
20435 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20436 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20437 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20438 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20440 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20441 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
20442 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20443 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
20444 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
20445 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
20446 without processing them independently,
20447 provided the following conditions are met:
20450 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
20451 &%headers_remove%&.
20453 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
20460 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
20461 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20462 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
20463 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
20464 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
20465 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
20466 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
20467 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
20468 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
20469 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20471 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20472 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20477 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20478 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20479 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20480 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20485 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20486 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20487 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20488 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20491 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20493 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20494 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20495 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20496 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20497 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20498 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20501 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20502 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20503 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20504 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20505 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20507 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20508 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20509 such as that implied by
20513 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20514 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20515 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20516 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20529 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20530 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20531 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20532 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20533 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20534 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20535 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20536 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20537 router handles the address
20541 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20542 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20543 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20545 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20547 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20548 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20550 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20551 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20552 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20553 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20555 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20556 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20557 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20558 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20565 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20566 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20567 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20568 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20569 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20570 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20573 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20575 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20577 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20578 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20579 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20580 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20581 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20582 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20583 must not be specified for it.
20585 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20586 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20587 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20588 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20589 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20590 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20591 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20594 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20595 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20596 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20597 delivery to the address is deferred.
20600 .option port iplookup integer 0
20601 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20602 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20606 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20607 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20608 protocols is to be used.
20611 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20612 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20615 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20617 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20618 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20621 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20622 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20623 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20624 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20625 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20626 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20627 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20628 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20631 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20632 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20633 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20634 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20635 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20636 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20637 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20638 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20639 following could be used:
20641 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20642 reroute = $local_part@$1
20645 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20646 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20647 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20648 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20653 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20654 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20656 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20657 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20658 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20659 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20660 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20661 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20662 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20663 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20664 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20665 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20667 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20668 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20669 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20670 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20671 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20672 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20673 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20676 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20677 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20678 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20679 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20680 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20681 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20682 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20685 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20686 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20687 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20688 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20689 below, following the list of private options.
20692 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20694 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20695 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20697 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20698 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20700 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20701 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20702 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20703 of the following values:
20712 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20713 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20714 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20717 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20718 router only if &%more%& is true.
20720 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20721 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20722 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20723 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20725 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20726 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20727 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20730 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20731 .cindex "randomized host list"
20732 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20733 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20734 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20735 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20736 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20737 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20738 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20739 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20741 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20742 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20743 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20744 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20746 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20748 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20749 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20750 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20751 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20752 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20755 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20756 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20757 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20760 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20762 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20763 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20767 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20768 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20769 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20770 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20773 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20774 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20775 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20776 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20777 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20778 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20779 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20780 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20782 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20783 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20784 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20785 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20786 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20787 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20788 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20789 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20794 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20795 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20796 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20797 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20798 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20799 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20801 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20803 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20807 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20808 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20810 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20811 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20812 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20813 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20814 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20815 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20816 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20817 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20818 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20819 in a &%route_list%&).
20821 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20822 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20823 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20824 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20828 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20829 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20830 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20831 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20832 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20833 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20834 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20837 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20838 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20840 This data can be accessed by setting
20842 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20844 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20845 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20846 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20847 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20848 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20853 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20854 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20855 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20856 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20857 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20858 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20859 The format of each item
20860 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20861 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20863 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20864 variables are set during its expansion:
20867 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20868 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20869 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20871 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20874 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20876 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20879 .vindex "&$value$&"
20880 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20881 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20883 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20887 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20888 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20892 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20893 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
20894 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
20895 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
20896 When no port is given, an IP address
20897 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20898 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20899 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20902 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20903 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20904 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20906 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20907 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20910 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20911 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20912 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20913 number follows. For example:
20915 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20919 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20920 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20921 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20922 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20923 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20926 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20927 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20928 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20929 records in the DNS. For example:
20931 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20933 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20936 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20938 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20939 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20940 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20941 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20942 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20943 happens is controlled by the
20944 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20945 &%self%& option of the router.
20947 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20948 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20949 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20950 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20951 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20952 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20953 defined by MX preferences.
20955 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20956 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20957 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20959 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20960 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20961 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20962 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20964 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20965 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20968 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20969 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20970 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20972 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20973 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20977 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20978 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20979 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20980 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20981 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20982 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20983 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20986 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20987 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20989 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20990 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20992 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20993 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20994 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20996 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20997 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20998 timeout), delivery is deferred.
21000 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
21002 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
21007 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
21008 domain2 host4:host5
21010 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
21011 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
21012 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
21013 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
21016 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
21017 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
21018 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
21019 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
21022 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
21023 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
21028 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
21029 &%host_find_failed%& option.
21032 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
21033 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
21037 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
21038 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
21039 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
21042 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
21043 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
21044 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
21045 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
21047 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
21049 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
21050 your first router something like this:
21053 driver = manualroute
21054 domains = !+local_domains
21055 transport = remote_smtp
21056 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
21058 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
21059 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
21060 they are tried in order
21061 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
21062 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
21065 driver = manualroute
21066 transport = remote_smtp
21067 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
21069 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
21070 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
21071 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
21072 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
21073 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
21074 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
21075 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
21076 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
21079 .cindex "mail hub example"
21080 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
21081 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
21082 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
21083 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
21084 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
21085 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
21086 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
21087 lookup is easier to manage.
21089 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
21090 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
21094 driver = manualroute
21095 transport = remote_smtp
21096 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
21098 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
21099 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
21100 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
21101 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
21102 domain can be used to find the host:
21105 driver = manualroute
21106 transport = remote_smtp
21107 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
21109 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
21110 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
21111 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
21115 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
21116 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
21117 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
21118 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
21119 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
21120 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
21123 driver = manualroute
21124 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
21125 route_list = saved.domain.example
21127 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
21128 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
21129 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
21132 driver = manualroute
21134 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
21135 *.saved.domain2.example \
21136 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
21139 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21141 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
21142 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
21143 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
21144 the address if the lookup fails.
21147 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
21148 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
21149 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
21150 one way it can be done:
21156 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
21157 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
21158 return_fail_output = true
21163 driver = manualroute
21165 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
21167 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
21169 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
21171 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
21172 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
21173 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
21175 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
21176 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
21185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21186 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21188 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
21189 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
21190 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
21191 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
21192 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
21193 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
21194 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
21195 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
21196 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
21197 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
21199 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
21201 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
21202 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
21203 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
21204 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
21205 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
21208 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
21209 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
21210 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
21211 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
21212 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
21213 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
21216 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
21217 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
21218 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
21219 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
21220 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
21221 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
21222 not set, a value for the gid also.
21224 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
21225 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
21226 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
21227 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
21228 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
21229 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
21233 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
21234 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
21235 before running the command.
21238 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
21239 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
21240 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
21244 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
21245 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
21246 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
21247 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
21248 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
21251 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
21254 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
21255 &%no_more%& is set.
21257 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
21258 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
21259 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
21260 included in the SMTP response.
21262 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
21263 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
21264 included in any SMTP response.
21266 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
21268 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
21269 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
21271 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
21272 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
21273 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
21276 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
21277 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
21280 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
21281 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
21283 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
21284 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
21285 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
21286 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
21288 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
21289 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
21290 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
21291 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
21292 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
21294 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
21295 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
21296 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
21297 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
21298 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
21300 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
21301 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
21302 variable. For example, this return line
21304 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
21306 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
21307 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
21308 .ecindex IIDquerou1
21309 .ecindex IIDquerou2
21314 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21315 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21317 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
21318 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
21319 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
21320 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
21321 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
21322 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
21323 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
21324 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
21325 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
21326 redirected in several different ways:
21329 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
21332 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
21334 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
21336 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
21338 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
21340 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
21342 It can be discarded.
21345 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
21346 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
21347 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
21348 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
21350 If success DSNs have been requested
21351 .cindex "DSN" "success"
21352 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
21353 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
21357 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
21358 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
21359 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
21360 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
21361 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
21362 aliases, in a configuration like this:
21366 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
21368 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
21369 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
21370 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
21371 cause delivery to be deferred.
21373 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
21374 &_.forward_& files, like this:
21379 file = $home/.forward
21382 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
21383 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
21384 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
21385 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
21388 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21389 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21390 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21392 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
21393 directly for redirection,
21394 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
21395 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
21396 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
21397 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
21401 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
21402 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
21403 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
21404 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
21407 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
21408 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
21409 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
21410 practice the router may not be able to operate.
21412 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
21413 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
21414 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
21415 saves some resources.
21423 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
21424 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21425 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21426 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
21427 can be interpreted in two different ways:
21430 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
21431 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
21432 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
21433 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
21434 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
21435 document is intended for use by end users.
21437 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
21438 described in the next section.
21441 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
21442 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
21443 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
21444 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
21445 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
21449 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
21450 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
21451 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
21452 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
21453 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
21454 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
21455 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
21456 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
21457 commas or newlines.
21458 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
21461 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
21462 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
21463 next newline character is ignored.
21465 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
21466 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
21467 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
21468 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21471 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21472 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21473 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21474 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21475 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21476 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21479 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21483 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21484 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21485 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21486 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21487 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21488 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21489 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21490 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21491 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21492 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21493 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21495 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21496 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21497 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21498 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21499 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21501 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21503 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21504 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21505 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21506 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21507 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21510 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
21511 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21512 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21513 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21514 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21516 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21517 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21522 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21523 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21526 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21528 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21529 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21530 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21531 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21532 should really contain
21534 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21536 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21537 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21538 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21542 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21543 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21544 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21547 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21548 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21549 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21550 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21551 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21552 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21553 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21555 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21556 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21557 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21558 in double quotes, for example:
21560 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21562 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21563 quote just the command. An item such as
21565 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21567 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21569 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21570 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21571 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21572 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21573 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21574 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21575 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21576 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21577 an &%accept%& router.
21580 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21581 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21582 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21583 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
21585 /home/world/minbari
21587 is treated as a filename, but
21589 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21591 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21592 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21593 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21594 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21596 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21597 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21599 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21600 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21601 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21602 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21605 .cindex "included address list"
21606 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21607 If an item is of the form
21609 :include:<path name>
21611 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21612 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21613 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21614 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21615 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21616 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21618 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21620 It must be given as
21622 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21624 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21625 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21626 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21628 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21629 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21630 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21631 .cindex "black hole"
21632 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21633 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21634 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21635 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21639 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21640 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21641 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21643 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21644 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21645 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21646 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21650 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21651 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21652 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21653 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21654 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21655 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21656 redirection items of the form
21661 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21662 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21663 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21664 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21666 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21668 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21670 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21671 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21673 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21674 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21675 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21677 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21678 By default for verify, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21679 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21680 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21681 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21682 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21683 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21684 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21685 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21688 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21689 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21690 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21691 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21693 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21694 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21695 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21696 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21697 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21699 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21700 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21701 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21702 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21703 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21707 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21708 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21709 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21710 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21711 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21712 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21713 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21717 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21718 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21719 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21720 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21721 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21722 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21723 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21724 aliasing scheme of the type
21726 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21730 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21731 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21732 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21735 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21736 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21738 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21739 the pipes are distinct.
21743 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21744 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21745 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21746 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21747 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21748 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21749 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21750 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21751 can be used to avoid this.
21754 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21755 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21756 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21757 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21758 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21759 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21760 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21764 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21766 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21767 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21770 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21771 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21772 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21775 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21776 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21777 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21778 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21781 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21782 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21783 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21784 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21785 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21786 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21787 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21789 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21790 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21793 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21794 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21795 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21796 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21797 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21801 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21802 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21803 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21804 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21805 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21806 let ordinary users do.
21810 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21811 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21812 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21813 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21814 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21815 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21817 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21818 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21819 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21820 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21821 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21822 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21824 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21826 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21827 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21828 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21829 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21830 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21831 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21832 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21833 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21836 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21837 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21838 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21839 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21840 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21841 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21842 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21843 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21847 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21848 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21849 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21850 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21851 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21852 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21855 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21856 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21857 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21858 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21859 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21860 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21862 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21863 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21864 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21866 data = #Exim filter\n\
21867 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21869 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21870 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21871 choice into a newline.
21874 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21875 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21876 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21877 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21878 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21881 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21882 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21883 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21884 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21885 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21886 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21887 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21888 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21890 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21891 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21892 runs a check on the containing directory,
21893 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21894 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21895 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21896 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21897 not, the router declines.
21900 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21901 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21902 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21903 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21904 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21905 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21906 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21909 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21910 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21911 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21912 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21913 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21916 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21917 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21918 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21919 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21923 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21924 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21925 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21926 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21927 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21932 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21933 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21934 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21935 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21936 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21937 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21938 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21939 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21940 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21941 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21942 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21945 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21946 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21947 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21948 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21949 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21952 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21953 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21954 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21955 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21956 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21957 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21959 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21960 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21961 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21962 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21963 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21964 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21965 &_.forward_& files).
21968 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21969 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21970 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21971 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21972 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21975 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21976 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21977 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21978 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21979 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21980 of the embedded Perl support.
21983 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21984 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21985 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21986 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21987 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21990 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21991 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21992 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21993 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21994 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21997 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21998 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21999 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22000 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
22001 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
22002 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
22003 &%one_time%& is set.
22006 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
22007 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22008 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22009 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22010 to make use of &%run%& items.
22013 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
22014 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22015 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22016 If this option is true, items of the form
22018 :include:<path name>
22020 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
22023 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
22024 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22025 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22026 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
22027 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
22028 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
22029 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
22032 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
22033 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22034 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22035 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
22036 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22039 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
22040 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
22041 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
22042 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
22043 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
22048 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
22049 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
22050 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
22051 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
22052 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
22053 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
22054 bounce may well quote the generated address.
22057 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
22059 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22060 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
22061 file did not exist.
22064 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
22066 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22067 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
22068 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
22070 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
22071 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
22072 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
22073 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
22074 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
22075 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
22076 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
22077 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
22081 .option include_directory redirect string unset
22082 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
22083 redirection list must start with this directory.
22086 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
22087 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
22088 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
22091 .option one_time redirect boolean false
22092 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
22093 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
22094 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
22095 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
22096 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
22097 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
22098 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
22099 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
22100 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
22101 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
22102 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
22103 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
22104 before they subscribed.
22106 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
22107 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
22108 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
22109 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
22112 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
22113 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
22114 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
22115 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
22117 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
22118 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
22119 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
22121 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
22124 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
22125 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
22126 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
22127 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
22128 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
22132 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
22133 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
22134 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
22135 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
22136 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
22137 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
22138 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
22139 See &%check_owner%& above.
22142 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
22143 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
22144 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
22145 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
22148 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
22149 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22150 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
22151 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
22152 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
22153 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
22154 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
22157 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
22158 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
22159 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
22160 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
22161 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
22162 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
22163 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
22164 &$qualify_recipient$&.
22166 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
22167 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
22168 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
22171 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
22172 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
22173 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
22174 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
22175 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
22176 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
22177 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
22178 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
22179 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
22180 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
22183 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
22184 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
22185 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
22186 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
22187 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
22188 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
22191 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
22192 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
22193 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
22194 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
22195 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
22196 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
22199 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
22200 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
22201 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
22202 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
22203 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
22206 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
22207 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22208 :subaddress part of an address.
22210 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
22211 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
22212 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
22213 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
22216 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
22217 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
22218 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
22219 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
22220 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
22221 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
22222 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
22226 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
22227 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
22228 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
22229 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
22230 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
22231 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
22232 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
22233 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
22234 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
22235 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
22236 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
22237 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
22238 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
22239 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
22240 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
22241 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
22243 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
22244 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
22245 the following routers.
22247 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
22248 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
22249 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
22250 so it is passed to the following routers.
22252 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
22253 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
22254 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
22255 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
22257 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
22258 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
22259 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
22260 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
22266 file = $home/.forward
22267 file_transport = address_file
22268 pipe_transport = address_pipe
22269 reply_transport = address_reply
22272 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
22273 syntax_errors_text = \
22274 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
22275 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
22276 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
22277 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
22278 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
22279 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
22280 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
22281 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
22282 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
22283 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
22285 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
22286 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
22287 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
22292 local_part_prefix = real-
22293 transport = local_delivery
22295 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
22296 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
22298 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
22299 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
22303 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
22304 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22307 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
22308 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22309 .ecindex IIDredrou1
22310 .ecindex IIDredrou2
22317 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22318 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22320 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
22321 "Environment for local transports"
22322 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
22323 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
22324 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
22325 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
22326 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
22327 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
22328 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
22330 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
22331 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
22332 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
22333 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
22335 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
22336 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
22337 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
22338 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
22339 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
22343 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
22344 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
22345 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
22346 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
22347 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
22348 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
22349 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
22352 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
22353 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
22357 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
22359 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
22360 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
22361 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
22362 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
22367 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
22368 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
22369 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
22370 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
22371 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
22372 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
22373 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
22374 group (set by the transport). For example:
22377 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
22381 transport = group_delivery
22384 # This transport overrides the group
22386 driver = appendfile
22387 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22390 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
22391 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
22392 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
22395 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
22396 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
22397 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
22398 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
22399 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
22400 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
22402 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
22403 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
22404 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
22405 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
22406 original gid is also used.
22408 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
22409 following that is set is used:
22412 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
22414 A &%group%& setting of the router;
22416 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
22417 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
22419 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
22421 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
22422 the uid is the creator's uid;
22424 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
22427 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
22428 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
22429 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
22430 The first of the following that is set is used:
22433 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
22435 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
22437 A &%user%& setting of the router;
22439 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
22444 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
22445 &%never_users%& list.
22451 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
22452 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
22453 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
22454 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
22455 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
22456 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
22457 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
22458 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
22459 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
22460 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22463 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
22465 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22467 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22469 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22472 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22475 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22477 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22481 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22482 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22483 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22487 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22488 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22489 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22490 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22491 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22492 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22493 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22494 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22495 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22496 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22497 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22498 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22499 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22500 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22508 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22511 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22512 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22513 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22514 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22515 The name of a transport is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
22516 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
22519 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22522 .option body_only transports boolean false
22523 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22524 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22525 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22526 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22527 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22528 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22529 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22530 automatically suppress them.
22533 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22534 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22535 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22536 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22537 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22538 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22541 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22542 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22543 deliveries by the transport or for any
22544 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22545 what you are doing.
22548 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22549 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22550 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22551 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22553 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22554 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22555 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22556 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22557 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22558 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22560 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22561 transport and the router that called it.
22563 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22564 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22565 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22566 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22567 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22568 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22569 safely be resent to other recipients.
22572 .option driver transports string unset
22573 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22574 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22577 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22578 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22579 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22580 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22581 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22582 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22583 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22584 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22585 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22586 resent to other recipients.
22588 &*Note:*& If used on a transport handling multiple recipients
22589 (the smtp transport unless &%max_rcpt%& is 1, the appendfile, pipe or lmtp
22590 transport if &%batch_max%& is greater than 1)
22591 then information about Bcc recipients will be leaked.
22592 Doing so is generally not advised.
22595 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22597 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22598 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22601 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22602 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22603 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22604 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22605 &%user%& (see below).
22608 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22609 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22610 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22611 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22612 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22613 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22614 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22615 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22616 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22617 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22618 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22620 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22621 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22624 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22625 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22626 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22627 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22628 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22629 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22630 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22631 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22634 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22635 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22636 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22637 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22638 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22639 to be removed from the message.
22640 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22641 Each list item is separately expanded.
22642 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22643 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22644 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22645 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22647 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22648 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22651 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22652 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22654 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22655 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22656 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22660 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22661 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22662 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22663 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22664 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22665 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22666 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22667 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22670 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22673 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22674 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22675 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22676 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22677 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22678 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22679 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22680 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22681 change envelope recipients at this time.
22684 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22685 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22687 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22688 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22689 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22690 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22691 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22692 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22693 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22697 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22698 .cindex "additional groups"
22699 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22700 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22701 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22702 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22703 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22706 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22707 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22708 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22709 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22710 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22711 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22712 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22713 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22715 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22716 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22717 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22718 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22719 Obviously there is scope for
22720 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22721 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22723 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22724 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22725 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22726 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22727 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22730 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22731 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22732 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22733 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22734 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22735 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22736 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22737 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22738 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22739 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22740 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22741 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22742 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22747 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22748 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22749 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22750 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
22751 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
22752 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22753 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22754 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22757 local_part_prefix = *-
22759 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22762 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22764 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22765 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22766 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22767 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22768 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22771 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22772 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22773 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22774 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22775 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22776 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22777 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22778 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22779 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22781 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22782 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22783 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22784 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22786 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22787 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22788 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22791 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
22792 .cindex "envelope sender"
22793 .cindex "envelope from"
22794 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22795 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22796 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22797 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22798 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22799 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22800 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22801 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22802 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22804 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22805 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22807 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
22808 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22809 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22810 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22811 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22812 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22813 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22815 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22816 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22817 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22818 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22819 &%errors_to%& in a router.
22823 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
22824 .chindex Return-path:
22825 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22826 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22827 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22828 have easy access to it.
22830 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22831 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22832 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22833 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22834 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22838 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22839 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22842 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
22843 .cindex "shadow transport"
22844 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
22845 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22846 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22848 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22849 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22850 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22851 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22852 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22853 cause a log line to be written.
22855 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22856 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22857 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22858 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22859 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22862 ST=<shadow transport name>
22864 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22865 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22866 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22867 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22868 headers that some sites insist on.
22871 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22872 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22873 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22874 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22875 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22876 individual users or via a system filter.
22877 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22879 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22880 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22881 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22882 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock).
22883 The command must be specified as an absolute path.
22885 The process run by the command must use its standard input as the message
22886 data to be transformed, and write the results on its standard output.
22888 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22889 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22890 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22891 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22892 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22893 &(pipe)& transports.
22895 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22896 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22897 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22898 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22899 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22901 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22902 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22903 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22904 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22906 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22907 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22908 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22909 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22910 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22911 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22913 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
22914 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22915 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22916 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22917 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22918 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22919 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22920 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22922 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22923 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22924 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22925 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22926 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22927 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22928 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22929 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22930 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22931 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22934 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22935 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22936 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22937 which the message is being sent. For example:
22938 . used to have $sender_address in this cmdline, but it's tainted
22940 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22941 $host $host_address $pipe_addresses
22944 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22945 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22946 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22948 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22949 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22950 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22953 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22955 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22956 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise.
22958 Option strings in general have any fully-surrounding double quote wrapping
22959 removed early in parsing (see &<<SECTstrings>>&).
22960 Then, for this option, quotes protect against whitespace being
22961 regarded as a separator while splitting into the command argument vector.
22962 Either double or single quotes can be used here;
22963 the former interprets backlash-quoted charachters
22964 and the latter does not.
22966 If double quotes had been used in this example, they would have been
22967 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22968 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22969 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22970 Exim tried to expand the first one.
22972 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22973 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22974 arguments. Consider this example:
22976 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22977 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22979 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22980 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22982 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22983 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22987 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22988 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22989 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22990 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22991 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22992 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22993 bounced from a transport filter.
22995 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22996 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22997 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
23000 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
23001 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
23002 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
23003 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
23004 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
23005 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
23006 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
23007 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
23008 becomes a temporary error.
23011 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
23012 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23013 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
23014 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
23015 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
23016 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
23017 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
23020 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
23021 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
23022 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
23024 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
23025 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
23026 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
23027 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
23029 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
23030 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
23031 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
23038 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23039 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23041 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
23043 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
23044 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
23045 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
23046 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
23047 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
23048 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
23049 copy of the message is delivered each time.
23051 .cindex "batched local delivery"
23052 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
23053 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
23054 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
23055 local transport, for example:
23058 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
23059 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
23060 recipients saves space.
23062 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
23063 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
23065 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
23066 to a scanner program or
23067 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
23071 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
23072 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
23073 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
23075 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
23076 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
23077 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
23078 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
23079 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
23080 to certain conditions:
23083 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23084 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
23085 batching is possible.
23087 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23088 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
23089 addresses with the same domain are batched.
23091 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
23092 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
23093 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
23094 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
23095 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
23098 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
23099 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
23100 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
23104 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
23105 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
23106 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
23107 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
23108 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
23109 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
23110 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
23113 escape_string = ".."
23115 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
23116 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
23117 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
23119 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
23120 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
23121 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
23122 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
23123 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
23124 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
23126 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
23127 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23128 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
23129 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
23130 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
23131 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
23132 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
23133 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
23134 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
23139 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23142 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
23143 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
23144 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
23145 .cindex "directory creation"
23146 .cindex "creating directories"
23147 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
23148 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
23149 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
23150 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
23151 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
23152 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
23153 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
23154 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
23155 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
23156 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
23158 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
23159 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
23160 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
23163 .cindex "quota" "system"
23164 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
23165 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
23166 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
23168 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
23169 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
23170 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
23171 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
23173 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
23174 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
23177 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
23178 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
23179 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
23180 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
23185 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
23186 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
23187 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
23188 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
23189 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
23191 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
23192 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23193 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
23194 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
23195 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
23196 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
23197 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
23198 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
23199 operation. There are two cases:
23202 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
23203 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
23204 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
23205 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
23206 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
23207 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
23208 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
23210 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
23211 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
23212 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
23214 If the &%create_file%& option is set to a path which
23215 matches (see the option definition below for details)
23216 a file or directory name
23217 for the delivery, that name becomes de-tainted.
23219 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
23220 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
23221 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
23222 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
23223 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
23224 which returns a path (or component).
23227 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
23228 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
23229 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
23230 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
23235 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
23237 require "fileinto";
23238 fileinto "folder23";
23240 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
23241 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
23242 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
23243 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
23244 way of handling this requirement:
23246 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
23247 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
23248 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
23250 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
23254 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
23255 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
23256 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
23258 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
23259 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
23260 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
23261 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
23262 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
23263 path to the transport.
23265 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
23266 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
23271 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
23272 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
23276 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
23277 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
23278 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
23279 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
23280 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
23281 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
23282 delivery is deferred.
23285 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
23286 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23287 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23288 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
23289 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
23290 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
23291 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
23292 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
23295 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
23296 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23297 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
23298 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
23302 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
23303 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23306 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
23307 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
23308 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
23309 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
23310 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
23313 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
23314 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
23315 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
23316 process is running.
23319 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
23320 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23321 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
23322 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
23323 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
23324 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
23325 contains is significant.
23327 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
23328 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
23329 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
23330 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
23331 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
23333 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
23334 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
23335 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
23336 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
23337 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
23338 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
23340 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23341 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
23342 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23343 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23345 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
23346 .cindex "directory creation"
23347 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
23348 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
23349 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
23351 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
23352 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
23353 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
23354 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
23355 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
23359 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
23360 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
23361 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
23362 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
23363 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
23366 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
23367 &"belowhome"&, or to an absolute path.
23369 In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
23370 set for the transport, and the file or directory being created must
23372 The "belowhome" checking additionally checks for attempts to use "../"
23373 to evade the testing.
23374 This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
23375 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
23376 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
23377 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
23378 &%file_must_exist%&.
23380 In the fourth case,
23381 the value given for this option must be an absolute path for an
23382 existing directory.
23383 The value is used for checking instead of a home directory;
23384 checking is done in "belowhome" mode.
23386 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
23387 .cindex "de-tainting" "using appendfile create_file option"
23388 If "belowhome" checking is used, the file or directory path
23389 becomes de-tainted.
23392 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
23393 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
23394 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
23395 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
23397 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
23398 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
23399 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
23400 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
23401 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
23403 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23407 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
23409 .vindex "&$inode$&"
23410 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
23411 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
23412 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
23414 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
23416 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
23417 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
23421 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
23422 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
23423 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
23426 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
23427 See &%check_string%& above.
23430 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
23431 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
23432 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
23433 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
23434 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
23435 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
23438 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23441 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23442 .cindex "locking files"
23443 .cindex "lock files"
23444 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
23445 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
23447 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
23448 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
23451 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
23452 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
23455 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
23456 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
23457 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
23458 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
23459 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
23460 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
23464 .option file_format appendfile string unset
23465 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
23466 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
23467 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
23468 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
23469 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
23470 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
23471 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
23472 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
23475 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
23476 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
23478 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
23479 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
23480 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
23481 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
23482 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
23483 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
23484 delivery is deferred.
23487 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
23488 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
23489 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
23490 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
23493 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
23494 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23495 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
23496 .cindex "locking files"
23497 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
23498 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
23499 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
23500 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
23501 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
23502 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
23503 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
23504 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
23506 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
23507 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
23508 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
23509 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
23511 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
23512 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23515 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23517 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23518 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23519 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23521 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23522 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23524 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23527 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23528 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23529 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23530 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23533 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23534 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23535 for details of locking.
23538 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23539 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23540 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23543 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23544 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23545 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23548 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23549 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23550 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23551 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23552 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23555 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23556 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23557 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23558 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23559 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23560 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23561 external source that maintains the data.
23564 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23565 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23566 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23567 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23568 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23569 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23570 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23571 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23575 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23576 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23577 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23578 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23579 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23580 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23581 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23582 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23583 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23584 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23587 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23588 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23589 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23590 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23591 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23592 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23593 calculation. The default value is:
23595 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23597 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23598 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23600 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23602 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23604 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23605 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23606 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23607 directly into that directory.
23610 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23611 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23612 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23615 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23616 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23617 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23620 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23621 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23622 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23623 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23624 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23625 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23626 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23627 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23629 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23630 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23631 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23632 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23633 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23634 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23635 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23636 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23637 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23638 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23641 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23642 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23643 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23644 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23645 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23646 below for further details.
23649 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23650 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23651 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23654 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23655 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23656 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23659 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23660 .cindex "locking files"
23661 .cindex "file" "locking"
23662 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23663 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23664 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23665 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23666 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23667 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23668 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23670 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23671 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23672 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23679 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23680 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23681 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23682 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23683 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23684 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23685 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23686 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23688 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23689 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23690 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23691 append messages to it.
23694 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23695 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23696 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23697 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23698 in which case it is:
23700 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23701 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23703 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23704 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23706 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23707 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23708 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23709 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
23714 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23715 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23717 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23718 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
23719 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
23720 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
23721 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
23722 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
23723 value, and this option is ignored.
23726 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
23727 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
23728 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
23729 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
23730 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
23733 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
23734 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
23735 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
23736 on users about incoming mail.
23739 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
23740 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
23741 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
23742 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
23743 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
23744 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
23745 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
23746 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
23747 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
23749 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
23750 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
23751 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
23753 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
23754 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23755 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23756 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23757 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23758 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23760 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23761 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23762 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23763 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23764 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23767 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23768 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23770 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23772 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23773 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23774 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23775 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23776 system quota failures.
23778 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23779 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23780 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23781 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23782 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23783 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23784 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23785 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23786 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23787 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23790 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23791 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23792 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23793 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23794 delivery directory.
23797 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23798 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23799 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23800 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23801 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23804 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23805 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23807 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23808 See &%quota%& above.
23811 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23812 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23813 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23814 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23815 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23816 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23817 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23819 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23820 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23821 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23822 the file length to the filename. For example:
23824 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23825 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23827 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23828 number of lines in the message.
23830 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23831 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23832 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23834 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23836 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23837 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23838 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23839 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23840 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23841 as is used to adjust the effective size.
23844 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23845 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23846 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23848 quota_warn_message = "\
23849 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23850 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23851 This message is automatically created \
23852 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23853 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23854 a warning threshold that is\n\
23855 set by the system administrator.\n"
23859 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23860 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23861 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23862 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23863 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23864 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23865 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23866 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23867 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23871 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23873 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23874 percent sign is ignored.
23876 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23877 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23878 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23879 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23880 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23881 &'From:'& line, the default is:
23883 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23885 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23886 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23889 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23890 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23894 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23895 .cindex "envelope from"
23896 .cindex "envelope sender"
23897 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23898 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23899 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23900 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23901 for details of batch SMTP.
23904 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23905 .cindex "carriage return"
23907 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23908 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23909 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23910 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23912 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23913 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23914 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23915 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23916 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23917 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23920 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23921 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23922 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23923 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23924 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23925 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23928 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23929 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23930 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23931 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23932 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23934 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23935 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23936 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23937 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23939 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23940 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23941 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23942 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23943 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23946 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23947 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23950 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23951 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23952 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23953 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23954 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23955 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23956 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23958 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23959 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23960 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23961 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23964 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23965 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23966 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23969 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23970 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23971 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23972 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23973 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23974 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23975 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23976 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23977 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23979 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23980 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23981 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23982 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23987 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23988 .cindex "appending to a file"
23989 .cindex "file" "appending"
23990 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23993 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23997 .cindex "directory creation"
23998 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23999 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
24000 &%directory_mode%& option.
24003 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
24004 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
24008 .cindex "file" "locking"
24009 .cindex "locking files"
24010 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24011 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
24012 reliably over NFS, as follows:
24015 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
24016 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
24017 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
24019 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
24021 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
24022 Unlink the hitching post name.
24024 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
24025 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
24026 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
24027 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
24029 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
24030 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
24031 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
24032 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
24033 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
24034 it before trying again.
24038 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
24039 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
24040 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
24043 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
24044 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
24045 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
24046 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
24047 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
24048 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
24049 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
24050 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
24051 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
24055 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
24056 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
24057 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
24058 delivery is deferred.
24061 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
24062 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
24063 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
24067 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
24068 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
24069 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
24072 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
24073 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
24074 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
24077 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
24078 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
24079 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
24080 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
24081 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
24082 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
24083 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
24084 that prevents link following.
24087 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
24088 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
24089 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
24090 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
24091 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
24094 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
24097 .cindex "file" "locking"
24098 .cindex "locking files"
24099 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
24100 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
24101 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
24102 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
24103 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
24105 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
24107 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
24108 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
24109 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
24111 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
24112 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
24113 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
24115 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
24116 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
24117 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
24118 delivery is deferred.
24120 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
24121 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
24122 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
24123 immediately. It retries up to
24125 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
24127 times (rounded up).
24130 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
24131 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
24134 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
24135 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
24136 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24137 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
24138 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
24139 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
24140 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
24141 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
24142 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
24143 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
24145 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
24146 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
24147 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
24148 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
24149 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
24150 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
24151 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
24153 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
24154 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
24155 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
24156 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
24159 .cindex "maildir format"
24160 .cindex "mailstore format"
24161 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
24162 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
24163 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
24164 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
24165 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
24167 .cindex "directory creation"
24168 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
24169 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
24170 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
24171 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
24172 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
24173 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
24178 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
24179 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
24180 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
24181 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
24182 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
24183 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
24184 &_new_& subdirectory.
24186 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
24187 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
24188 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
24189 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
24190 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
24191 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
24192 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
24194 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
24195 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
24196 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
24197 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
24198 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
24199 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
24200 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
24201 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
24203 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
24204 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
24205 folders. Consider this example:
24207 maildir_format = true
24208 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
24209 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
24210 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
24211 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
24213 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
24214 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
24215 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
24216 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
24217 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
24218 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
24220 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
24221 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
24222 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
24223 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
24224 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
24226 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
24227 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
24228 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
24230 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24231 .cindex "maildir++"
24232 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
24233 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
24234 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
24235 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
24236 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
24237 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
24238 amount of space used.
24240 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
24241 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
24242 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
24243 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
24244 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
24245 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
24250 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
24251 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
24252 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
24253 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
24254 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
24255 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
24258 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24259 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
24260 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
24261 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
24262 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
24263 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
24264 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
24265 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
24266 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
24267 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
24268 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
24269 backwards compatibility).
24271 For one common implementation, you might set:
24273 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
24275 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
24277 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
24278 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
24279 &[stat()]& each message file.
24282 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
24283 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24284 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
24285 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
24286 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
24287 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
24288 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
24289 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
24290 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
24292 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
24293 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
24294 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
24295 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
24296 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
24297 need to know the quota.
24299 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
24300 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
24302 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
24303 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
24304 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
24308 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
24309 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
24310 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
24311 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
24312 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
24313 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
24314 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
24315 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
24317 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
24318 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
24319 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
24320 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
24321 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
24322 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
24324 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
24325 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
24326 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
24327 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
24328 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
24329 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
24331 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
24332 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
24333 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
24334 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
24337 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
24338 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
24339 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
24340 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
24341 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
24343 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
24345 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
24346 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
24347 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
24348 .ecindex IIDapptra1
24349 .ecindex IIDapptra2
24356 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24357 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24359 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
24360 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
24361 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
24362 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
24363 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
24364 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
24365 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
24366 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
24368 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
24369 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
24370 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
24371 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
24372 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
24375 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
24376 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
24377 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
24378 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
24379 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
24381 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
24382 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
24383 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
24384 transport is run as a consequence of a
24386 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
24387 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
24388 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
24389 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
24390 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
24391 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
24393 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
24394 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
24395 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
24396 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
24398 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
24399 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
24400 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
24401 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
24402 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
24403 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
24404 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
24406 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
24407 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
24408 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
24409 the transport defers.
24410 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
24411 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
24413 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
24414 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
24415 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
24416 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
24418 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24419 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
24420 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
24421 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
24422 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
24423 problems. They are just discarded.
24427 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
24428 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
24430 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
24431 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
24432 message when the message is specified by the transport.
24435 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
24436 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
24437 when the message is specified by the transport.
24440 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
24441 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
24442 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
24443 string comes first.
24446 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
24447 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
24448 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
24451 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
24452 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
24453 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
24456 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
24457 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
24458 specified by the transport.
24461 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
24462 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
24463 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
24464 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
24467 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
24468 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
24469 the message is specified by the transport.
24472 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
24473 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
24477 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
24478 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
24479 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
24480 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
24481 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
24485 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
24486 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
24487 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
24488 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
24490 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
24491 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
24492 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
24493 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
24494 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
24495 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
24496 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
24499 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
24500 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
24501 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
24502 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
24503 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
24505 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
24506 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
24507 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
24508 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
24509 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
24510 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
24513 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
24514 See &%once%& above.
24517 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24518 See &%once%& above.
24519 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24522 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24523 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24524 specified by the transport.
24527 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24528 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24529 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24530 configuration option.
24533 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24534 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24535 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24536 automatic responses. For example:
24538 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24540 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24541 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24542 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24543 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24548 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24549 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24550 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24551 the text comes first.
24554 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24555 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24556 when the message is specified by the transport.
24557 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24558 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24564 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24566 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24567 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24568 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24569 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24570 .cindex "LMTP" "over a unix-domain socket"
24571 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
24573 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24574 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24575 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24576 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24577 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24578 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24582 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24583 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24584 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24587 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24588 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24591 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24592 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24593 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24594 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24595 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24598 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24599 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24600 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24601 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24602 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24603 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24606 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24607 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24608 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24609 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24610 in its response to the LHLO command.
24612 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24613 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24614 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24615 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24618 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24619 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24620 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24621 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24626 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24630 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24631 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24635 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24636 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24638 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24639 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24640 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24641 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24642 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24643 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24644 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24645 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24649 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24650 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24651 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24652 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24653 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24655 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24656 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24657 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24658 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24659 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24660 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24661 that are routed to the transport.
24663 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24664 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24665 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24666 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24667 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24668 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24669 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24673 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24674 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24675 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24677 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24678 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24679 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24680 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24681 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24682 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24683 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24685 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24686 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24687 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24690 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24691 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24692 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24693 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24694 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24695 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24696 of "1" to enforce serialization.
24701 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
24702 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
24703 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
24704 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
24705 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
24706 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
24707 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
24708 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
24709 &"local delivery failed"&.
24711 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
24712 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
24713 will be sent as normal.
24715 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
24716 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
24717 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
24718 apply in this case.
24720 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
24721 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
24722 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
24723 a non-existent command may be the problem.
24725 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
24726 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
24727 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
24728 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
24729 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
24730 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
24731 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
24736 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
24737 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
24738 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
24739 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
24740 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
24743 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
24744 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
24745 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
24746 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
24748 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
24749 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
24750 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
24751 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
24752 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24754 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24756 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24757 arguments. You have to write
24759 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24761 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24762 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24763 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24764 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24765 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24766 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24769 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24772 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24773 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24774 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24775 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24776 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24777 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24778 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24779 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24780 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24781 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24782 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24784 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24785 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24786 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24787 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24788 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24789 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24790 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24791 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24793 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24794 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24795 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24796 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24797 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24798 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24799 control what is done with it.
24801 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24802 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24803 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24804 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24805 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24806 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24807 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24808 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24809 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24810 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24811 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24815 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24816 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24817 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24818 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24819 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24820 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24821 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24822 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24823 &*Note*&: Using enviroment variables loses track of tainted data.
24824 Writers of &(pipe)& transport commands should be wary of data supplied
24825 by potential attackers.
24827 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24828 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24829 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24830 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24831 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24832 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24833 &`LOGNAME `& see below
24834 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24835 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24836 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24837 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24838 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24839 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24840 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24841 &`USER `& see below
24843 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24844 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24845 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24846 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24847 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24848 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24849 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24852 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24853 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24854 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24858 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24859 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24860 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24861 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24864 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24865 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24869 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24870 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24871 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24872 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24873 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24874 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24875 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24876 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24877 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24878 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24879 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24882 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24884 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24885 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24886 &%use_shell%& is set.
24889 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24890 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24893 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
24894 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24895 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24898 .option check_string pipe string unset
24899 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24900 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24901 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24902 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24903 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24904 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24905 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24909 .option command pipe string&!! unset
24910 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24911 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24912 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24913 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24914 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24915 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24917 .cindex "tainted data"
24918 No part of the resulting command may be tainted.
24921 .option environment pipe "string list&!!" unset
24922 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24923 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24924 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24925 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24926 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24927 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24930 .option escape_string pipe string unset
24931 See &%check_string%& above.
24934 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24935 .cindex "exec failure"
24936 .cindex "failure of exec"
24937 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24938 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24939 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24940 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24941 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24944 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24945 .cindex "signal exit"
24946 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24947 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24948 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24949 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24952 .option force_command pipe boolean false
24953 .cindex "force command"
24954 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24955 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24956 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24957 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24958 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24959 command. For example:
24961 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24965 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24966 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24967 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24970 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24971 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24972 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24973 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24974 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24975 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24977 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24978 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24981 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24982 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24983 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24984 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24985 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24986 written to the main log.
24989 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24990 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24991 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24992 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24993 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24994 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24998 .option log_output pipe boolean false
24999 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
25000 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
25001 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
25002 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25005 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
25006 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
25007 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
25008 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
25009 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
25010 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
25011 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
25012 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
25015 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
25016 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
25017 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
25020 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
25024 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
25025 .cindex "&""From""& line"
25026 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
25027 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
25028 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
25033 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25034 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
25037 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
25038 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
25039 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
25040 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
25044 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25045 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
25048 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
25049 This option is expanded and
25050 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
25051 variable of the subprocess.
25052 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
25053 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
25054 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
25057 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
25058 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
25059 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
25060 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
25061 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
25062 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
25063 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
25064 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
25065 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
25068 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
25069 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
25070 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
25071 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
25072 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
25073 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
25074 accept the message is used.
25077 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
25078 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
25079 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
25080 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
25081 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
25082 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
25085 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
25086 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
25087 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
25088 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
25089 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
25090 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
25091 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25095 .option return_output pipe boolean false
25096 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
25097 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
25098 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
25099 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
25100 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
25101 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
25102 of them may be set.
25106 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
25107 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
25108 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
25109 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
25110 and &%return_output%& is not set,
25111 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
25112 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
25113 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
25114 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
25115 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
25116 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
25117 and 73, respectively.
25120 .option timeout pipe time 1h
25121 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
25122 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
25123 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
25124 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
25125 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
25126 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
25128 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
25129 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
25130 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
25131 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
25132 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
25133 delivery to be deferred.
25135 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
25136 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
25139 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
25140 .cindex "envelope sender"
25141 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
25142 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
25143 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
25144 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
25145 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
25147 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
25148 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
25149 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
25150 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
25151 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
25152 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
25156 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
25157 .cindex "carriage return"
25159 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
25160 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
25161 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
25162 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
25164 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
25165 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
25166 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
25167 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
25168 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
25171 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
25172 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
25173 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
25174 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
25175 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
25176 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
25177 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
25178 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
25179 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
25184 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
25185 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
25186 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
25187 .cindex "external local delivery"
25188 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
25189 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
25190 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
25191 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
25192 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
25193 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
25194 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
25195 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
25196 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
25197 configuration for &%procmail%&:
25202 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
25206 check_string = "From "
25207 escape_string = ">From "
25209 user = $local_part_data
25216 transport = procmail_pipe
25218 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
25219 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
25220 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
25221 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
25222 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
25223 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
25225 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
25229 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
25230 use a shell to run pipe commands.
25233 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
25234 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
25235 . Used to have R: local_part_suffix = .* + T: -m $local_part_suffix_v
25236 . but that suffix is tainted so cannot be used in a command arg
25237 . Really, you'd want to use a lookup for acceptable suffixes to do real detainting
25240 local_delivery_cyrus:
25242 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
25243 -- $local_part_data
25255 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
25257 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
25258 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
25260 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
25261 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
25264 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25265 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25267 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
25268 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
25269 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
25270 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
25271 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
25272 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
25273 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
25274 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
25277 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
25278 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
25282 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
25283 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
25284 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
25285 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
25286 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
25287 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
25288 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
25290 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
25291 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
25292 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
25293 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
25294 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
25295 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
25300 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
25301 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
25302 no further messages are sent over that connection.
25306 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
25308 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25309 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
25310 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
25311 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
25312 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
25313 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
25314 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
25315 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
25318 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
25319 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25320 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25321 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25322 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25323 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
25324 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25325 are the values that were set when the message was received.
25326 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
25327 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
25328 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
25329 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
25330 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
25331 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
25333 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
25334 and will be removed in a future release.
25337 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
25338 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
25339 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
25342 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
25343 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
25344 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
25345 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
25346 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
25347 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
25348 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
25349 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
25351 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
25352 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
25353 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25354 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
25355 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
25356 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
25357 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
25358 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
25359 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
25362 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
25364 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
25365 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
25366 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
25367 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
25368 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
25371 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
25372 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
25373 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
25374 particular connection.
25376 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
25377 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
25378 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
25379 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
25381 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
25382 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
25383 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
25385 authenticated_sender = $local_part
25387 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
25388 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
25390 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
25391 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
25395 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
25396 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
25397 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
25398 authenticated as a client.
25401 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
25402 .cindex timeout "smtp transport command"
25403 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
25404 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
25405 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
25408 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
25409 .cindex timeout "smtp transport connect"
25410 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
25411 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
25412 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
25413 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
25414 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
25415 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
25418 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
25419 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
25420 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
25421 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25422 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
25423 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
25424 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
25427 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
25428 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a MAILMAX value,
25429 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
25430 that value also constrains the result of this option.
25433 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25434 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
25435 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25436 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
25437 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
25438 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
25439 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
25440 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
25441 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
25442 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
25443 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
25444 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
25445 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
25446 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
25449 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
25450 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data blocks"
25451 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
25452 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
25453 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
25456 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
25457 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25458 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
25459 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25460 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
25461 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25462 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
25463 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25464 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
25465 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25466 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
25467 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25468 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
25469 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25470 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
25471 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25472 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
25473 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25476 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
25477 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25478 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25479 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
25480 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
25483 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
25484 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
25485 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
25486 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
25487 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
25488 unhappy at this prospect, so...
25490 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25491 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
25492 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25493 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
25494 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
25495 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
25496 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
25497 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
25501 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
25502 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
25503 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
25504 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
25505 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
25508 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
25509 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
25510 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
25511 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
25515 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
25516 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25517 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25518 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25519 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25520 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
25521 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
25522 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
25527 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
25528 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25529 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25530 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25531 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25532 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25533 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25534 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25535 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25539 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25540 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25541 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25542 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25543 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25544 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25545 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25547 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25548 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25549 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25550 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25551 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25554 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25555 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25556 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25557 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25558 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25559 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25560 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25561 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25563 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25564 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25565 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25566 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25567 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25568 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25570 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25571 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25572 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25573 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25574 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25576 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25577 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25578 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25579 copy of the message is sent.
25581 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25582 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25583 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25584 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25588 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25589 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data accept"
25590 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25591 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25594 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25595 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25596 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25597 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25598 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25599 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25601 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25602 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25603 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25604 implementations of TLS.
25606 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25607 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25608 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25609 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25610 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25611 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25612 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25617 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25618 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25619 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25620 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25621 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25622 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25623 interface address, you could use this:
25625 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address} \
25626 {${listextract{1}{<\n $value}}} \
25627 {$primary_hostname}}
25629 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25632 .option host_name_extract smtp "string list&!!" "see below"
25633 .cindex "load balancer" "hosts behind"
25634 .cindex TLS resumption
25635 Some mail-accepting sites
25636 (notably Microsoft)
25637 operate many servers behind a network load-balancer. When this is done,
25638 with separated TLS session caches, TLS session resuption becomes problematic.
25639 It will only succeed when the same server happens to be selected by the
25640 load-balancer, matching the session stored in the client's cache.
25642 Exim can pull out a server name, if there is one, from the response to the
25643 client's SMTP EHLO command.
25644 For normal STARTTLS use, the default value of this option:
25646 ${if and { {match {$host} {.outlook.com\$}} \
25647 {match {$item} {\N^250-([\w.]+)\s\N}} \
25650 suffices for one known case.
25652 During the expansion of this option the &$item$& variable will have the
25653 server's EHLO response.
25655 For TLS-on-connect connections we do not have an EHLO
25656 response to use. Because of this the default value of this option is
25657 set to a static string for those cases, meaning that resumption will
25658 always be attempted if permitted by the &%tls_resumption_hosts%& option.
25660 The result of the option expansion is included in the key used to store and
25661 retrieve the TLS session, for session resumption.
25663 Operators of high-load sites may wish to evaluate their logs for indications
25664 of other destination sites operating load-balancers, and develop a suitable
25665 expression for this option.
25666 The smtp:ehlo event and the &$tls_out_resumption$& variable
25667 will be useful for such work.
25669 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25670 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25671 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25672 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25673 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25674 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25676 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25677 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25678 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25679 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25681 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25682 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25683 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25684 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25685 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25686 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25687 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25689 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25690 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25691 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25692 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25693 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25694 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25695 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25698 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
25699 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
25702 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25703 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
25704 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
25705 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
25706 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25707 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
25708 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
25709 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
25710 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
25711 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
25714 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
25715 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25716 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
25717 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
25718 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
25720 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
25721 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
25722 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
25723 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
25724 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
25725 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
25727 The retry hints database is used for the record,
25728 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
25729 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
25730 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
25731 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
25733 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
25736 When the facility is used, if the transport &%interface%& option is unset
25737 the &%helo_data%& option
25738 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
25740 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
25741 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
25742 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
25743 You have been warned.
25746 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25747 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25748 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25749 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25751 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25752 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25753 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
25754 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
25755 to any host that matches this list.
25758 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
25759 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25760 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
25761 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
25762 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
25763 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
25764 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
25765 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
25768 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
25769 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
25770 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
25775 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25776 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25777 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25778 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25779 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
25780 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25781 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
25782 explanation of when this might be needed.
25784 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25785 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25786 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25787 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25788 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
25789 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25790 message on the same session.
25792 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
25793 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
25794 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
25795 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
25796 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
25797 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
25802 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
25803 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
25804 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
25805 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
25806 &%fallback_hosts%&.
25809 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25810 .cindex "randomized host list"
25811 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25812 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25813 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25814 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25815 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25816 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25817 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25818 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25820 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25821 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25822 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25823 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
25825 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25827 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25828 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25829 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25831 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25832 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25833 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25834 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25835 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25836 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25837 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25838 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25839 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25842 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" "see below"
25843 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25844 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
25845 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25846 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25848 The default is &"**"& if DANE is not in use for the connection,
25849 or if DANE-TA us used.
25850 It is empty if DANE-EE is used.
25852 .option hosts_require_alpn smtp "host list&!!" unset
25853 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in client"
25855 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
25856 If the TLS library supports ALPN
25857 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any host
25858 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
25859 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
25861 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
25862 managed by this option; see &%hosts_require_tls%&.
25864 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
25865 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25866 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
25867 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25868 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25869 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
25870 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25871 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25872 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25874 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25875 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25876 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
25877 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25878 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25880 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25881 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25882 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25883 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25884 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
25885 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
25887 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25888 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
25889 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25890 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
25891 connects. If authentication fails
25892 and &%hosts_require_auth%& permits,
25893 Exim will try to transfer the message unauthenticated.
25894 See also chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25896 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
25897 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
25898 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
25899 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
25900 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25901 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
25902 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
25903 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
25905 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25906 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25907 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25908 If built with DANE support, Exim will look up a
25909 TLSA record for any host matching the list,
25910 If one is found and that lookup was DNSSEC-validated,
25911 then Exim requires that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made for that host;
25912 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25913 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25914 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25916 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25917 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25918 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25919 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25920 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25921 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25922 perform a TCP Fast Open.
25923 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25924 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25925 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25927 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25928 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25930 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25931 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25932 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25933 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25934 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25936 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25937 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25938 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
25939 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25940 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25941 for multi-recipient messages.
25942 The option can usually be left as default.
25944 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
25945 .cindex "bind IP address"
25946 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
25948 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25949 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
25950 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
25951 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
25952 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
25953 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
25954 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
25955 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
25958 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
25959 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
25960 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
25961 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
25962 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
25963 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
25966 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
25968 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
25969 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
25970 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
25971 interface to use if the host has more than one.
25974 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
25975 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25976 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25977 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25978 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25979 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25980 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25981 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25982 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25983 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25987 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25988 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25989 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25990 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25991 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25993 .option max_rcpt smtp integer&!! 100
25994 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25997 limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25998 SMTP message transaction.
25999 A value setting of zero disables the limit.
26001 If a constant is given,
26002 each set of addresses is treated independently, and
26003 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
26006 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26007 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTMAX value,
26008 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26009 that value also constrains the result of this option
26010 and no parallel connections will be caused on meeting the RCPTMAX limit.
26013 .option message_linelength_limit smtp integer 998
26014 .cindex "line length" limit
26015 This option sets the maximum line length, in bytes, that the transport
26016 will send. Any messages with lines exceeding the given value
26017 (before a transport filter, if any)
26018 will fail and a failure-DSN ("bounce") message will if possible be returned
26020 The default value is that defined by the SMTP standards.
26022 It is generally wise to also check in the data ACL so that messages
26023 received via SMTP can be refused without producing a bounce.
26026 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
26027 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26028 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
26029 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
26030 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
26031 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
26032 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
26033 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
26035 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
26036 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
26037 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
26039 If the connection is DANE-enabled then this option is ignored;
26040 only messages having the domain used for the DANE TLSA lookup are
26041 sent on the connection.
26043 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26044 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTDOMAINMAX value,
26045 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26046 this option is regarded as being false.
26049 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
26050 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
26051 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
26052 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
26053 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
26054 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
26055 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
26056 variable that contains an outgoing port.
26058 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
26059 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
26061 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
26062 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
26063 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
26066 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
26067 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
26071 .option protocol smtp string smtp
26072 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
26073 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
26074 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
26076 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
26077 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
26078 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
26079 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
26080 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
26082 &*Note*&: When using LMTP it should be considered whether the default values
26083 for some other features, such as DANE, are appropriate.
26085 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
26086 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
26087 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
26088 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
26089 but as of RFC 8314 it is preferred over STARTTLS for message submission
26090 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
26093 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
26094 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
26095 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
26096 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
26097 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
26098 addresses is not affected.
26100 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
26101 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
26102 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
26103 Exim to use only the host name.
26104 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
26107 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26108 .cindex "serializing connections"
26109 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
26110 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
26111 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
26112 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
26113 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
26114 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
26115 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
26117 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
26118 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
26119 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
26120 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
26121 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
26122 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
26124 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
26125 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
26126 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
26127 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
26128 are used for ETRN serialization.
26130 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
26133 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
26134 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
26135 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
26136 .cindex "size" "of message"
26137 .cindex "transport" "filter"
26138 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
26139 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
26140 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
26141 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
26142 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
26143 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
26144 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
26146 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
26147 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
26150 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
26151 .cindex proxy SOCKS
26152 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
26153 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
26156 .option tls_alpn smtp string&!! unset
26157 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26159 .cindex ALPN "set name in client"
26160 If this option is set
26161 and the TLS library supports ALPN,
26162 the value given is used.
26164 As of writing no value has been standardised for email use.
26165 The authors suggest using &"smtp"&.
26169 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
26170 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
26171 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
26173 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26174 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26175 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
26176 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
26177 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
26180 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
26181 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
26182 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
26183 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
26187 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
26188 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
26189 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
26190 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
26191 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
26194 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
26195 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
26196 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
26197 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
26198 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
26199 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
26202 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
26205 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
26206 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
26208 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26209 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26210 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
26211 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
26212 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26213 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
26214 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
26215 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26218 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
26219 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
26220 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
26222 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26223 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
26224 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
26225 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
26226 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26227 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
26228 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
26229 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
26230 ciphers is a preference order.
26233 .option tls_resumption_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26234 .cindex TLS resumption
26235 This option controls which connections to use the TLS resumption feature.
26236 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
26240 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
26241 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26243 .cindex SNI "setting in client"
26244 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
26245 If this option is set
26246 and the connection is not DANE-validated
26247 then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
26248 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
26249 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
26250 certificate and private key for the session.
26252 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
26254 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
26260 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
26261 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
26262 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
26263 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
26264 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
26265 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
26266 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
26267 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
26268 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26269 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26273 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
26274 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26275 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26276 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26277 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
26278 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26279 Note that unless the host is in this list
26280 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
26281 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
26282 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
26283 certificate verification succeeds.
26286 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
26287 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
26288 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26289 This option give a list of hosts for which,
26290 while verifying the server certificate,
26291 checks will be included on the host name
26292 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
26293 versus the Subject-Alternate-Name (or, if none, Subject-Name) fields.
26294 Wildcard names are permitted,
26295 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
26297 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
26300 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
26301 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26302 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26304 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26305 The value of this option must be either the
26307 or the absolute path to
26308 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
26309 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
26311 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
26312 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
26313 is taken as empty and an explicit location
26316 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
26317 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
26319 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
26321 either by file or directory
26322 are added to those given by the system default location.
26324 The values of &$host$& and
26325 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26326 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26328 For back-compatibility,
26329 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
26330 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
26331 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
26334 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26335 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26336 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26337 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26338 certificate verification must succeed.
26339 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26340 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
26341 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
26342 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
26343 that connections use TLS.
26344 Fallback to in-clear communication will be done unless restricted by
26345 the &%hosts_require_tls%& option.
26347 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
26348 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
26349 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
26350 If built with internationalization support,
26351 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
26353 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
26354 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
26355 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
26356 set this option to an empty string.
26357 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
26362 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
26364 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26365 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
26366 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
26367 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
26368 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
26371 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
26372 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
26373 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
26374 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
26377 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
26378 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
26379 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
26381 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
26382 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
26383 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
26384 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
26385 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
26387 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
26388 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
26389 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
26390 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
26391 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
26392 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
26393 see below for an exception).
26395 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
26396 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
26397 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
26398 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
26399 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
26401 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
26402 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
26403 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
26404 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
26405 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
26406 reached their retry times.
26408 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
26409 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
26410 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
26411 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
26412 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
26413 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
26414 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
26415 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
26416 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
26417 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
26420 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
26421 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
26422 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
26423 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
26424 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
26425 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
26427 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
26428 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
26429 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
26430 possible IP addresses have been tried.
26431 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
26432 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
26438 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26441 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
26442 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
26443 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
26444 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
26445 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
26446 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
26448 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
26449 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
26450 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26451 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
26452 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
26453 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
26454 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
26456 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
26457 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
26458 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
26459 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
26462 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
26463 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
26464 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
26465 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
26467 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
26468 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
26469 facility; you do not have to use it.
26471 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
26472 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
26473 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
26474 address to which it applies.
26476 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
26477 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
26478 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
26479 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
26480 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
26481 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
26484 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
26485 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
26486 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
26487 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
26490 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
26491 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
26492 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
26493 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
26494 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
26497 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
26498 illustrated by these examples:
26501 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
26502 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
26503 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
26504 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
26506 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
26507 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
26512 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
26513 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
26514 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
26515 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
26516 message's processing.
26518 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26519 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
26520 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&), but no
26521 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
26522 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
26523 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
26524 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
26525 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
26526 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
26528 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26529 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26530 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
26531 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
26532 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
26533 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
26534 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
26535 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
26536 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
26537 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
26539 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
26540 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
26541 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
26542 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
26543 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
26544 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
26546 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
26547 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
26548 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
26550 .cindex "envelope from"
26551 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
26552 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
26553 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
26554 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
26555 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
26556 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
26557 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
26558 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
26559 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
26561 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
26562 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
26568 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
26569 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
26570 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
26571 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
26572 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
26573 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
26574 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
26575 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
26576 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
26577 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
26579 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
26581 might produce the output
26583 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26584 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26585 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26586 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26587 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26588 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26589 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26590 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26592 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
26593 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
26594 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
26595 set for a particular transport.
26598 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
26599 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
26600 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
26603 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
26605 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
26606 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
26607 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
26608 any colons must be doubled, of course).
26610 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
26611 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
26612 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
26613 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
26616 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
26617 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
26618 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
26620 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
26621 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
26622 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
26623 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
26624 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
26625 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
26626 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
26628 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26629 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26630 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
26631 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
26632 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
26636 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
26637 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26640 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
26641 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
26642 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
26643 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
26644 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
26645 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
26646 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
26647 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
26648 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
26650 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26651 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26652 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26654 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26655 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26656 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26657 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26658 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26659 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26660 of pattern they are set as follows:
26663 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26664 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26665 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26668 *queen@*.fict.example
26670 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26672 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26676 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26677 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26680 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26681 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26682 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26683 rewriting rule of the form
26685 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26687 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
26693 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
26694 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
26695 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
26696 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
26697 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
26701 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
26702 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
26703 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
26704 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
26705 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
26707 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
26709 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
26712 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26713 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26714 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
26715 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
26716 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26717 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
26718 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
26719 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
26720 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
26721 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
26722 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
26723 entry written to the panic log.
26727 .subsection "Rewriting flags" "SSECID153"
26728 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
26731 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
26734 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
26736 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
26739 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
26740 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
26744 .subsection "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
26746 .cindex rewriting flags
26747 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
26748 &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
26749 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
26750 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
26751 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
26753 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
26754 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
26755 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
26756 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
26757 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
26758 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
26759 &`h`& rewrite all headers
26760 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
26761 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
26762 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
26764 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
26765 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
26766 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
26768 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
26769 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
26772 .subsection "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" SSECTrewriteS
26773 .cindex SMTP "rewriting malformed addresses"
26774 .cindex RCPT "rewriting argument of"
26775 .cindex MAIL "rewriting argument of"
26776 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
26777 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
26778 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
26779 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
26780 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
26782 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26783 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26784 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
26785 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
26786 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
26787 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
26788 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
26789 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
26792 .subsection "Flags controlling the rewriting process" SSECID155
26793 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
26794 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
26795 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
26798 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
26799 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
26800 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
26802 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
26803 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
26804 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
26805 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
26807 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
26808 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
26809 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
26811 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
26812 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
26813 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
26814 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
26816 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
26820 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
26823 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
26824 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
26825 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
26826 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
26827 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
26828 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
26829 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
26830 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
26832 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
26833 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
26837 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
26838 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
26840 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
26841 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
26842 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
26844 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
26845 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
26846 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
26847 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
26848 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
26849 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
26850 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
26851 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
26853 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
26854 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
26856 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
26858 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
26859 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
26861 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
26862 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
26863 messages that originate outside the local host:
26865 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
26866 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
26868 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
26871 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
26872 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
26873 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
26874 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
26875 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
26876 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
26877 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
26878 components. For example, the rule
26880 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
26882 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
26883 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
26884 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
26885 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
26886 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
26887 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
26888 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
26895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26896 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26898 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
26899 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
26900 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
26901 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
26902 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
26903 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
26904 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
26905 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
26906 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
26907 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
26908 address, domain and error.
26910 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
26911 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
26912 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
26913 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
26914 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
26915 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
26916 log selector is set, the message
26917 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
26918 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
26919 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
26920 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
26922 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
26923 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
26924 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
26925 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
26926 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
26927 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
26928 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
26929 domain are maintained independently.
26931 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
26932 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
26933 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
26934 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
26935 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
26936 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
26937 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
26938 the local address is reached.
26940 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
26941 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
26942 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
26943 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
26944 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
26946 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
26947 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
26948 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
26949 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
26950 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
26951 messages that it should now be retaining.
26955 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
26956 .cindex "retry" "rules"
26957 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
26958 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
26959 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
26960 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
26961 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
26962 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
26963 message's sender, respectively.
26966 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
26967 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
26968 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
26969 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
26970 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
26971 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
26974 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26976 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
26979 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26981 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
26982 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
26985 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
26986 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
26987 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
26988 expressions work in address lists.
26990 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
26991 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
26995 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
26996 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
26997 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
26998 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
26999 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
27000 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
27001 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
27002 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
27003 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
27005 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
27006 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
27007 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
27008 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
27011 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
27012 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
27013 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
27014 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
27015 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
27016 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
27017 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
27018 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
27019 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
27020 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
27025 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
27027 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
27028 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
27029 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
27030 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
27031 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
27032 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
27034 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
27038 and the retry rules are
27040 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
27041 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
27043 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
27044 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
27045 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
27046 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
27047 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
27048 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
27050 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
27051 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
27052 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
27053 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
27055 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
27056 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
27057 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
27059 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
27061 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
27062 textual form of the IP address.
27064 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
27065 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
27066 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
27067 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
27070 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
27071 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
27072 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
27074 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
27075 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
27076 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
27078 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
27079 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
27081 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
27082 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
27085 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
27086 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
27087 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
27088 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
27089 retry rule of this form:
27091 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
27093 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
27094 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
27097 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
27098 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
27099 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
27100 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
27103 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
27104 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
27105 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
27106 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
27107 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
27109 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
27110 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
27112 .vitem &%refused_A%&
27113 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
27116 A connection was refused.
27118 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
27119 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
27121 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
27122 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
27124 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
27125 A connection attempt timed out.
27127 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
27128 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
27129 obtained from an MX record.
27131 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
27132 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
27133 obtained from an MX record.
27136 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
27138 .vitem &%tls_required%&
27139 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
27140 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
27141 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
27144 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27147 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
27148 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
27149 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
27150 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27151 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
27152 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
27156 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
27157 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
27158 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
27159 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
27160 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
27164 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
27165 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
27166 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
27168 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
27169 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
27170 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
27171 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
27172 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
27173 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
27174 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
27176 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
27177 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
27180 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
27181 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
27182 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
27187 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
27188 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
27189 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
27190 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
27191 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
27194 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
27196 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
27198 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
27200 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
27201 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
27204 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
27206 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
27207 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
27208 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
27209 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
27210 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
27212 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
27213 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
27215 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
27217 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
27218 list is never matched.
27224 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
27225 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
27226 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
27227 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
27229 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
27231 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
27232 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
27233 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
27234 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
27235 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
27237 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
27238 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
27239 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
27240 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
27241 The available algorithms are:
27244 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
27247 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
27248 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
27249 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
27251 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
27252 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
27253 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
27254 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
27255 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
27256 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
27257 queue processing times.
27260 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
27261 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
27262 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
27263 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
27264 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
27265 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
27266 interval is found. The main configuration variable
27267 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
27268 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
27269 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
27270 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
27271 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
27273 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
27274 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
27275 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
27276 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
27277 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
27278 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
27281 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
27282 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
27283 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
27284 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
27285 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
27286 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
27287 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
27288 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
27289 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
27290 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
27291 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
27292 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
27294 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
27295 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
27296 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
27297 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
27298 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
27299 deliveries that have been deferred.
27302 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
27303 Here are some example retry rules:
27305 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
27306 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
27307 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
27308 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27309 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
27310 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
27312 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
27313 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
27314 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
27315 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
27316 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
27317 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
27318 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
27321 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
27322 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
27323 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
27324 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
27325 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
27327 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
27328 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
27329 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
27330 were not obtained from an MX record.
27332 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
27333 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
27334 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
27335 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
27336 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
27340 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
27341 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
27342 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
27343 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
27344 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
27345 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
27346 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
27347 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
27348 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
27349 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
27350 failing for the first time.
27352 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
27353 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
27354 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
27355 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
27357 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
27358 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
27359 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
27364 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
27365 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
27366 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
27367 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
27368 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
27369 default retry rule:
27371 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
27373 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
27374 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
27375 failure for the recipient address that counts.
27377 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
27378 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
27379 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
27380 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
27381 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
27383 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
27384 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
27385 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
27387 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
27388 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
27389 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
27390 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
27391 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
27392 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
27393 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
27394 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
27395 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
27396 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
27397 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
27399 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
27400 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
27401 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
27402 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
27403 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
27406 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
27407 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
27408 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
27409 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
27410 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
27411 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
27412 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
27413 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
27414 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
27417 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
27418 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
27419 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
27420 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
27421 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
27422 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
27423 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
27424 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
27427 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
27428 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
27429 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
27430 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
27431 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
27432 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
27433 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
27434 time out the address.
27436 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
27437 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
27438 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
27439 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
27440 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
27441 considered immediately.
27442 .ecindex IIDretconf1
27443 .ecindex IIDregconf2
27450 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27451 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27453 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
27454 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
27455 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
27456 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
27457 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
27458 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
27459 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
27460 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
27461 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
27464 The name of an authenticator is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
27465 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
27468 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
27469 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
27470 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
27473 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
27474 the client's EHLO command.
27476 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
27477 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
27479 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
27480 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
27481 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
27482 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
27483 with the AUTH command.
27485 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
27487 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
27488 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
27489 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27492 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
27493 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
27494 unauthenticated connection.
27497 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
27498 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
27499 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
27500 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
27502 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
27503 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
27504 &`Connected to server.example.`&
27505 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
27506 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
27507 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
27508 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
27509 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
27514 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
27515 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
27516 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
27517 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
27518 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
27519 included by setting
27522 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
27526 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
27531 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
27532 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
27533 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
27534 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
27535 work via a socket interface.
27536 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
27537 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
27538 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
27539 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
27540 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
27541 supporting setting a server keytab.
27542 The seventh can be configured to support
27543 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
27544 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
27545 The eighth authenticator
27546 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
27547 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
27548 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
27550 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
27551 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
27552 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
27553 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
27554 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
27555 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
27556 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
27558 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
27559 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
27560 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
27561 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
27562 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
27563 both sets of options, is required. For example:
27567 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27568 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
27570 client_secret = secret2
27572 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
27573 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
27575 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
27576 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
27577 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
27580 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
27581 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
27582 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
27583 authenticating data.
27585 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
27586 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
27587 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
27588 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
27589 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
27590 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
27591 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
27592 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
27593 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
27594 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
27597 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
27598 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
27599 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
27600 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
27604 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
27605 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
27606 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
27608 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27609 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
27610 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
27611 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
27612 encrypted by a setting such as:
27614 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27618 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27619 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
27620 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
27621 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
27624 .option driver authenticators string unset
27625 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
27626 authenticators is to be used.
27629 .option public_name authenticators string unset
27630 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
27631 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
27632 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
27633 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
27634 defaults to the driver's instance name.
27637 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27638 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
27639 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
27640 mechanism is not advertised.
27641 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
27642 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
27643 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
27646 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27647 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
27648 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
27651 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
27652 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
27654 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27655 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27656 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27657 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27658 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27659 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27660 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27661 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27662 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27666 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27667 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27668 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27669 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27670 out the values of variables.
27671 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27672 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27675 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27676 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27677 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27678 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
27679 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
27680 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
27681 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
27682 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
27683 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
27684 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
27685 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
27686 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
27689 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27690 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
27691 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
27692 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
27693 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
27694 remembered for later use.
27695 How it is used is described in the following section.
27701 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
27702 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
27703 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27704 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
27705 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
27709 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
27710 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
27712 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
27714 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
27715 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
27716 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
27717 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
27718 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
27719 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
27720 given for the MAIL command.
27722 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
27723 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
27726 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
27727 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
27728 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
27729 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
27730 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
27731 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
27732 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
27737 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
27738 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
27739 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
27740 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
27742 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
27743 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
27744 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
27745 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
27746 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
27751 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
27752 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
27753 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
27754 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
27758 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
27760 If the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
27761 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
27764 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
27765 the mechanisms are advertised.
27767 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
27768 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
27769 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
27770 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
27771 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
27772 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
27773 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
27775 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
27777 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
27779 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
27780 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
27781 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
27784 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
27786 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27787 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
27788 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
27790 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
27791 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
27792 command. This is the case if
27795 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
27797 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
27799 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
27800 server authenticators.
27804 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
27805 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
27806 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
27808 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
27809 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
27810 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
27811 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
27812 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
27813 rejected with a 504 error.
27815 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
27816 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
27817 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
27818 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
27819 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
27820 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
27821 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
27822 no successful authentication.
27824 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
27825 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
27826 &%authresults%& expansion item.
27828 .cindex authentication "failure event, server"
27829 If an authenticator is run and does not succeed,
27830 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
27831 While the event is being processed the variables
27832 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
27833 and &$authenticated_fail_id$& (as set by the authenticator &%server_set_id%& option)
27835 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged
27836 instead of the default log line.
27837 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
27840 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
27841 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
27842 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
27843 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
27844 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
27845 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
27846 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
27850 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
27852 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
27853 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
27854 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
27855 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
27856 command line to run this script on such data might be
27858 encode '\0user\0password'
27860 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
27861 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
27862 whose code value is zero.
27864 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
27865 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
27866 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
27867 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
27869 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
27870 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
27871 example, a command such as
27873 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
27875 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
27877 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to produce
27878 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
27880 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
27882 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
27883 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
27884 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
27885 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
27889 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
27890 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
27891 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
27892 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
27893 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
27894 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
27897 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
27898 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
27899 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
27900 of the authenticator.
27903 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27904 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
27905 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
27906 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
27907 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
27908 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
27909 delivery to be deferred.
27911 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
27912 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
27913 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
27917 .cindex authentication "failure event, client"
27918 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code),
27919 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
27920 While the event is being processed the variable
27921 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
27923 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged.
27924 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
27927 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
27928 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
27929 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
27930 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
27931 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
27932 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
27933 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
27934 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
27935 deliver the message unauthenticated.
27938 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
27939 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
27940 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
27941 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
27942 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
27943 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
27944 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
27945 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
27947 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
27949 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27950 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
27951 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
27952 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
27953 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
27954 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
27955 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
27956 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
27957 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
27958 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
27959 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
27960 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
27961 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
27968 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27969 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27971 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
27972 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
27973 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
27974 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
27975 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
27976 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
27977 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
27978 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
27979 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
27980 connections as you do for login accounts.
27982 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
27983 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
27984 TLS is not being used:
27986 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
27987 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
27990 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
27991 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
27992 (including their names) have been properly verified.
27994 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
27995 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
27996 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
27998 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27999 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
28000 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
28002 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
28003 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
28004 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
28007 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
28008 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28009 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28010 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28011 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28012 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28013 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28015 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
28016 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28017 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28018 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
28019 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
28020 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
28021 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
28023 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
28024 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
28025 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28026 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28028 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
28029 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
28030 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
28032 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28033 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
28034 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28035 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28036 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28037 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28038 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28039 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28040 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28041 string as the error text.
28043 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
28044 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
28045 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
28049 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
28050 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
28051 .cindex authentication PLAIN
28052 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28053 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
28054 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
28055 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
28056 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
28058 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
28059 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
28060 configured as follows:
28064 public_name = PLAIN
28066 server_condition = \
28067 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
28068 server_set_id = $auth2
28070 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
28071 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
28072 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
28073 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
28075 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
28076 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
28077 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
28078 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
28082 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
28084 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
28086 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
28087 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
28091 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
28092 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
28094 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
28095 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
28096 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
28097 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
28098 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
28100 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
28101 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
28102 authenticating clients it could make sense.
28104 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
28105 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
28106 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
28107 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
28108 This is an incorrect example:
28110 server_condition = \
28111 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
28113 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
28114 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
28115 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
28116 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
28117 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
28118 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
28119 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
28121 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
28122 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
28124 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
28125 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
28126 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
28127 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
28128 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
28131 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
28132 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
28133 .cindex authentication LOGIN
28134 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
28135 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
28136 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
28137 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
28141 public_name = LOGIN
28142 server_prompts = User Name : Password
28143 server_condition = \
28144 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
28145 server_set_id = $auth1
28147 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
28148 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
28149 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
28150 strings are used to obtain two data items.
28152 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
28153 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
28154 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
28155 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
28156 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
28160 public_name = LOGIN
28161 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
28162 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
28165 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
28166 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
28167 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
28168 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
28170 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
28171 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
28172 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
28173 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
28174 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
28175 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
28176 uninterpreted string.
28179 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
28180 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
28181 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
28182 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
28183 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
28189 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
28190 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
28191 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
28193 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
28194 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
28195 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
28196 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
28199 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
28200 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
28201 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
28202 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
28203 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
28204 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
28205 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
28206 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
28207 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
28208 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
28209 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
28210 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
28212 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
28213 splitting takes priority and happens first.
28215 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
28216 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
28217 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
28218 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
28221 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
28222 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
28226 public_name = PLAIN
28227 client_send = ^username^mysecret
28229 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
28230 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs.
28231 Note that due to the ambiguity of parsing three consectutive circumflex characters
28232 there is no way to provide a password having a leading circumflex.
28236 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
28240 public_name = LOGIN
28241 client_send = : username : mysecret
28243 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
28244 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
28246 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
28247 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
28252 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28253 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28255 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
28256 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28257 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
28258 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
28259 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
28260 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
28261 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
28262 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
28263 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
28264 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
28265 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
28266 available in plain text at either end.
28269 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
28270 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
28271 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
28272 authenticator as a server:
28274 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28275 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28276 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
28277 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
28278 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
28279 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
28280 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
28281 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
28282 returned to the client.
28284 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
28285 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
28286 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
28287 numeric variables for other things.
28289 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
28290 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
28291 user name, authentication fails.
28295 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28296 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
28297 server_set_id = $auth1
28299 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28300 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
28301 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
28302 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
28306 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28307 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
28309 server_set_id = $auth1
28311 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
28312 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
28314 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
28315 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
28316 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
28321 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28322 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
28323 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28324 server_set_id = $auth1
28327 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
28328 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
28329 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
28333 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
28334 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
28335 computing the response to the server's challenge.
28338 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28339 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
28340 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
28344 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28345 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
28346 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
28347 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
28348 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
28349 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
28350 send the message to the current server.
28352 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
28357 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28359 client_secret = secret
28361 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
28362 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
28366 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28367 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28369 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
28370 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
28371 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
28372 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
28374 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
28375 at A L Digital Ltd.
28377 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
28378 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
28379 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
28380 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
28381 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
28383 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
28384 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
28385 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
28386 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
28388 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
28389 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
28390 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
28391 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
28392 depending on the driver you are using.
28394 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
28395 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
28396 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
28397 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
28398 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
28401 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
28402 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
28403 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
28404 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
28405 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
28406 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
28407 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
28408 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
28411 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
28412 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
28413 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
28414 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
28415 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
28416 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
28420 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
28421 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28422 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
28423 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
28426 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
28427 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28428 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28429 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28433 driver = cyrus_sasl
28434 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28435 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28436 server_set_id = $auth1
28439 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
28440 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28443 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
28444 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28447 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
28448 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
28449 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
28450 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
28453 driver = cyrus_sasl
28454 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28455 server_set_id = $auth1
28458 driver = cyrus_sasl
28459 public_name = PLAIN
28460 server_set_id = $auth2
28462 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
28463 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
28464 but it is present in many binary distributions.
28465 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
28466 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
28471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28473 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
28474 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
28475 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
28476 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
28477 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
28478 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
28479 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
28480 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
28481 authenticator only. There is only one non-generic option:
28483 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
28485 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
28486 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
28487 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
28488 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
28492 public_name = PLAIN
28493 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher}
28494 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28495 server_set_id = $auth1
28500 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28501 server_set_id = $auth1
28504 &*Note*&: plaintext authentication methods such as PLAIN and LOGIN
28505 should not be advertised on cleartext SMTP connections.
28506 See the discussion in section &<<SECTplain_TLS>>&.
28508 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
28509 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
28510 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
28511 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
28512 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
28513 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
28515 The Dovecot configuration to match the above will look
28518 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
28523 unix_listener auth-client {
28530 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
28532 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
28535 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
28536 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
28539 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28540 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28541 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
28542 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
28543 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
28544 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
28545 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
28546 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28547 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28548 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
28549 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
28550 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
28551 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
28552 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
28553 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
28554 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
28555 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
28556 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
28557 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
28558 without code changes in Exim.
28560 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
28561 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
28562 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
28565 To see the list of mechanisms supported by the library run Exim with "auth" debug
28566 enabled and look for a line containing "GNU SASL supports".
28567 Note however that some may not have been tested from Exim.
28570 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
28571 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
28572 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
28573 by &%client_username%& option.
28574 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
28575 which is the common case.
28577 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28578 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
28580 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
28581 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28582 the password to be used, in clear.
28584 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
28585 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28586 the account name to be used.
28589 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
28590 This option is only supported for library versions 1.9.1 and greater.
28591 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY will be defined when this is so.
28593 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
28594 and correctly sized
28595 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
28596 The value after expansion should be
28597 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
28598 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
28600 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
28601 supplied by the server.
28602 The option is expanded before use.
28603 During the expansion &$auth1$& is set with the client username,
28604 &$auth2$& with the iteration count, and
28605 &$auth3$& with the salt.
28607 The intent of this option
28608 is to support clients that can cache thes salted password
28609 to save on recalculation costs.
28610 The cache lookup should return an unusable value
28611 (eg. an empty string)
28612 if the salt or iteration count has changed
28614 If the authentication succeeds then the above variables are set,
28615 .vindex "&$auth4$&"
28616 plus the calculated salted password value value in &$auth4$&,
28617 during the expansion of the &%client_set_id%& option.
28618 A side-effect of this expansion can be used to prime the cache.
28621 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28622 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
28623 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
28624 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
28625 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
28628 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
28629 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
28630 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
28633 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
28634 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
28635 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
28637 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
28638 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
28639 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
28641 . However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
28642 . Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
28643 . with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
28645 This option was deprecated in previous releases due to doubts over
28646 the "Triple Handshake" vulnerability.
28647 Exim takes suitable precausions (requiring Extended Master Secret if TLS
28648 Session Resumption was used) for safety.
28651 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
28652 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28653 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28654 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28657 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
28658 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28659 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28660 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28665 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28666 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28667 server_set_id = $auth1
28671 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
28672 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
28673 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
28674 the password itself.
28676 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
28677 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
28678 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
28679 if available, else the empty string.
28680 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
28681 else the empty string.
28683 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
28685 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
28686 option to be simply "true".
28689 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
28690 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28691 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28694 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
28695 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28696 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28697 when this option is expanded.
28699 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
28700 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
28701 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
28702 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
28703 either the iteration count or the salt).
28704 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
28705 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
28707 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
28708 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28709 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28710 when this option is expanded.
28711 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
28712 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
28713 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
28714 protocol conversation.
28717 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
28718 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
28719 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
28720 to provide stored information related to a password,
28721 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
28723 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
28724 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
28726 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
28727 When this is so, the macros
28728 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
28729 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
28732 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
28734 If set, the results of expansion should for each
28735 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
28736 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
28737 &%server_password%& option.
28738 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
28740 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
28741 to generate these values.
28744 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
28745 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28746 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28749 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
28750 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28751 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
28752 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
28754 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
28755 meanings for these variables:
28758 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28759 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
28761 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28762 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
28764 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
28765 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
28768 On a per-mechanism basis:
28771 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28772 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
28773 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28775 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28776 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
28777 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28779 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28780 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
28781 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
28782 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28785 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
28786 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
28787 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
28790 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
28791 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
28793 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
28795 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28796 server_realm = imap.example.org
28797 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
28798 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28799 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
28800 server_condition = yes
28804 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28805 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28807 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
28808 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
28809 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
28810 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28811 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
28812 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
28813 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
28816 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
28817 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
28818 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
28819 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28821 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
28822 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
28823 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
28824 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
28826 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
28827 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
28828 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
28832 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
28833 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
28834 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
28835 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
28837 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
28838 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
28839 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
28840 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
28842 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28844 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28845 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
28847 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28848 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
28849 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
28854 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28855 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28857 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
28858 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
28859 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
28860 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
28861 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
28862 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
28863 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
28864 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
28865 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
28866 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
28867 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
28868 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
28869 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
28873 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
28874 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
28876 The server sends back a challenge.
28878 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
28879 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
28882 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
28886 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
28887 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
28888 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
28890 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
28891 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
28892 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
28893 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
28894 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
28895 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
28896 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
28897 for other things. For example:
28902 server_password = \
28903 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
28905 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28906 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28912 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
28913 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
28914 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
28918 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
28919 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
28922 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
28923 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
28926 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
28927 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
28928 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
28934 client_username = msn/msn_username
28935 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
28936 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
28938 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
28939 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
28945 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28946 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28948 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
28949 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
28950 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
28951 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28952 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
28953 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28954 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
28955 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
28956 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
28957 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
28958 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
28959 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
28960 by the server configuration.
28962 The client presents an identity in-clear.
28963 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
28964 and for clients to only attempt,
28965 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
28967 One possible use, compatible with the
28968 K-9 Mail Android client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
28969 is for using X509 client certificates.
28971 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
28972 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
28973 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
28974 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
28975 client certificates only.
28977 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
28978 client-certificate authentication is being done.
28980 The client must present a certificate,
28981 for which it must have been requested via the
28982 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28983 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28984 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
28985 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
28987 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
28988 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
28989 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
28991 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
28992 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
28993 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28994 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
28995 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
28996 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28997 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28999 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
29001 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
29002 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29003 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
29004 "in &(external)& authenticator"
29005 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29006 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29008 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
29009 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
29010 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
29011 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
29012 an identity for authentication and
29013 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
29015 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
29016 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
29017 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
29018 string expansions that also use them for other things.
29020 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29021 Once an identity has been received,
29022 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
29023 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
29024 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
29025 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
29026 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
29027 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
29028 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
29029 string as the error text.
29033 ext_ccert_san_mail:
29035 public_name = EXTERNAL
29037 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
29038 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29039 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29040 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
29041 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
29042 server_set_id = $auth1
29044 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29045 of your configured trust-anchors
29046 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29047 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
29049 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
29050 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29051 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29055 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
29056 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
29057 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
29059 .option client_send external string&!! unset
29060 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
29061 identity being asserted.
29067 public_name = EXTERNAL
29069 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
29070 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
29074 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
29075 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
29081 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29084 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
29085 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
29086 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
29087 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29088 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29089 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29090 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
29091 authentication based on client certificates.
29093 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
29094 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
29095 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
29096 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
29097 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
29098 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
29100 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
29101 for which it must have been requested via the
29102 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29103 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29105 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
29106 run immediately after a TLS connection being negotiated
29107 (due to either STARTTLS or TLS-on-connect)
29108 and can authenticate the connection.
29109 If it does, SMTP authentication is not subsequently offered.
29111 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
29114 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
29115 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
29117 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
29118 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
29119 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
29120 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
29121 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29122 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29124 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
29125 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
29126 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
29128 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
29135 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29136 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29137 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
29140 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
29141 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
29142 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
29144 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
29146 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29147 of your configured trust-anchors
29148 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29149 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
29151 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
29152 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29153 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29155 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
29157 . An alternative might use
29159 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
29161 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
29162 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
29163 . This would help for per-device use.
29165 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
29166 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
29168 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
29169 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
29172 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
29173 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
29174 a connect- or helo-ACL.
29178 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29181 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
29182 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
29183 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
29184 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
29185 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
29188 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
29189 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
29190 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
29191 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
29192 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
29193 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
29194 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
29195 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
29196 certificates are used.
29198 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
29199 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
29200 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
29201 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
29202 between them is encrypted.
29204 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
29205 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
29206 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
29207 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
29210 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
29211 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
29212 in order to get TLS to work.
29216 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
29218 .cindex "submissions protocol"
29219 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
29220 .cindex "smtps protocol"
29221 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
29222 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
29223 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
29224 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
29225 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
29226 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
29227 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
29228 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
29230 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
29231 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
29232 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
29234 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
29235 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
29236 reassigned for other use.
29237 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
29239 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
29240 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
29241 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
29243 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
29244 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
29245 the most common use is expected to be:
29247 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
29249 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
29250 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
29251 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
29252 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
29253 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
29256 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
29257 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
29264 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
29265 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
29266 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
29267 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
29273 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
29279 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
29280 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
29282 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
29285 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
29286 cannot be the path of a directory
29287 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
29288 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
29290 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
29292 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29293 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
29294 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
29295 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
29296 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
29298 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
29299 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
29300 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
29301 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
29302 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
29303 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
29304 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
29307 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
29308 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
29310 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
29311 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
29312 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
29313 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
29315 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option,
29316 it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
29318 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
29319 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
29320 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
29321 implementation, then patches are welcome.
29323 The output from "exim -bV" will show which (if any) support was included
29325 Also, the macro "_HAVE_OPENSSL" or "_HAVE_GNUTLS" will be defined.
29329 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
29330 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
29331 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
29332 but not the chosen filename.
29333 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
29334 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
29336 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
29337 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
29338 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
29339 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
29341 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
29342 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
29343 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
29344 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
29345 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
29346 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
29347 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
29349 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
29350 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
29351 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
29352 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
29353 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
29355 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
29356 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
29357 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
29358 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
29359 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
29360 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
29362 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
29363 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
29364 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
29366 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
29367 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
29368 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
29369 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
29372 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
29375 # chown exim:exim new-params
29376 # chmod 0600 new-params
29377 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
29378 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
29379 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
29380 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
29381 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
29382 # chmod 0400 new-params
29383 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
29385 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
29386 stalling is removed.
29388 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
29389 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
29390 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
29391 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
29392 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
29393 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
29394 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
29395 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
29396 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
29397 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
29398 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
29400 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
29401 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
29402 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
29403 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
29405 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
29406 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
29407 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
29408 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
29409 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
29412 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
29413 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
29414 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
29415 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
29416 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
29417 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
29418 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
29419 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
29420 directly to this function call.
29421 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
29422 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
29423 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
29424 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
29427 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
29429 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
29430 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
29431 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
29434 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
29435 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
29436 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
29440 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
29443 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
29444 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
29447 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
29448 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
29450 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
29451 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
29454 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
29455 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
29456 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
29457 not be moved to the end of the list.
29460 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
29463 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
29464 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
29467 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29468 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
29469 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
29470 choice of clients used:
29472 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
29473 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29478 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
29480 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
29483 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
29484 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
29485 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
29486 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
29488 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
29490 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
29494 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
29496 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
29497 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
29498 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
29499 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
29500 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
29501 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
29502 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
29503 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
29504 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
29505 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
29507 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
29508 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
29510 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
29511 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
29512 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
29513 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
29514 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
29515 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
29517 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
29518 "Priority strings". This is online as
29519 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
29520 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
29521 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
29522 then the example code
29523 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
29524 on that site can be used to test a given string.
29528 # Disable older versions of protocols
29529 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
29532 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
29533 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
29534 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
29536 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29537 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
29538 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
29539 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
29543 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29549 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
29550 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
29551 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29552 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
29553 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
29554 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
29555 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
29556 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
29558 If STARTTLS is to be used you
29559 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
29561 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
29562 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
29563 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
29566 554 Security failure
29568 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
29569 rejected with a 554 error code.
29571 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
29572 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
29574 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
29575 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
29576 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
29577 from someone able to intercept the communication.
29579 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
29581 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
29583 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
29584 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
29586 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
29587 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
29588 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
29589 that goes with it. These files need to be
29590 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
29591 always be given as full path names.
29592 The key must not be password-protected.
29593 They can be the same file if both the
29594 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
29595 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
29596 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
29597 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
29598 the server's certificate.
29600 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
29601 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
29602 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
29603 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
29604 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
29605 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
29607 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
29608 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
29609 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
29611 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
29612 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
29613 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
29616 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
29617 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
29618 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
29620 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
29622 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
29623 with the parameters contained in the file.
29624 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
29629 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
29630 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
29631 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
29632 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
29638 for a way of generating file data.
29640 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
29641 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
29642 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
29643 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
29644 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
29646 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29647 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29648 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
29649 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
29650 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
29651 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
29652 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
29653 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
29654 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
29656 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
29657 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
29658 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
29659 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
29660 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
29661 documentation for more details.
29663 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
29664 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
29667 .subsection "Requesting and verifying client certificates"
29668 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29669 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29670 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
29671 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
29672 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
29673 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
29674 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
29675 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
29676 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
29677 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
29678 an explicit file or,
29679 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
29680 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
29682 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
29685 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
29686 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
29687 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
29689 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
29691 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
29693 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
29694 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
29696 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
29697 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
29698 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
29699 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
29700 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
29701 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
29702 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
29703 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
29704 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
29705 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
29707 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29708 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
29709 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
29710 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
29712 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29713 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
29714 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
29715 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
29716 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
29717 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
29720 .subsection "Caching of static server configuration items" "SSECTserverTLScache"
29721 .cindex certificate caching
29722 .cindex privatekey caching
29723 .cindex crl caching
29724 .cindex ocsp caching
29725 .cindex ciphers caching
29726 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29727 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29728 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29729 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29730 .cindex tls_crl caching
29731 .cindex tls_ocsp_file caching
29732 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29733 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29734 .cindex caching certificate
29735 .cindex caching privatekey
29736 .cindex caching crl
29737 .cindex caching ocsp
29738 .cindex caching ciphers
29739 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29740 If any of the main configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&,
29741 &%tls_crl%& and &%tls_ocsp_file%& have values with no
29742 expandable elements,
29743 then the associated information is loaded at daemon startup.
29744 It is made available
29745 to child processes forked for handling received SMTP connections.
29747 This caching is currently only supported under Linux and FreeBSD.
29749 If caching is not possible, for example if an item has to be dependent
29750 on the peer host so contains a &$sender_host_name$& expansion, the load
29751 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29753 The cache is invalidated and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29754 containing files specified by these options.
29756 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29757 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29758 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29759 The latter case is not automatically invalidated;
29760 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29761 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29762 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29763 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29765 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29766 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
29768 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29769 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
29775 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
29776 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29777 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29778 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29779 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
29780 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
29781 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
29782 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
29783 within the &(smtp)& transport.
29785 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29786 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
29787 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
29788 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
29789 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
29790 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
29792 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
29793 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
29794 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
29795 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
29796 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
29799 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
29800 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
29801 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
29802 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
29803 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
29804 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
29805 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
29806 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
29807 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
29808 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
29811 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
29812 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
29814 This is an optional thing for TLS connections, although either end
29816 If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
29817 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
29819 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
29820 for client use (they are usable for server use).
29821 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
29822 in failed connections.
29824 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
29825 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
29827 the system default set (depending on library version),
29829 or (depending on library version) a directory.
29830 The client verifies the server's certificate
29831 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
29832 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
29833 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
29834 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
29836 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
29837 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
29838 or need not succeed respectively.
29840 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
29841 name checks are made on the server certificate.
29842 The match against this list is, as per other Exim usage, the
29843 IP for the host. That is most closely associated with the
29844 name on the DNS A (or AAAA) record for the host.
29845 However, the name that needs to be in the certificate
29846 is the one at the head of any CNAME chain leading to the A record.
29847 The option defaults to always checking.
29849 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
29850 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
29851 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
29853 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
29854 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
29855 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
29858 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
29859 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
29860 for OCSP to be relevant.
29863 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
29864 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
29865 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
29866 alternative hosts, if any.
29869 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
29870 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
29871 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
29875 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
29876 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
29877 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
29878 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
29879 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
29881 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
29882 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
29883 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
29884 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
29885 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
29886 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
29887 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
29888 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
29889 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
29890 outgoing connection.
29894 .subsection "Caching of static client configuration items" SECTclientTLScache
29895 .cindex certificate caching
29896 .cindex privatekey caching
29897 .cindex crl caching
29898 .cindex ciphers caching
29899 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29900 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29901 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29902 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29903 .cindex tls_crl caching
29904 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29905 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29906 .cindex caching certificate
29907 .cindex caching privatekey
29908 .cindex caching crl
29909 .cindex caching ciphers
29910 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29911 If any of the transport configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&
29912 and &%tls_crl%& have values with no
29913 expandable elements,
29914 then the associated information is loaded per smtp transport
29915 at daemon startup, at the start of a queue run, or on a
29916 command-line specified message delivery.
29917 It is made available
29918 to child processes forked for handling making SMTP connections.
29920 This caching is currently only supported under Linux.
29922 If caching is not possible, the load
29923 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29925 The cache is invalidated in the daemon
29926 and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29927 containing files specified by these options.
29929 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29930 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29931 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29932 The latter case is not automatically invaludated;
29933 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29934 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29935 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29936 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29938 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29939 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
29941 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29942 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
29948 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
29949 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
29952 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
29953 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
29954 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
29955 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
29956 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
29957 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
29958 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
29959 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
29962 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
29963 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
29966 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
29967 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
29968 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
29969 be of limited use in that environment.
29971 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
29972 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
29973 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
29974 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
29975 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
29977 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
29978 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
29979 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
29980 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
29981 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
29983 If DANE validated the connection attempt then the value of the &%tls_sni%& option
29984 is forced to the name of the destination host, after any MX- or CNAME-following.
29986 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
29987 received from a client.
29988 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
29990 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
29991 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
29992 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
29995 &%tls_certificate%&
30001 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30006 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
30007 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
30008 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
30009 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
30010 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
30011 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
30012 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
30014 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
30017 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
30018 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
30019 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
30020 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
30022 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
30023 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
30024 built, then you have SNI support).
30028 .cindex ALPN "general information"
30029 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
30030 There is a TLS feature related to SNI
30031 called Application Layer Protocol Name (ALPN).
30032 This is intended to declare, or select, what protocol layer will be using a TLS
30034 The client for the connection proposes a set of protocol names, and
30035 the server responds with a selected one.
30036 It is not, as of 2021, commonly used for SMTP connections.
30037 However, to guard against misdirected or malicious use of web clients
30038 (which often do use ALPN) against MTA ports, Exim by default check that
30039 there is no incompatible ALPN specified by a client for a TLS connection.
30040 If there is, the connection is rejected.
30042 As a client Exim does not supply ALPN by default.
30043 The behaviour of both client and server can be configured using the options
30044 &%tls_alpn%& and &%hosts_require_alpn%&.
30045 There are no variables providing observability.
30046 Some feature-specific logging may appear on denied connections, but this
30047 depends on the behaviour of the peer
30048 (not all peers can send a feature-specific TLS Alert).
30050 This feature is available when Exim is built with
30051 OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later or GnuTLS 3.2.0 or later;
30052 the macro _HAVE_TLS_ALPN will be defined when this is so.
30056 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
30058 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
30059 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
30060 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
30061 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
30062 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
30063 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
30064 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
30065 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
30066 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
30067 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
30069 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
30070 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
30071 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
30072 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
30073 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
30074 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
30075 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
30077 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
30078 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
30079 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
30080 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
30081 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
30082 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
30083 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
30084 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
30085 and delay other deliveries to that host.
30087 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
30088 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
30089 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
30090 information is recorded.
30092 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
30093 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
30094 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
30099 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
30100 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
30101 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
30102 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
30103 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
30104 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
30106 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
30107 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
30108 document is currently at
30110 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
30112 and their FAQ is at
30114 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
30117 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
30118 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
30120 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
30121 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
30122 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
30123 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
30126 .subsection "Certificate chains" SECID186
30127 A file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
30128 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
30129 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
30130 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
30131 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
30132 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
30133 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
30134 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
30135 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
30136 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
30137 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
30138 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
30140 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
30141 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
30142 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
30143 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
30147 .subsection "Self-signed certificates" SECID187
30148 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
30149 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
30150 with OpenSSL, like this:
30151 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
30152 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
30154 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
30157 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
30158 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
30159 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
30160 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
30161 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
30162 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
30163 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
30165 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
30166 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
30167 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
30168 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
30169 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
30170 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
30172 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
30173 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
30174 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
30175 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
30176 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
30177 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
30178 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
30179 be a sensible resolution).
30181 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
30182 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
30183 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
30185 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
30186 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
30187 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
30188 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
30189 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
30190 signed with that self-signed certificate.
30192 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
30193 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
30194 Open-source PKI book, available online at
30195 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
30198 .subsection "Revoked certificates"
30199 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
30200 .cindex "revocation list"
30201 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
30202 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
30203 There are three ways for a certificate to be made unusable
30207 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
30208 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
30209 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
30210 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
30211 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
30213 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
30214 file from every certificate authority they know of.
30217 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
30218 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
30219 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
30220 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
30221 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
30222 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
30224 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
30225 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
30226 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
30227 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
30230 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
30231 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
30232 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
30233 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
30234 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
30235 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
30236 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
30237 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
30239 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
30240 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
30241 support for OCSP stapling is included.
30243 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30244 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
30245 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
30246 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
30247 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
30249 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
30250 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
30251 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
30252 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
30253 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
30256 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
30257 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
30260 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
30261 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
30262 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
30263 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
30264 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
30265 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30267 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
30268 not any of the chain from CA to it.
30270 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
30273 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
30274 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
30275 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
30277 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
30278 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
30279 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
30284 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
30285 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
30288 .section "TLS Resumption" "SECTresumption"
30289 .cindex TLS resumption
30290 TLS Session Resumption for TLS 1.2 and TLS 1.3 connections can be used (defined
30291 in RFC 5077 for 1.2). The support for this requires GnuTLS 3.6.3 or OpenSSL 1.1.1
30294 Session resumption (this is the "stateless" variant) involves the server sending
30295 a "session ticket" to the client on one connection, which can be stored by the
30296 client and used for a later session. The ticket contains sufficient state for
30297 the server to reconstruct the TLS session, avoiding some expensive crypto
30298 calculation and (on TLS1.2) one full packet roundtrip time.
30301 Operational cost/benefit:
30303 The extra data being transmitted costs a minor amount, and the client has
30304 extra costs in storing and retrieving the data.
30306 In the Exim/Gnutls implementation the extra cost on an initial connection
30307 which is TLS1.2 over a loopback path is about 6ms on 2017-laptop class hardware.
30308 The saved cost on a subsequent connection is about 4ms; three or more
30309 connections become a net win. On longer network paths, two or more
30310 connections will have an average lower startup time thanks to the one
30311 saved packet roundtrip. TLS1.3 will save the crypto cpu costs but not any
30314 .cindex "hints database" tls
30315 Since a new hints DB is used on the TLS client,
30316 the hints DB maintenance should be updated to additionally handle "tls".
30321 The session ticket is encrypted, but is obviously an additional security
30322 vulnarability surface. An attacker able to decrypt it would have access
30323 all connections using the resumed session.
30324 The session ticket encryption key is not committed to storage by the server
30325 and is rotated regularly (OpenSSL: 1hr, and one previous key is used for
30326 overlap; GnuTLS 6hr but does not specify any overlap).
30327 Tickets have limited lifetime (2hr, and new ones issued after 1hr under
30328 OpenSSL. GnuTLS 2hr, appears to not do overlap).
30330 There is a question-mark over the security of the Diffie-Helman parameters
30331 used for session negotiation.
30336 The &%log_selector%& "tls_resumption" appends an asterisk to the tls_cipher "X="
30339 The variables &$tls_in_resumption$& and &$tls_out_resumption$&
30340 have bits 0-4 indicating respectively
30341 support built, client requested ticket, client offered session,
30342 server issued ticket, resume used. A suitable decode list is provided
30343 in the builtin macro _RESUME_DECODE for in &%listextract%& expansions.
30348 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& main option specifies a hostlist for which
30349 exim, operating as a server, will offer resumption to clients.
30350 Current best practice is to not offer the feature to MUA connection.
30351 Commonly this can be done like this:
30353 tls_resumption_hosts = ${if inlist {$received_port}{587:465} {:}{*}}
30355 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30356 is offered and/or accepted.
30358 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& smtp transport option performs the
30359 equivalent function for operation as a client.
30360 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30361 is attempted (if a stored session is available) or the information
30362 stored (if supplied by the peer).
30368 In a resumed session:
30370 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_cipher$& will have values different
30371 to the original (under GnuTLS).
30373 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_ocsp$& will be "not requested" or "no response",
30374 and the &%hosts_require_ocsp%& smtp trasnport option will fail.
30375 . XXX need to do something with that hosts_require_ocsp
30381 .section DANE "SECDANE"
30383 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
30384 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
30385 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
30386 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
30387 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
30388 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
30390 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
30391 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
30392 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
30394 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
30395 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
30397 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and communicate via side-channel) copies of server certificates
30398 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
30399 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
30401 DANE requires a server operator to do three things:
30403 Run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
30404 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
30405 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
30408 Add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
30410 Offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
30413 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
30414 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
30415 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
30416 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
30418 .subsection "DNS records"
30419 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
30420 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
30421 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
30422 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
30424 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
30425 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
30426 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
30427 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
30428 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
30429 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
30431 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
30432 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
30433 does require careful arrangement.
30434 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
30435 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
30436 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
30437 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
30438 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
30440 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
30441 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
30443 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
30444 "MTA-STS", described below.
30446 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
30447 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
30448 connections to you.
30449 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
30450 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
30451 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
30452 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
30453 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
30454 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
30456 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
30457 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
30458 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
30459 random serial numbers.
30460 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
30461 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
30462 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
30463 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
30465 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
30466 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
30468 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
30471 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
30472 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
30477 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
30479 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
30482 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
30485 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
30486 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
30489 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
30491 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
30492 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
30493 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
30494 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
30496 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
30497 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
30499 .subsection "Interaction with OCSP"
30500 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
30501 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
30502 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
30505 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
30506 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
30510 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
30511 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
30512 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
30513 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
30514 control the OCSP request.
30516 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
30517 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
30520 .subsection "Client configuration"
30521 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
30522 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
30523 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
30524 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
30525 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
30527 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
30529 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using DNSSEC.
30530 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
30531 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
30532 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
30534 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
30535 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
30536 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
30537 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
30538 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
30539 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
30540 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
30542 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
30546 tls_try_verify_hosts
30547 tls_verify_certificates
30549 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
30553 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
30554 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
30556 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
30557 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
30559 .subsection Observability
30560 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
30562 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
30563 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
30564 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
30565 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
30567 .cindex DANE reporting
30568 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
30569 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
30570 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
30571 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
30572 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
30573 Section 4.3 of that document.
30575 .subsection General
30576 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
30578 DANE is specified in RFC 6698. It decouples certificate authority trust
30579 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
30581 It does retain the need to trust the assurances provided by the DNSSEC tree.
30583 There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS (RFC 8461), which
30584 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website.
30585 The discovery of the address for that website does not (per standard)
30586 require DNSSEC, and could be regarded as being less secure than DANE
30589 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
30590 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
30591 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
30594 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
30595 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
30596 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
30598 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
30599 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
30600 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
30601 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
30602 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
30603 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
30604 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
30608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30611 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
30612 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
30613 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
30614 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
30615 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
30616 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
30617 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
30618 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
30619 one very small ACL:
30623 accept hosts = one.host.only
30625 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
30626 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
30628 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
30629 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
30630 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
30631 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
30632 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
30633 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
30634 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
30635 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30638 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
30639 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
30640 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30643 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
30644 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
30645 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
30646 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
30647 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
30648 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30649 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
30650 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
30651 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30652 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30653 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
30654 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
30655 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30656 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
30657 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
30658 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
30659 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
30660 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30661 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30662 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
30663 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30666 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
30667 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
30668 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
30669 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
30670 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
30671 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
30672 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
30673 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
30674 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
30675 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
30676 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
30677 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
30678 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
30679 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
30680 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
30681 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
30682 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
30683 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
30684 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
30685 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
30686 .irow &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
30689 For example, if you set
30691 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
30693 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
30694 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
30695 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
30696 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
30697 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
30698 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
30699 testing as possible at RCPT time.
30702 .subsection "The non-SMTP ACLs" SECnonSMTP
30703 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30704 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
30705 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
30706 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
30707 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
30708 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
30709 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
30710 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
30711 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
30712 in any of these ACLs.
30714 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
30715 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
30716 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
30717 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
30718 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
30719 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
30720 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
30721 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
30723 control = suppress_local_fixups
30725 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
30726 run, it is too late.
30728 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30729 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30731 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
30732 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
30733 temporary error for these kinds of message.
30736 .subsection "The SMTP connect ACL" SECconnectACL
30737 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30738 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
30739 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
30740 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
30741 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
30742 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
30743 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
30744 &%smtp_banner%& option.
30746 For tls-on-connect connections, the ACL is run before the TLS connection
30747 is accepted; if the ACL does not accept then the TCP connection is dropped without
30748 any TLS startup attempt and without any SMTP response being transmitted.
30751 .subsection "The EHLO/HELO ACL" SECheloACL
30752 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30753 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30754 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
30755 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
30756 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
30757 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
30758 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
30759 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
30761 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
30762 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
30763 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
30765 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
30766 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
30767 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
30768 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
30772 .subsection "The DATA ACLs" SECdataACLS
30773 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30774 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
30775 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
30776 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
30777 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
30778 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
30779 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
30780 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
30781 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
30783 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
30784 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
30785 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
30786 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
30787 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
30788 associated with the DATA command.
30790 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
30791 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
30792 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
30793 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
30794 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
30795 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
30796 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
30797 the data specified is received.
30799 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
30800 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
30801 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
30802 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
30803 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
30806 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
30807 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
30808 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
30809 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
30811 .subsection "The SMTP DKIM ACL" SECTDKIMACL
30812 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
30813 enabled (which is the default).
30815 If, for a specific message, an ACL control
30816 &*dkim_disable_verify*&
30817 has been set, this &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is not called.
30819 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
30820 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
30821 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
30823 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30825 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30828 .subsection "The SMTP MIME ACL" SECID194
30829 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30830 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30832 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30835 .subsection "The SMTP PRDR ACL" SECTPRDRACL
30836 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30837 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
30838 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
30839 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
30840 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
30841 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
30844 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
30845 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
30846 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
30847 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
30848 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
30849 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
30850 for some or all recipients.
30852 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
30853 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
30854 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
30855 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
30856 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
30858 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
30859 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
30860 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
30862 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
30863 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
30865 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30866 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
30867 the feature was not requested by the client.
30869 .subsection "The SMTP WELLKNOWN ACL" SECTWELLKNOWNACL
30870 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
30871 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_wellknown%&"
30872 The &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
30873 with WELLKNOWN support enabled.
30875 The ACL determines the response to an SMTP WELLKNOWN command, using the normal
30876 accept/defer/deny verbs for the response code,
30877 and a new &"control=wellknown"& modifier.
30878 This modifier takes a single option, separated by a '/'
30879 character, which must be the name of a file containing the response
30880 cleartext. The modifier is expanded before use in the usual way before
30881 it is used. The configuration is responsible for picking a suitable file
30882 to return and, most importantly, not returning any unexpected file.
30883 The argument for the SMTP verb will be available in the &$smtp_command_argument$&
30884 variable and can be used for building the file path.
30885 If the file path given in the modifier is empty or inacessible, the control will
30891 accept control = wellknown/\
30892 ${lookup {${xtextd:$smtp_command_argument}} \
30893 dsearch,key=path,filter=file,ret=full \
30894 {$spooldir/wellknown.d}}
30896 File content will be encoded in &"xtext"& form, and line-wrapping
30897 for line-length limitation will be done before transmission.
30898 A response summary line will be prepended, with the (pre-encoding) file size.
30900 The above example uses the expansion operator ${xtextd:<coded-string>}
30901 which is needed to decode the xtext-encoded key from the SMTP verb.
30903 Under the util directory there is a "mailtest" utility which can be used
30904 to test/retrieve WELLKNOWN items. Syntax is
30906 mailtest -h host.example.com -w security.txt
30909 WELLKNOWN is a ESMTP extension providing access to extended
30910 information about the server. It is modelled on the webserver
30911 facilities documented in RFC 8615 and can be used for a security.txt
30912 file and could be used for ACME handshaking (RFC 8555).
30914 Exim will advertise WELLKNOWN support in the EHLO response
30915 .oindex &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&
30916 (conditional on a new option &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&)
30917 and service WELLKNOWN smtp verbs having a single parameter
30918 giving a key for an item of "site-wide metadata".
30919 The verb and key are separated by whitespace,
30920 and the key is xtext-encoded (per RFC 3461 section 4).
30923 .subsection "The QUIT ACL" SECTQUITACL
30924 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30925 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
30926 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
30927 does not in fact control any access.
30928 For this reason, it may only accept
30929 or warn as its final result.
30931 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
30932 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
30933 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
30934 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
30936 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
30937 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
30939 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
30940 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
30943 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
30944 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
30945 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
30946 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
30947 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
30950 .subsection "The not-QUIT ACL" SECTNOTQUITACL
30951 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
30952 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
30953 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
30954 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
30955 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
30956 situation even worse.
30958 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
30959 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
30960 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
30963 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
30964 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
30965 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
30966 connection. The possible values are:
30968 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
30969 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
30970 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
30971 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
30972 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
30973 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
30974 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
30975 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
30976 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
30977 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
30979 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
30980 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
30981 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
30982 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
30983 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
30987 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
30988 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
30989 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
30990 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
30992 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
30993 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
30995 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
30996 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
30997 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
30998 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
30999 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
31001 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
31002 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
31003 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
31006 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
31007 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
31008 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
31009 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
31010 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
31011 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
31013 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
31014 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
31015 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
31017 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
31018 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
31019 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
31020 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
31022 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
31023 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
31024 matches the string.
31026 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
31027 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
31028 want to have something like
31030 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
31032 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
31033 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
31039 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
31040 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
31041 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
31042 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
31043 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
31044 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
31045 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
31046 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
31047 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
31049 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
31050 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
31051 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
31054 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
31055 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
31056 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
31057 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
31059 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
31060 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
31061 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
31062 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
31063 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
31064 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
31065 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
31067 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
31068 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
31071 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
31072 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
31073 recipients; it may create new recipients.
31077 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
31078 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
31079 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
31080 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
31081 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
31082 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
31084 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
31085 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
31086 used to accept or reject anything.
31088 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
31089 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
31090 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
31091 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
31093 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&,
31095 and &%acl_smtp_wellknown%&),
31096 the action when the ACL
31097 is not defined is &"deny"&. This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be
31098 defined in order to receive any messages over an SMTP connection.
31099 For an example, see the ACL in the default configuration file.
31103 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
31104 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
31106 .vindex &$local_part$&
31107 .vindex &$sender_address$&
31108 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
31109 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31110 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
31111 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
31112 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
31113 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
31114 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
31115 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31117 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
31118 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
31119 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
31122 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
31123 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
31124 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
31125 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
31126 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
31129 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
31130 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
31131 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
31132 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
31133 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
31134 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
31135 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
31136 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
31142 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
31143 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
31144 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
31145 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31146 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
31147 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
31148 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31149 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
31150 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
31151 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
31152 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
31153 unencrypted connections.
31156 accept encrypted = *
31157 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
31159 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
31161 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
31162 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
31163 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
31164 option to do this.)
31168 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
31169 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
31170 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
31171 An individual ACL definition consists of a number of statements.
31172 Each statement starts
31173 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
31174 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
31175 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
31177 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
31178 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
31179 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
31182 deny dnslists = list1.example
31183 dnslists = list2.example
31185 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
31186 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
31187 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
31188 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
31189 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
31191 The definition of an ACL ends where another starts,
31192 or a different configuration section starts.
31195 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
31196 The ACL verbs are as follows:
31199 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
31200 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
31201 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
31202 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
31203 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
31204 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
31205 check a RCPT command:
31207 accept domains = +local_domains
31211 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
31212 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
31213 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
31214 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
31217 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
31218 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
31219 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
31222 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
31223 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
31224 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
31225 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
31226 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
31227 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
31229 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
31230 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
31232 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
31233 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
31234 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
31236 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
31237 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
31238 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
31243 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
31244 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
31245 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
31246 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
31247 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
31248 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
31249 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
31253 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
31254 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
31255 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
31258 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31260 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
31264 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
31265 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
31266 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
31267 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
31268 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
31269 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
31270 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
31271 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
31272 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
31274 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
31275 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
31276 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
31280 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
31281 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
31282 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
31284 drop condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
31285 message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
31287 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
31288 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
31291 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
31292 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
31293 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
31294 example, when checking a RCPT command,
31296 require message = Sender did not verify
31299 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
31300 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
31301 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
31302 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
31305 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31306 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
31307 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
31308 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
31309 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
31310 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
31311 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
31313 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
31314 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
31315 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
31316 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
31317 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31319 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
31320 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
31321 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
31322 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
31323 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
31324 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
31328 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31329 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
31330 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
31331 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
31333 warn !verify = sender
31334 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
31338 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
31340 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
31341 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
31342 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
31343 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
31344 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
31348 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
31349 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
31350 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
31351 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
31352 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
31353 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
31354 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
31355 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
31356 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
31357 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
31359 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
31360 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
31361 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
31362 on the same SMTP connection.
31364 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
31365 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
31366 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
31369 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
31370 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
31371 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
31373 accept hosts = whatever
31374 set acl_m4 = some value
31375 accept authenticated = *
31376 set acl_c_auth = yes
31378 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
31379 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
31380 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
31382 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
31383 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
31384 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
31385 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
31386 error is generated.
31388 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
31389 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
31392 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
31393 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
31394 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
31395 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
31397 deny domains = *.dom.example
31398 !verify = recipient
31400 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
31401 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
31402 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
31403 two statements are equivalent:
31405 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
31406 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
31408 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
31409 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
31411 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
31412 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
31413 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
31415 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31416 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
31417 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31418 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
31420 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
31421 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
31422 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
31423 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
31424 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
31425 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
31426 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
31428 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
31429 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
31430 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
31431 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
31432 message is handled.
31434 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
31435 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
31436 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
31437 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
31439 require message = Can't verify sender
31441 message = Can't verify recipient
31443 message = This message cannot be used
31445 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
31446 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
31447 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
31448 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
31449 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
31450 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
31452 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
31453 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
31454 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
31455 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
31458 !senders = *@my.domain.example
31459 message = Invalid sender from client host
31461 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
31462 by which time Exim has set up the message.
31466 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
31467 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
31468 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
31471 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31472 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
31473 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
31474 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31476 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31477 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
31478 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
31479 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
31480 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
31481 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
31482 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
31483 write rather ugly lines like this:
31485 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
31487 Instead, all you need is
31489 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
31492 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31493 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31494 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
31495 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
31496 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
31497 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
31498 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
31499 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
31501 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
31502 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
31503 in several different ways. For example:
31505 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
31506 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
31507 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
31511 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
31513 accept ...some conditions
31516 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
31517 other words, when the conditions are all true.
31520 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
31522 accept ...some conditions...
31524 ...some more conditions...
31526 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
31527 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
31528 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
31532 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
31533 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
31536 warn ...some conditions...
31540 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
31541 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
31545 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
31546 &%require%& verb. For example:
31548 require control = no_multiline_responses
31552 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
31553 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
31555 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
31556 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
31557 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
31558 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
31559 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
31560 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
31562 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
31565 deny ...some conditions...
31568 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
31569 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
31572 ...some conditions...
31574 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
31575 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
31577 warn ...some conditions...
31583 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
31584 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
31585 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
31586 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
31587 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
31588 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
31589 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
31593 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
31594 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
31595 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
31596 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
31597 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
31598 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
31599 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
31602 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31603 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
31604 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
31605 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
31607 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
31608 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
31610 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
31613 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
31614 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
31616 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
31617 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
31618 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
31621 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
31622 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
31623 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
31624 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
31625 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
31626 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
31629 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31630 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
31631 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
31634 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
31635 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
31636 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
31637 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
31638 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
31639 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
31641 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
31642 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
31643 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
31644 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
31645 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
31646 logging rejections.
31649 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
31650 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
31651 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
31652 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
31653 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
31654 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
31655 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
31656 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
31658 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
31659 &` log_reject_target =`&
31661 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
31662 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
31666 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31667 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
31668 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
31669 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
31670 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
31671 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
31672 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
31675 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
31676 &` control = freeze`&
31677 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
31679 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
31680 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
31681 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
31684 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
31685 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
31689 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31690 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
31691 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
31692 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
31693 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
31694 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
31695 &%accept%& for details.)
31697 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
31698 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
31699 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
31700 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
31701 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
31703 require message = Host not recognized
31706 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
31709 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
31710 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
31711 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
31712 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
31713 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
31714 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
31715 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
31716 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
31717 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
31720 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
31721 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
31722 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
31724 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
31725 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
31727 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
31728 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
31729 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
31732 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
31733 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
31735 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
31736 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
31738 If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
31740 A long message line will also be split into multi-line SMTP responses,
31741 on word boundaries if possible.
31743 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31744 While the text is being expanded, the &$acl_verify_message$& variable
31745 contains any message previously set.
31746 Afterwards, &$acl_verify_message$& is cleared.
31748 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
31749 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
31750 However, the original message is available in the variable
31751 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
31752 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
31753 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
31754 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
31756 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
31757 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
31758 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
31759 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
31760 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
31761 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
31765 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31766 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
31767 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
31768 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
31770 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
31772 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
31773 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
31774 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
31775 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
31778 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31779 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
31780 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
31781 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
31784 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
31785 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
31786 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
31787 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
31790 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
31791 .cindex "UDP communications"
31792 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
31793 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
31794 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
31795 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
31796 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
31797 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
31798 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
31801 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
31802 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
31809 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
31810 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31811 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
31814 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
31815 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
31816 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
31817 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
31818 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
31819 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
31820 not work without it. For example:
31822 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
31823 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
31825 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
31826 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
31827 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
31828 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
31829 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
31832 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
31833 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
31834 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
31835 .cindex "case of local parts"
31836 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31837 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
31838 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
31839 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
31840 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
31841 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
31844 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
31845 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
31846 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
31847 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
31848 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
31850 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
31851 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
31854 warn control = caseful_local_part
31855 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
31857 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
31859 control = caselower_local_part
31861 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
31862 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
31865 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
31866 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
31867 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
31868 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
31870 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
31871 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
31872 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
31873 is used for all recipients of the message,
31874 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
31875 and data is copied from one to the other.
31877 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
31878 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
31879 If a recipient-verify callout
31881 connection is subsequently
31882 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
31883 any subsequent recipients and the data,
31884 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
31886 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
31887 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
31888 Note also that headers cannot be
31889 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
31890 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
31891 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
31892 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
31893 this will affect the timestamp.
31895 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
31896 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
31897 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
31898 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
31901 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
31902 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
31903 before the entire message has been received from the source.
31904 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
31908 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
31909 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
31910 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
31911 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
31912 before the acceptance "<=" line.
31914 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
31916 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
31917 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
31918 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
31919 and does not queue the message.
31920 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
31922 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
31924 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
31927 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
31928 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
31929 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
31930 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
31931 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
31932 by default called &'debuglog'&.
31934 Logging set up by the control will be maintained across spool residency.
31936 Options are a slash-separated list.
31937 If an option takes an argument, the option name and argument are separated by
31938 an equals character.
31939 Several options are supported:
31941 tag=<&'suffix'&> The filename can be adjusted with thise option.
31942 The argument, which may access any variables already defined,
31943 is appended to the default name.
31945 opts=<&'debug&~options'&> The argument specififes what is to be logged,
31946 using the same values as the &`-d`& command-line option.
31948 stop Logging started with this control may be
31949 stopped by using this option.
31951 kill Logging started with this control may be
31952 stopped by using this option.
31953 Additionally the debug file will be removed,
31954 providing one means for speculative debug tracing.
31956 pretrigger=<&'size'&> This option specifies a memory buffuer to be used
31957 for pre-trigger debug capture.
31958 Debug lines are recorded in the buffer until
31959 and if) a trigger occurs; at which time they are
31960 dumped to the debug file. Newer lines displace the
31961 oldest if the buffer is full. After a trigger,
31962 immediate writes to file are done as normal.
31964 trigger=<&'reason'&> This option selects cause for the pretrigger buffer
31965 see above) to be copied to file. A reason of &*now*&
31966 take effect immediately; one of &*paniclog*& triggers
31967 on a write to the panic log.
31970 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
31974 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
31975 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
31976 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
31977 control = debug/kill
31978 control = debug/opts=+all/pretrigger=1024/trigger=paniclog
31979 control = debug/trigger=now
31983 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
31984 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
31985 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
31986 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
31987 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
31990 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
31991 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
31992 .cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
31993 This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
31994 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
31997 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
31998 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
31999 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
32000 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
32001 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
32002 strings or to numeric value.
32003 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
32004 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
32005 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
32007 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
32008 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
32009 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
32010 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
32011 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
32014 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
32015 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
32016 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
32017 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
32018 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
32019 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
32020 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
32021 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
32023 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
32024 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
32025 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
32026 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
32027 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
32028 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
32032 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
32033 .cindex "fake defer"
32034 .cindex "defer, fake"
32036 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
32037 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
32038 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
32039 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
32040 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
32042 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
32043 .cindex "fake rejection"
32044 .cindex "rejection, fake"
32046 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
32047 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
32048 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
32049 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
32050 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32051 the same SMTP connection.
32053 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
32054 message is supplied, the following is used:
32056 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
32057 550-kept for evaluation.
32058 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
32059 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
32061 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
32063 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
32064 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
32065 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32066 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32067 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
32068 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
32071 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
32072 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
32073 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
32074 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
32076 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
32077 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
32078 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
32079 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32080 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
32081 disables such output flushing.
32083 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
32084 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32085 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
32086 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32087 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
32088 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
32090 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
32091 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
32092 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
32093 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
32094 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
32095 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
32096 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32097 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
32098 to be useful in production.
32100 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
32101 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
32102 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
32103 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
32104 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
32106 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
32107 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
32108 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
32109 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
32110 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
32111 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
32114 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
32115 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
32116 verification failed"&) is sent.
32118 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
32122 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
32123 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
32125 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
32126 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
32127 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
32128 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
32129 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
32130 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
32131 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
32132 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
32134 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
32135 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
32136 .oindex "&%queue%&"
32137 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
32138 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
32139 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
32140 .cindex "first pass routing"
32141 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32142 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32143 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
32145 If used with no options set,
32146 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
32147 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
32149 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
32150 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
32151 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
32152 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
32153 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
32154 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
32156 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
32157 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32159 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
32160 .cindex "message" "submission"
32161 .cindex "submission mode"
32162 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
32163 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
32164 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
32165 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
32166 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
32167 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
32168 late (the message has already been created).
32170 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
32171 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
32172 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
32173 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
32174 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32176 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
32177 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
32178 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
32179 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
32180 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
32183 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
32184 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
32186 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
32188 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
32191 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
32192 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
32193 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32194 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
32197 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
32198 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
32200 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
32201 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
32203 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
32205 .vitem &*control&~=&~wellknown*&
32206 This control sets up a response data file for a WELLKNOWN SMTP command.
32207 It may only be used in an ACL servicing that command.
32208 For details see section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&.
32212 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
32213 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
32216 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
32218 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
32219 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
32221 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
32223 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
32228 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
32229 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
32230 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
32231 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
32232 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
32233 to an incoming message, as in this example:
32235 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32236 dialup.mail-abuse.org
32237 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
32239 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32240 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32241 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32242 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
32243 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
32246 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
32247 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32249 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
32250 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
32251 contains one or more newlines that
32252 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
32253 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
32254 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
32256 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32257 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32258 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
32259 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
32260 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
32261 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
32262 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
32263 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
32264 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
32265 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
32266 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
32268 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
32269 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
32271 until they are added to the
32272 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
32273 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
32274 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
32275 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
32276 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
32277 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
32278 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32280 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
32282 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32283 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32285 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32286 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32288 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32289 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32291 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
32292 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
32293 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
32294 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
32297 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
32298 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
32299 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
32300 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
32301 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
32302 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
32303 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
32306 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
32307 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
32308 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
32309 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
32310 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
32312 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
32313 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
32314 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
32315 to be a header name first.) For example:
32317 warn add_header = \
32318 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
32320 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
32321 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
32322 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
32323 up in reverse order.
32325 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32326 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
32327 system filter or in a router or transport.
32331 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
32332 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
32333 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
32334 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
32335 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
32336 from an incoming message, as in this example:
32338 warn message = Remove internal headers
32339 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32341 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32342 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32343 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32344 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
32345 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
32346 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
32348 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
32349 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32351 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
32352 list of header specifiers.
32353 If a specifier does not start with a circumflex (^)
32354 then it is treated as a header name.
32355 The header name matching is case insensitive.
32356 If it does, then it is treated as a (front-anchored)
32357 regular expression applied to the whole header.
32359 &*Note*&: The colon terminating a header name will need to be doubled
32360 if used in an RE, and there can legitimately be whitepace before it.
32364 remove_header = \N^(?i)Authentication-Results\s*::\s*example.org;\N
32367 List expansion is not performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
32368 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
32369 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
32371 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
32372 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32373 warn message = Remove internal headers
32374 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
32376 Header specifiers for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32377 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32378 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
32379 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
32380 a non-existent header. Further header specifiers for removal may be accumulated
32381 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which matching headers are removed
32382 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, remove specifiers are
32383 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are acted on after
32384 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
32385 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
32386 would have been removed.
32388 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
32389 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
32390 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
32391 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
32392 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
32393 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
32394 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
32395 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
32396 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32398 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32399 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32401 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
32402 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32404 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32405 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
32407 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
32408 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
32409 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
32410 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
32413 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32414 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
32415 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
32420 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
32421 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
32422 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
32423 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
32424 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
32425 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32427 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
32428 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
32429 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
32430 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
32431 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
32432 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
32433 The conditions are as follows:
32437 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
32438 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
32439 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
32440 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
32441 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
32442 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
32443 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
32444 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
32445 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
32446 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
32447 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
32448 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
32450 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
32451 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
32452 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
32453 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
32454 The name and values are expanded separately.
32455 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
32456 will act as argument separators.
32458 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
32459 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
32460 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
32461 conditions are tested.
32463 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
32464 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
32465 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
32466 for different local users or different local domains.
32468 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32469 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
32470 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
32471 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
32472 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
32473 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
32474 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
32479 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
32480 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
32481 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
32482 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
32483 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
32484 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
32485 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
32486 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
32487 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
32488 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
32489 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
32490 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
32493 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
32494 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
32495 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32496 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32497 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
32498 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
32499 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
32500 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32502 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
32503 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
32504 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32505 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32506 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32507 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
32508 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
32509 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
32510 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
32511 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
32513 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32514 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
32515 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
32516 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
32517 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
32518 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the domain
32519 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
32520 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
32521 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
32524 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
32525 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
32528 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32529 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
32530 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
32531 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
32532 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
32533 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
32534 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
32540 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
32541 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
32542 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
32543 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
32544 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
32545 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
32546 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
32548 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32550 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
32551 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
32552 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
32554 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
32555 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
32556 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
32557 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
32558 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
32559 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
32561 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
32562 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
32564 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32565 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
32567 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
32568 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
32569 statement can then check the IP address.
32571 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
32572 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
32573 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
32574 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
32576 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
32577 message = $host_data
32579 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
32581 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
32582 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
32583 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
32584 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
32585 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
32586 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the local
32587 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
32588 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
32589 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
32590 the next &%local_parts%& test.
32592 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
32593 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
32594 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
32595 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
32596 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32597 content-scanning extension
32598 and only after a DATA command.
32599 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
32600 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32602 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32603 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
32604 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32605 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32606 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32607 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
32608 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
32611 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32612 .cindex "rate limiting"
32613 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
32614 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
32616 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32617 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
32618 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
32619 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
32620 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks the entire
32621 recipient address against a list of recipients.
32623 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32624 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
32625 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32626 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32627 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
32628 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
32629 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32631 .vitem &*seen&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32632 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
32633 This condition can be used to test if a situation has been previously met,
32634 for example for greylisting.
32635 Details are given in section &<<SECTseen>>&.
32637 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32638 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
32639 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32640 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
32641 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32642 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
32643 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
32644 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
32645 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
32646 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
32647 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
32648 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
32649 influence the sender checking.
32651 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32652 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32654 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32655 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
32656 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32657 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
32658 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
32659 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
32663 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32664 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32666 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
32667 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
32668 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
32669 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32670 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
32671 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32673 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
32674 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32675 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
32676 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
32677 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
32678 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
32679 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
32680 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
32681 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
32682 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
32684 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
32685 .cindex "CSA verification"
32686 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
32687 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
32688 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
32690 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
32691 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32692 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32693 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32694 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
32695 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32697 This usually means an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32698 It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
32699 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
32700 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
32702 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
32703 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
32704 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
32706 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
32707 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32708 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
32709 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
32710 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
32711 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
32712 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32713 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32714 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
32715 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
32716 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
32717 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
32718 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
32719 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
32720 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
32722 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
32723 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
32724 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
32725 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
32728 !verify = header_sender
32729 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
32732 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
32733 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32734 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
32735 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
32736 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
32737 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32738 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32739 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
32740 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
32741 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
32742 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
32743 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
32744 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
32747 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
32748 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
32752 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
32753 common as they used to be.
32755 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
32756 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32757 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
32758 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
32759 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
32760 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
32761 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
32762 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
32763 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
32764 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
32765 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
32766 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
32767 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
32769 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
32770 option), this condition is always true.
32773 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
32774 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
32775 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
32776 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
32777 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
32778 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
32779 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
32780 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
32781 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
32783 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
32784 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
32786 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
32787 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
32790 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
32791 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32792 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
32793 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
32794 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
32795 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32796 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
32797 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
32798 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
32799 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
32800 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
32801 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
32802 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
32803 value for the child address.
32805 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
32806 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32807 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
32808 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
32809 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
32810 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
32811 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
32812 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
32813 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
32814 original IP address.
32816 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
32817 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
32819 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
32820 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
32822 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
32823 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32824 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
32825 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
32826 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
32827 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
32828 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
32829 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
32830 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
32832 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32833 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
32834 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
32835 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
32836 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
32837 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
32838 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
32840 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
32841 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
32842 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
32844 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
32845 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32846 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
32847 verified as a sender.
32849 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
32850 (eg. is generated from the received message)
32851 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
32853 verify = sender=${listquote{/}{${address:$h_sender:}}}
32859 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
32860 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32861 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32862 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32863 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
32864 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
32865 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
32866 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
32867 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
32868 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
32870 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
32871 dialups.mail-abuse.org
32873 the following records are looked up:
32875 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32876 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
32878 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
32879 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
32880 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
32881 use two separate conditions:
32883 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32884 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32886 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
32887 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
32888 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
32891 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
32892 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
32893 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
32894 following special items in the list:
32895 .itable none 0 0 2 25* left 75* left
32896 .irow "+include_unknown" "behave as if the item is on the list"
32897 .irow "+exclude_unknown" "behave as if the item is not on the list (default)"
32898 .irow "+defer_unknown " "give a temporary error"
32900 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
32901 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
32902 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
32903 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
32905 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
32907 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
32908 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
32910 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32911 warn dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32912 message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
32914 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
32916 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
32917 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
32918 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
32919 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
32920 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
32921 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
32923 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
32924 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
32925 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
32929 .subsection "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" SECID201
32930 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
32931 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
32932 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
32933 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
32935 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
32937 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
32938 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
32939 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
32940 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
32945 .subsection "DNS lists keyed on domain names" SECID202
32946 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
32947 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
32948 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
32949 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
32950 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
32951 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
32953 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
32954 message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
32956 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
32957 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
32958 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
32959 up by this example is
32961 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
32963 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
32964 addresses. For example:
32966 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32967 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
32969 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
32970 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
32975 .subsection "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" SECTmulkeyfor
32976 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
32977 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
32978 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
32979 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
32980 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
32981 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
32982 either to double the separators like this:
32984 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
32986 or to change the separator character, like this:
32988 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
32990 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
32991 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
32992 occurs. Consider this condition:
32994 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
32996 The DNS lookups that occur are:
32998 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
32999 a.domain.black.list.tld
33001 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
33002 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
33003 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
33004 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
33005 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
33006 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
33007 error for a previous item.
33009 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
33010 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
33012 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
33013 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
33015 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
33016 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
33018 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
33019 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
33020 $sender_address_domain} }} }
33021 message = The mail servers for the domain \
33022 $sender_address_domain \
33023 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
33026 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
33027 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
33028 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
33029 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
33031 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
33033 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
33034 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
33036 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
33037 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
33042 .subsection "Data returned by DNS lists" SECID203
33043 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
33044 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
33045 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
33046 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
33047 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
33048 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
33049 .irow 127.1.0.1 "RBL"
33050 .irow 127.1.0.2 "DUL"
33051 .irow 127.1.0.3 "DUL and RBL"
33052 .irow 127.1.0.4 "RSS"
33053 .irow 127.1.0.5 "RSS and RBL"
33054 .irow 127.1.0.6 "RSS and DUL"
33055 .irow 127.1.0.7 "RSS and DUL and RBL"
33057 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
33058 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
33059 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
33061 Values returned by a properly running DBSBL should be in the 127.0.0.0/8
33062 range. If a DNSBL operator loses control of the domain, lookups on it
33063 may start returning other addresses. Because of this, Exim now ignores
33064 returned values outside the 127/8 region.
33067 .subsection "Variables set from DNS lists" SECID204
33068 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
33069 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
33070 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
33071 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
33072 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
33073 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
33074 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
33075 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
33076 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
33077 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
33078 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
33079 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
33080 cases, for example:
33082 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
33084 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
33085 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
33086 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
33087 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
33089 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
33091 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
33092 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
33094 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
33095 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
33096 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
33097 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
33098 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
33101 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
33102 &-- even if these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
33103 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
33105 deny hosts = !+local_networks
33106 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
33108 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
33113 .subsection "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" SECTaddmatcon
33114 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
33115 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
33116 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
33119 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
33121 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
33122 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
33123 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
33124 describes how multiple records are handled.
33126 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
33127 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
33128 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
33130 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33132 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
33133 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
33134 first. For example:
33136 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
33137 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
33140 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
33141 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
33142 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
33143 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
33144 tested. For example:
33146 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
33148 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
33149 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
33150 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
33152 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33154 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
33159 .subsection "Negated DNS matching conditions" SECID205
33160 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
33163 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33165 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33166 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
33168 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33170 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33171 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
33172 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
33173 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
33175 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
33176 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
33178 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
33179 previous example is precisely equivalent to
33181 deny dnslists = a.b.c
33182 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33184 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
33185 Consider this example:
33187 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33189 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
33192 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
33194 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33196 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
33197 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
33198 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
33200 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
33202 Negation can also be used with a bitwise-and restriction.
33203 The dnslists condition with only be trus if a result is returned
33204 by the lookup which, anded with the restriction, is all zeroes.
33207 deny dnslists = zen.spamhaus.org!&0.255.255.0
33213 .subsection "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" SECThanmuldnsrec
33214 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
33215 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
33216 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
33217 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
33218 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
33220 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
33222 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
33223 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
33224 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
33225 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
33226 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
33227 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
33230 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
33231 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
33232 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33234 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
33235 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
33238 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
33240 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33241 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
33243 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
33245 for the condition to be true.
33248 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
33249 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
33251 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
33252 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
33254 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
33256 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33257 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33259 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
33260 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
33262 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
33264 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33265 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
33267 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33269 for the condition to be false.
33271 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
33272 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
33277 .subsection "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" SECTmordetinf
33278 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
33279 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
33280 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
33281 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
33282 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
33283 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
33284 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
33285 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
33288 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
33289 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
33290 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
33291 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
33292 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
33293 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
33294 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
33297 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
33298 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33300 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
33301 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
33303 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
33304 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
33305 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
33306 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
33307 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
33308 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
33310 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
33311 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
33312 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
33315 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
33316 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
33317 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
33318 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33320 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
33321 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
33322 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
33326 .subsection "DNS lists and IPv6" SECTmorednslistslast
33327 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
33328 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
33329 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
33330 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
33331 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
33333 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
33334 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33336 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
33337 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
33338 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
33340 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
33342 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
33343 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
33345 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
33346 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
33348 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
33349 dnslists = some.list.example
33352 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
33353 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
33354 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
33356 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
33360 .section "Previously seen user and hosts" "SECTseen"
33361 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
33362 .cindex greylisting
33363 The &%seen%& ACL condition can be used to test whether a
33364 situation has been previously met.
33365 It uses a hints database to record a timestamp against a key.
33366 The syntax of the condition is:
33368 &`seen =`& <&'optional flag'&><&'time interval'&> &`/`& <&'options'&>
33373 defer seen = -5m / key=${sender_host_address}_$local_part@$domain
33375 in a RCPT ACL will implement simple greylisting.
33377 The parameters for the condition are
33378 a possible minus sign,
33380 then, slash-separated, a list of options.
33381 The interval is taken as an offset before the current time,
33382 and used for the test.
33383 If the interval is preceded by a minus sign then the condition returns
33384 whether a record is found which is before the test time.
33385 Otherwise, the condition returns whether one is found which is since the
33388 Options are read in order with later ones overriding earlier ones.
33390 The default key is &$sender_host_address$&.
33391 An explicit key can be set using a &%key=value%& option.
33393 If a &%readonly%& option is given then
33394 no record create or update is done.
33395 If a &%write%& option is given then
33396 a record create or update is always done.
33397 An update is done if the test is for &"since"&.
33398 If none of those hold and there was no existing record,
33399 a record is created.
33401 Creates and updates are marked with the current time.
33403 Finally, a &"before"& test which succeeds, and for which the record
33404 is old enough, will be refreshed with a timestamp of the test time.
33405 This can prevent tidying of the database from removing the entry.
33406 The interval for this is, by default, 10 days.
33407 An explicit interval can be set using a
33408 &%refresh=value%& option.
33410 Note that &"seen"& should be added to the list of hints databases
33411 for maintenance if this ACL condition is used.
33414 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
33415 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
33416 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
33417 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
33418 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
33419 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
33420 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
33421 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
33422 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
33423 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
33425 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
33427 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
33428 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
33430 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
33431 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
33432 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
33435 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
33436 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
33437 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
33438 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
33439 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
33440 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
33441 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
33442 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
33443 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
33445 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
33446 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
33447 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
33448 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
33450 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
33451 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
33452 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
33453 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
33454 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
33455 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
33456 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
33457 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
33458 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
33459 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
33461 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
33462 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
33463 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
33466 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
33467 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
33468 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
33469 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
33470 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
33471 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
33473 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
33474 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
33475 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
33476 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
33477 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
33478 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
33479 the &%count=%& option.
33482 .subsection "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" ratoptmea
33483 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
33486 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33487 This option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
33488 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
33489 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
33492 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33493 This option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
33494 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
33495 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
33496 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33499 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33500 This option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
33501 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
33502 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
33503 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
33504 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
33505 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
33506 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
33509 .cindex "rate limiting" per_rcpt
33510 This option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
33511 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
33512 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, or &%acl_smtp_data%& ACLs. In
33513 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
33514 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
33515 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
33516 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
33519 .cindex "rate limiting" per_addr
33520 This option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
33521 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
33522 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
33523 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
33527 .cindex "rate limiting" per_cmd
33528 This option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
33529 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
33530 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
33531 multiple different commands.
33534 .cindex "rate limiting" count
33535 This option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
33537 A value is required, after an equals sign.
33538 For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
33539 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&.
33540 If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
33541 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
33542 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&).
33543 The count does not have to be an integer.
33546 .cindex "rate limiting" unique
33547 This option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
33551 .subsection "Ratelimit update modes" ratoptupd
33552 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
33553 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
33554 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
33555 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
33557 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
33558 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
33560 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
33561 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
33562 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
33563 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
33567 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
33568 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33569 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33572 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
33573 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33574 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33577 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
33578 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
33579 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
33580 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
33581 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
33582 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
33585 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
33586 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
33587 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
33588 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
33589 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
33592 .subsection "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" ratoptfast
33593 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
33594 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
33595 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
33596 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
33597 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
33600 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
33601 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
33602 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
33603 up to the given limit.
33604 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
33605 consists of refusing the message, and
33606 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
33607 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
33608 likely not what is wanted.
33610 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
33611 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
33612 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
33613 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
33614 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
33615 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
33616 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
33617 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
33619 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
33623 .subsection "Limiting the rate of different events" ratoptuniq
33624 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
33625 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
33626 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
33627 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
33628 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
33629 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
33630 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
33631 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
33633 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
33634 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
33635 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
33636 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
33637 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
33638 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
33640 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
33641 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
33644 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
33645 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
33646 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
33647 required increases with larger limits.
33649 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
33650 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
33651 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
33652 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
33653 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
33654 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
33655 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
33656 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
33657 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
33661 .subsection "Using rate limiting" useratlim
33662 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
33663 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
33664 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
33665 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
33666 message. For example:
33668 # Log all senders' rates
33669 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
33670 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
33672 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
33673 # at the decimal point.
33674 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
33675 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
33676 $sender_rate_limit }s
33678 # Keep authenticated users under control
33679 deny authenticated = *
33680 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
33682 # System-wide rate limit
33683 defer ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
33684 message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
33686 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
33687 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
33688 defer ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
33689 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
33690 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
33691 message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
33692 messages per $sender_rate_period
33694 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
33695 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
33696 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
33697 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
33698 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
33699 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
33700 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
33704 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
33705 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
33706 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
33707 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
33708 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
33709 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
33710 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
33711 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
33712 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
33714 verify = sender/callout
33715 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
33717 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
33718 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
33719 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
33720 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
33721 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
33722 The available options are as follows:
33725 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
33726 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
33727 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
33729 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
33730 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
33731 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
33732 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
33734 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
33735 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
33737 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
33738 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
33739 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
33740 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
33742 If the &%quota%& option is specified for recipient verify,
33743 successful routing to an appendfile transport is followed by a call into
33744 the transport to evaluate the quota status for the recipient.
33745 No actual delivery is done, but verification will succeed if the quota
33746 is sufficient for the message (if the sender gave a message size) or
33747 not already exceeded (otherwise).
33750 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
33751 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
33752 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
33753 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
33754 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
33755 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
33758 warn !verify = sender
33759 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
33761 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
33762 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
33763 verification failure.
33764 This variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
33766 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
33767 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
33770 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
33771 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
33773 &%route%&: Routing failed.
33775 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
33776 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
33777 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
33779 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
33781 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
33783 &%quota%&: The quota check for a local recipient did non pass.
33786 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
33787 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
33789 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
33790 address verification to:
33793 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
33799 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
33800 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
33801 .cindex "callout" "verification"
33802 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
33803 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
33804 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
33805 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
33806 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
33807 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
33808 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
33809 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
33810 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
33813 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
33814 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
33815 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
33816 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
33817 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
33818 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
33820 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
33821 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
33822 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
33823 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
33824 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
33826 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
33827 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
33828 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
33829 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
33830 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
33831 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
33832 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
33833 supplies a host list.
33834 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
33836 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
33837 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
33838 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
33839 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
33840 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
33841 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
33842 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
33844 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
33845 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
33846 following SMTP commands are sent:
33848 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
33850 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
33853 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
33856 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
33859 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
33860 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
33861 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
33862 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
33863 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
33864 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
33866 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
33867 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
33868 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
33869 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
33870 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
33872 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
33873 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
33874 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
33875 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
33876 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
33878 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
33879 .cindex "de-tainting" "using recipient verify"
33880 A recipient callout which gets a 2&'xx'& code
33881 will assign untainted values to the
33882 &$domain_data$& and &$local_part_data$& variables,
33883 corresponding to the domain and local parts of the recipient address.
33888 .subsection "Additional parameters for callouts" CALLaddparcall
33889 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
33890 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
33891 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
33893 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
33895 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
33896 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
33897 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
33901 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
33902 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
33903 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
33906 verify = sender/callout=5s
33908 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
33909 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
33910 the &%connect%& parameter.
33913 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33914 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
33915 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
33916 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
33918 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
33920 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
33922 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
33923 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
33924 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
33925 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
33926 updated in this circumstance.
33928 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
33929 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
33930 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
33931 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
33932 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
33933 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
33936 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
33937 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
33938 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
33939 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
33940 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
33941 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
33942 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
33943 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
33944 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
33945 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
33947 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
33949 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
33952 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33953 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
33954 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
33957 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
33959 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
33960 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
33961 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
33962 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
33963 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
33966 .vitem &*no_cache*&
33967 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
33968 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
33969 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
33971 .vitem &*postmaster*&
33972 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
33973 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
33974 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
33975 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
33976 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
33977 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
33978 made, until the cache record expires.
33980 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
33981 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
33982 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
33985 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
33987 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
33988 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
33990 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
33992 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
33993 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
33994 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
33995 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
33999 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
34000 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
34001 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
34002 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
34003 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
34005 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
34007 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
34008 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
34009 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
34010 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
34011 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
34013 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
34014 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
34015 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34017 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
34019 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34020 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
34021 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
34022 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
34023 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
34025 .vitem &*use_sender*&
34026 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34028 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
34030 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
34031 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
34032 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
34033 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
34034 usefulness of callout caching.
34037 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34039 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
34041 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
34042 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
34043 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
34044 when that is used for the connections.
34045 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
34046 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
34047 if the use_sender option is used,
34048 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
34049 and if no other callouts intervene.
34052 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
34053 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
34054 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
34055 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
34056 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
34057 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
34058 these circumstances.
34060 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
34061 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
34062 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
34063 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
34064 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
34065 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
34066 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
34068 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
34069 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
34070 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
34071 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
34076 .subsection "Callout caching" SECTcallvercache
34077 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
34078 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
34079 .cindex "caching" "callout"
34080 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
34081 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
34082 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
34083 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
34084 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
34085 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
34087 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
34088 the failure. However, for subsequent failures that use the cache data, this message
34091 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
34092 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
34093 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
34095 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
34096 commands up to and including
34100 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
34101 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
34102 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
34103 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
34104 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
34105 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
34106 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
34108 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
34109 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
34110 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
34111 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
34112 will eventually be noticed.
34114 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
34115 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
34116 behaviour will be the same.
34120 .section "Quota caching" "SECTquotacache"
34121 .cindex "hints database" "quota cache"
34122 .cindex "quota" "cache, description of"
34123 .cindex "caching" "quota"
34124 Exim caches the results of quota verification
34125 in order to reduce the amount of resources used.
34126 The &"callout"& hints database is used.
34128 The default cache periods are five minutes for a positive (good) result
34129 and one hour for a negative result.
34130 To change the periods the &%quota%& option can be followed by an equals sign
34131 and a number of optional paramemters, separated by commas.
34134 verify = recipient/quota=cachepos=1h,cacheneg=1d
34136 Possible parameters are:
34138 .vitem &*cachepos&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34139 .cindex "quota cache" "positive entry expiry, specifying"
34140 Set the lifetime for a positive cache entry.
34141 A value of zero seconds is legitimate.
34143 .vitem &*cacheneg&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34144 .cindex "quota cache" "negative entry expiry, specifying"
34145 As above, for a negative entry.
34147 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34148 Set both positive and negative lifetimes to zero.
34150 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
34151 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
34152 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
34153 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
34154 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
34155 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
34158 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
34160 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
34161 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
34162 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
34163 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
34164 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
34165 550 Sender verification failed
34167 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
34168 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
34169 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
34170 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
34173 verify = sender/no_details
34176 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
34177 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
34178 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
34179 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
34180 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
34181 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
34182 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
34185 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
34186 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
34187 verification also fails.
34189 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
34190 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
34193 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
34194 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
34195 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
34198 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
34200 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
34201 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
34202 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
34203 verification to succeed.
34205 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
34206 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
34207 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
34208 option. For example:
34210 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
34212 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
34213 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
34215 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
34216 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
34217 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
34218 address and a report is output for each of them.
34222 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
34223 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
34224 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
34225 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
34226 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
34227 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
34228 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
34232 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
34233 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
34234 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
34235 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
34236 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
34237 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
34239 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
34240 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
34241 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
34242 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
34245 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
34247 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
34249 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
34250 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
34252 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
34253 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
34256 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
34257 use for the DNS query. The default is:
34259 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
34261 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
34262 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
34263 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
34264 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
34267 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
34269 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
34270 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
34271 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
34273 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
34274 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
34275 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
34276 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
34277 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
34278 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
34279 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
34280 of legitimate HELO domains.
34282 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
34283 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
34284 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
34285 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
34288 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
34290 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
34291 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
34292 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
34297 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
34298 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
34299 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
34300 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
34301 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
34302 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
34303 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
34304 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
34306 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
34307 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
34308 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
34309 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
34310 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
34311 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
34312 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
34313 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
34315 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
34316 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
34319 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
34320 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
34323 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
34324 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
34327 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
34329 recipients = +batv_senders
34330 message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
34332 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
34334 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
34335 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
34336 !condition = $prvscheck_result
34337 message = Invalid reverse path signature.
34339 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
34340 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
34341 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
34342 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
34343 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
34345 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
34346 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
34347 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
34348 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
34349 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
34350 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
34351 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
34353 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
34354 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
34355 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
34356 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
34360 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
34362 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
34363 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
34364 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
34367 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
34370 external_smtp_batv:
34372 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
34373 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
34374 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
34375 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
34378 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
34382 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
34383 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
34384 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
34385 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
34386 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
34387 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
34388 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
34389 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
34390 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
34391 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
34393 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
34394 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
34395 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
34396 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
34397 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
34398 same host is fulfilling both functions,
34400 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
34402 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
34403 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
34404 system to arbitrary domains.
34407 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
34408 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
34409 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
34410 example, suppose you want to do the following:
34413 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
34414 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
34415 &'my.dom2.example'&.
34417 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
34418 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
34420 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
34421 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
34425 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
34427 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
34428 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
34429 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
34431 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
34435 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
34436 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
34438 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
34439 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
34440 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
34441 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
34442 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
34443 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
34444 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
34448 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
34449 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
34450 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
34451 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
34452 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
34457 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34460 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
34461 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
34462 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
34463 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
34464 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
34465 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
34468 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
34469 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
34470 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
34471 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
34472 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
34474 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
34475 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
34476 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
34479 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
34480 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
34482 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
34483 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
34484 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
34486 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
34487 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
34489 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
34492 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
34495 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
34496 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
34497 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
34498 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
34499 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
34500 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
34502 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
34503 temporarily created in a file called:
34505 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
34507 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
34508 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
34509 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
34510 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
34511 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
34513 control = no_mbox_unspool
34515 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
34516 same directory by default.
34520 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
34521 .cindex "virus scanning"
34522 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
34523 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
34524 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
34525 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
34526 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
34527 in memory and thus are much faster.
34529 Since message data needs to have arrived,
34530 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
34532 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
34533 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
34536 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
34537 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
34539 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
34540 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
34541 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
34542 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
34544 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
34546 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
34548 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
34550 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
34552 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
34553 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
34554 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
34558 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
34559 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
34560 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
34561 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
34562 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
34563 This scanner type takes one option,
34564 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34565 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34566 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34567 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34568 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
34569 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
34570 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
34572 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
34573 If &`pass_unscanned`&
34574 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
34575 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
34580 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34581 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34582 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
34584 If you omit the argument, the default path
34585 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
34587 If you use a remote host,
34588 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
34589 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
34590 For information about available commands and their options you may use
34592 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
34598 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
34599 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
34600 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
34602 .vitem &%aveserver%&
34603 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34604 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
34605 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
34606 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
34609 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
34614 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
34615 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
34616 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
34617 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
34618 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
34620 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
34621 a UNIX socket specification,
34622 a TCP socket specification,
34623 or a (global) option.
34625 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
34626 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
34627 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
34628 and the second a port number,
34629 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
34630 These per-server options are supported:
34632 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34635 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34636 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
34638 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
34642 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
34643 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
34644 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
34645 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
34646 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
34648 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
34650 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
34651 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
34652 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
34653 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
34655 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
34656 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
34657 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
34658 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
34659 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
34660 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
34661 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
34662 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
34663 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
34665 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
34666 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
34667 (Connection refused)
34670 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
34671 contributing the code for this scanner.
34674 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
34675 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
34676 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
34677 type takes 3 mandatory options:
34680 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
34681 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
34684 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
34685 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
34686 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
34687 the &"trigger"& expression.
34690 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
34691 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
34692 &"name"& expression.
34695 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
34697 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
34699 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
34700 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
34701 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
34702 configuration setting:
34704 av_scanner = cmdline:\
34705 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
34706 found in file:'(.+)'
34709 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
34710 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
34712 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34713 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34714 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34715 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34718 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
34719 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
34721 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
34722 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
34725 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
34726 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
34727 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
34731 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
34733 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
34735 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
34736 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
34737 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
34738 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
34741 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
34743 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
34746 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
34747 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
34748 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
34750 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
34752 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
34753 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
34755 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
34756 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34757 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
34758 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
34759 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
34762 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
34764 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
34767 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
34768 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
34769 though some documentation was available in English.
34770 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
34771 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
34772 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
34774 The only option for this scanner type is
34775 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
34776 provided that mksd has
34777 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
34779 av_scanner = mksd:2
34781 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
34784 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
34785 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
34786 running on the local machine.
34787 There are four options:
34788 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
34789 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
34790 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
34791 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
34792 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
34795 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
34797 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
34798 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
34799 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
34800 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
34801 specify an empty element to get this.
34804 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
34805 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
34806 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
34807 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
34808 client communication. For example:
34810 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
34812 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
34816 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
34817 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
34820 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
34821 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
34822 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
34823 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
34824 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
34825 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
34828 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
34829 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
34830 The first element can then be one of
34833 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
34834 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
34837 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
34838 the condition fails immediately.
34840 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
34841 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
34842 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
34843 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
34844 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
34847 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
34848 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
34849 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
34851 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
34852 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
34855 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
34857 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
34859 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
34860 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
34861 is set to record the actual address used.
34863 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
34864 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
34865 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
34866 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
34869 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
34870 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
34872 Here is a very simple scanning example:
34875 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34877 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
34879 deny malware = */defer_ok
34880 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34882 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
34883 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
34885 av_scanner = $acl_m0
34887 in the main Exim configuration.
34889 deny set acl_m0 = sophie
34891 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34893 deny set acl_m0 = aveserver
34895 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34899 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
34900 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
34901 .cindex "spam scanning"
34902 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
34904 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
34905 score and a report for the message.
34906 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
34908 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
34909 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
34910 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
34912 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
34914 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
34916 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
34917 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
34920 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
34921 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
34922 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
34923 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
34924 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
34925 configuration as follows (example):
34927 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
34929 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
34930 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
34931 iptables firewall, consider setting
34932 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
34933 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
34934 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
34935 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
34939 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
34941 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
34943 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
34946 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
34947 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
34948 filename instead of an address/port pair:
34950 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
34952 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
34953 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
34954 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
34955 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
34957 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
34958 192.168.2.11 783 : \
34961 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
34962 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
34963 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
34966 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
34967 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
34968 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
34969 take care to not double the separator.
34971 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
34972 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
34973 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
34974 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
34976 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
34978 The supported options are:
34980 pri=<priority> Selection priority
34981 weight=<value> Selection bias
34982 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
34983 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34984 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
34985 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
34988 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
34989 higher values being tried first.
34990 The default priority is 1.
34992 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
34993 Within a priority set
34994 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
34995 The default value for selection bias is 1.
34997 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
34998 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
34999 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
35000 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
35002 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
35003 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
35005 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
35006 The default value is two minutes.
35008 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
35009 a failed connect is made.
35010 The default is to not retry.
35012 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
35013 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
35014 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
35017 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
35018 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
35019 is set to record the actual address used.
35021 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
35022 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
35025 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35027 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
35028 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
35029 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
35030 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
35031 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
35034 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
35035 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
35036 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
35037 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
35038 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
35040 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
35041 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
35043 or the use of PRDR,
35044 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
35045 are needed to use this feature.
35047 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
35048 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
35049 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
35052 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
35053 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
35054 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
35057 deny condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
35059 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35062 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
35063 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
35064 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
35065 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
35067 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
35068 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
35070 Except for &$spam_report$&,
35071 these variables are saved with the received message so are
35072 available for use at delivery time.
35075 .vitem &$spam_score$&
35076 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
35077 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
35079 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
35080 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
35081 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
35082 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
35083 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
35085 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
35086 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
35087 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
35088 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
35089 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
35090 spam bar is 50 characters.
35092 .vitem &$spam_report$&
35093 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
35094 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
35095 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
35096 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
35097 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
35098 unencoded in headers.
35100 .vitem &$spam_action$&
35101 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
35102 spam score versus threshold.
35103 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
35107 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
35108 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
35109 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
35111 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
35112 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
35113 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
35114 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
35115 spam condition, like this:
35117 deny spam = joe/defer_ok
35118 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35120 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
35122 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
35125 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
35126 warn spam = nobody:true
35127 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
35128 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
35130 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
35131 # is over threshold
35133 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
35135 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
35136 deny spam = nobody:true
35137 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
35138 message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
35143 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
35144 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
35145 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
35146 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
35147 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
35148 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
35149 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
35150 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
35151 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
35152 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
35155 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
35156 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
35157 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
35158 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
35159 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
35160 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
35161 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
35163 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
35164 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
35165 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
35166 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
35167 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
35169 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
35170 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
35171 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
35172 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
35173 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
35176 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
35178 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
35182 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
35184 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
35185 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
35186 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
35187 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
35189 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
35190 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
35191 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
35192 the full path and filename.
35194 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
35195 filename, and the default path is then used.
35197 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
35198 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages.
35199 The variable &$mime_filename$& will have the suggested name for the file.
35200 Note however that this might contain anything, and is very difficult
35201 to safely use as all or even part of the filename.
35202 If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
35203 automatically unlinked.
35205 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
35206 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
35207 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
35208 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
35209 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
35211 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
35212 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
35213 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
35215 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
35216 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
35217 available in the MIME ACL:
35220 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
35221 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35222 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
35223 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35224 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
35225 the detected issue.
35227 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
35228 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
35229 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
35230 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
35231 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
35232 contains the empty string.
35234 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
35235 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
35236 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
35237 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
35243 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
35244 case-insensitively.
35246 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
35247 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
35248 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
35249 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
35250 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
35251 only used for display purposes.
35253 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
35254 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
35255 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
35256 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
35258 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
35259 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
35260 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
35261 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
35263 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
35264 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
35265 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35266 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
35267 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
35268 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
35270 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35271 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35272 This variable contains the normalized content of the
35273 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
35274 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
35276 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
35277 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
35278 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
35279 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
35280 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
35284 application/octet-stream
35288 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
35291 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35292 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35293 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35294 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
35295 containing the decoded data.
35300 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
35301 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
35302 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
35303 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
35304 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
35307 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
35309 found, this variable contains the empty string.
35311 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35312 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35313 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
35314 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
35315 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
35317 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
35318 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
35322 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
35325 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
35326 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
35329 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
35330 and the rest are attachments.
35333 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
35336 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
35337 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
35338 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
35340 deny !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
35341 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
35342 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
35343 message = HTML mail is not accepted here
35346 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
35347 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
35348 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
35349 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
35350 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
35351 want to carry out specific actions on them.
35353 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35354 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35355 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
35356 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
35357 decoding is fully recursive.
35359 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
35360 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
35361 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
35362 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
35363 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
35364 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
35365 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
35366 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
35371 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
35372 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
35373 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
35374 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
35375 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
35377 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
35378 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
35379 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
35380 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
35381 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
35383 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
35384 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
35385 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
35386 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
35387 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
35388 32K characters are checked.
35390 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
35391 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
35392 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
35393 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
35394 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
35396 deny regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
35397 message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
35399 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
35400 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
35401 matching regular expression.
35402 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
35403 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
35405 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
35413 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35414 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35416 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
35417 "Local scan function"
35418 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
35419 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
35420 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
35421 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
35422 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
35424 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
35425 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
35426 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
35427 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
35428 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
35430 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
35431 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
35432 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
35433 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
35435 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
35436 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
35437 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
35438 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
35440 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
35441 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
35442 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
35443 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
35444 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
35445 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
35446 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
35447 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
35448 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
35452 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
35453 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
35454 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
35455 function is before building Exim, by setting
35456 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
35457 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
35458 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
35459 directory, so you might set
35461 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
35462 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
35464 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
35465 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
35466 and then #include "local_scan.h".
35468 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
35469 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
35470 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
35471 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
35472 _src/local_scan.c_.
35474 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
35475 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
35477 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35479 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
35484 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
35485 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
35486 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
35487 You must include this line near the start of your code:
35490 #include "local_scan.h"
35492 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
35493 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
35494 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
35495 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
35496 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
35497 strings and pointers to character strings:
35499 #define CS (char *)
35500 #define CCS (const char *)
35501 #define CSS (char **)
35502 #define US (unsigned char *)
35503 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
35504 #define USS (unsigned char **)
35506 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
35508 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
35510 The arguments are as follows:
35513 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
35514 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
35515 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
35517 The descriptor is positioned at character 26 of the file, which is the first
35518 character of the body itself, because the first 26 characters (19 characters
35519 before Exim 4.97) are the message id followed by &`-D`& and a newline.
35520 If you rewind the file, you should use the
35521 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
35522 case this changes in some future version.
35524 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
35525 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
35528 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
35531 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
35532 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
35533 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
35534 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
35535 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
35536 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
35538 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
35539 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35540 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
35542 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
35543 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35544 queued without immediate delivery.
35546 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
35547 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
35548 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
35549 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
35550 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
35553 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
35554 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
35555 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
35558 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35559 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
35560 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
35561 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
35562 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
35563 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
35564 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35566 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35567 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
35568 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35571 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
35572 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
35573 &%-oe%& command line options.
35577 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
35578 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
35579 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
35580 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
35581 want to do this, you must have the line
35583 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35585 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
35586 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
35587 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
35590 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
35591 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
35592 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
35593 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
35594 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
35595 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
35597 static int my_integer_option = 42;
35598 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
35600 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
35601 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
35602 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
35605 int local_scan_options_count =
35606 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
35608 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
35609 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
35613 my_string = some string of text...
35615 The available types of option data are as follows:
35618 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
35619 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
35620 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
35621 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
35622 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
35623 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
35626 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
35627 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
35628 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
35629 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
35632 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
35633 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
35636 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
35637 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
35638 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
35639 printed with the suffix K or M.
35641 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
35642 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
35643 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
35644 always output in octal.
35646 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
35647 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
35648 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
35650 .vitem &*opt_time*&
35651 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
35652 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
35655 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
35656 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
35660 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
35661 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
35662 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
35663 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
35664 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
35665 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
35666 C variables are as follows:
35669 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
35670 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
35671 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35673 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
35674 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
35675 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35677 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
35678 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
35679 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
35680 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
35683 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
35684 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
35685 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
35688 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
35689 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
35693 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
35694 selected, you should use code like this:
35696 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35697 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35699 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
35700 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
35701 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
35703 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
35704 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
35707 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
35708 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
35710 .vitem &*const&~uschar&~*headers_charset*&
35711 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
35713 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
35714 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
35715 &%-bh%& command line option.
35717 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
35718 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
35719 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
35721 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
35722 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
35723 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
35724 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
35726 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
35727 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
35728 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
35730 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
35731 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35733 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
35734 The number of accepted recipients.
35736 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
35737 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
35738 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
35739 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
35740 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
35741 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
35742 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
35743 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
35744 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
35745 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
35746 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
35747 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
35749 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
35750 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
35752 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
35753 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
35754 locally-submitted messages.
35756 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
35757 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
35758 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
35760 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
35761 The name of the sending host, if known.
35763 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
35764 The port on the sending host.
35766 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
35767 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
35769 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
35770 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
35772 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
35773 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
35774 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
35778 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
35779 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
35780 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
35781 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
35786 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
35787 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
35789 .vitem &*int&~type*&
35790 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
35791 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
35792 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
35793 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
35794 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
35795 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
35797 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
35798 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
35801 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
35802 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
35803 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
35808 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
35809 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
35812 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
35813 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
35815 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
35816 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
35817 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
35818 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
35820 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
35821 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
35822 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
35823 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
35824 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
35825 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
35826 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
35827 is NULL for all recipients.
35832 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
35833 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
35834 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
35835 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
35839 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
35840 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
35842 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
35843 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
35844 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
35845 for the process in &%newumask%&.
35847 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
35848 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
35849 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
35850 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
35851 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
35853 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
35855 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
35856 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
35857 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
35858 return value is as follows:
35863 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
35869 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
35875 The process timed out.
35879 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
35882 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
35883 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
35884 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
35885 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
35886 forks a subprocess that is running
35888 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
35890 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
35891 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
35892 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
35893 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
35895 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
35896 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
35897 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
35898 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
35901 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
35902 *sender_authentication)*&
35903 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
35906 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
35908 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
35911 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
35912 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
35913 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
35914 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
35915 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
35917 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35918 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35921 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
35922 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
35923 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
35924 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
35925 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
35926 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
35927 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
35928 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
35930 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
35931 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
35932 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
35933 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
35934 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
35935 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
35937 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
35938 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
35939 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
35940 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
35942 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
35943 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
35944 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
35945 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
35946 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
35947 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
35948 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
35949 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
35950 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
35951 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
35953 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
35954 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
35956 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
35957 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
35960 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
35961 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
35962 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
35963 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
35964 match the specification, the function does nothing.
35967 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
35968 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
35969 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
35970 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
35971 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
35972 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
35974 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
35976 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
35977 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
35978 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
35979 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
35980 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
35983 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
35984 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
35985 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
35986 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
35987 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
35988 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
35989 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
35990 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
35992 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
35993 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
35994 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
35995 .itable none 0 0 2 15* left 85* left
35996 .irow &`OK`& "match succeeded"
35997 .irow &`FAIL`& "match failed"
35998 .irow &`DEFER`& "match deferred"
36000 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
36001 inability to contact a database.
36003 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36005 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
36006 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
36007 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36009 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36011 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
36012 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
36013 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36015 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
36017 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
36020 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
36022 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
36023 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
36024 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
36025 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
36026 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
36027 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
36030 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
36032 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
36033 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
36034 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
36035 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
36036 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
36037 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
36040 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
36041 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
36042 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
36043 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
36045 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
36046 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
36047 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
36048 value afterwards. For example:
36050 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
36051 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
36052 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
36055 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
36056 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
36057 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
36058 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
36065 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
36066 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
36067 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
36068 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
36069 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
36070 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
36071 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
36072 binary string is returned with an error message.
36074 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
36075 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
36076 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
36078 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
36079 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
36080 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
36081 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
36082 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
36084 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
36085 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
36086 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
36088 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
36089 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
36090 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
36091 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
36095 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
36096 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
36099 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
36100 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
36101 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
36102 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
36103 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
36104 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
36105 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
36106 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
36109 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
36110 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
36112 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
36113 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
36114 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
36115 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
36117 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
36118 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
36119 ABI version number was incremented.
36121 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
36122 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
36123 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
36124 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
36125 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
36126 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
36127 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
36129 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
36130 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
36132 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
36133 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
36134 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
36135 multiple output lines.
36137 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
36139 guarantee a flush of
36140 pending output, and therefore does not test
36141 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
36142 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
36143 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
36144 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
36145 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
36148 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
36149 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
36150 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
36151 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
36152 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
36153 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
36154 Exim bombs out if it ever
36155 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36157 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
36158 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
36159 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36161 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
36164 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
36167 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
36168 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
36169 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
36170 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
36171 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
36172 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
36178 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
36179 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
36180 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
36181 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
36182 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
36183 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
36184 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
36187 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
36188 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
36189 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
36190 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
36192 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
36193 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
36195 store_pool = POOL_PERM
36197 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
36198 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
36199 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
36200 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
36202 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
36203 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
36204 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
36205 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
36212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36215 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
36216 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
36217 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
36218 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
36219 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
36220 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
36221 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
36222 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
36224 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
36225 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
36226 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
36227 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
36228 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
36230 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
36231 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
36232 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
36233 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
36234 .cindex retry condition
36235 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
36236 prevent it happening on retries.
36238 .vindex "&$domain$&"
36239 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36240 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
36241 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
36242 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
36243 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
36244 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
36245 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
36248 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
36249 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
36250 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
36251 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
36252 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
36253 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
36254 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
36256 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
36257 system_filter_user = exim
36259 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
36260 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
36261 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
36262 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
36263 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
36264 by the &%reply%& command.
36267 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
36268 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
36269 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
36270 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
36272 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
36273 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
36277 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
36278 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
36279 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
36280 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
36281 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
36282 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
36285 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
36286 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
36287 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
36288 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
36289 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
36290 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
36291 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
36293 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
36294 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
36295 succeed, it will not be tried again.
36296 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
36297 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
36299 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
36300 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
36301 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
36302 to which users' filter files can refer.
36306 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
36307 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
36308 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
36309 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
36310 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
36314 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
36315 .cindex "freezing messages"
36316 .cindex "message" "freezing"
36317 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
36318 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
36319 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
36320 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
36321 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
36322 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
36323 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
36324 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
36325 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
36327 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
36329 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
36331 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
36332 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
36333 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
36334 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
36335 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
36338 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
36339 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
36340 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
36341 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
36343 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
36344 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
36345 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
36346 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
36347 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
36348 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
36349 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
36350 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
36351 message. For example:
36353 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
36354 because it contains attachments that we are \
36355 not prepared to receive."
36358 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
36359 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
36360 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
36361 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
36362 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
36363 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
36366 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
36367 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
36369 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
36370 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
36371 generated by the filter.
36373 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
36375 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
36376 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
36382 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
36383 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
36388 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
36389 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
36390 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
36391 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
36392 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
36394 headers add <string>
36395 headers remove <string>
36397 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
36398 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
36399 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
36400 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
36401 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
36403 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
36404 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
36405 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
36408 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
36409 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
36412 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
36413 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
36414 space after input continuations is ignored.
36416 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
36417 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
36418 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
36419 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
36420 header with the same name, they are all removed.
36422 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
36423 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
36424 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
36425 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
36426 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
36427 used for all recipients of the message.
36429 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
36430 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
36431 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
36432 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
36433 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
36434 until the message is actually being written (see section
36435 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
36437 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
36438 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
36439 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
36440 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
36441 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
36442 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
36443 modified more than once.
36445 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
36446 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
36449 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
36450 headers remove "Subject"
36451 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
36452 headers remove "Old-Subject"
36457 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
36458 .cindex "envelope from"
36459 .cindex "envelope sender"
36460 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
36462 errors_to <some address>
36464 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
36465 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
36466 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
36469 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
36471 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
36472 address if its delivery failed.
36476 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
36477 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
36478 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
36479 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
36480 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
36481 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
36482 such as &$local_part_data$& and &$domain_data$& can be used,
36483 and indeed, the choice of filter file could be made dependent on them.
36484 This is an example of a router which implements such a filter:
36489 domains = +local_domains
36490 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
36495 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
36496 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
36497 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
36498 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
36500 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
36501 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
36502 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
36503 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
36505 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
36506 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
36507 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
36514 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36517 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
36518 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
36519 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
36520 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
36521 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
36522 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
36523 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
36524 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
36526 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
36527 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
36528 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
36529 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
36530 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
36532 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
36533 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
36534 loopback interface specially in any way.
36536 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
36537 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
36542 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
36543 .cindex "message" "submission"
36544 .cindex "submission mode"
36545 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
36546 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
36547 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
36548 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
36550 control = submission
36552 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
36553 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
36554 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
36555 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
36556 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
36557 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
36559 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
36560 control = submission
36562 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
36563 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
36564 is used to separate options. For example:
36566 control = submission/sender_retain
36568 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
36569 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
36570 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
36571 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
36572 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
36573 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
36574 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
36576 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
36577 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
36580 control = submission/domain=some.domain
36582 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
36583 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
36584 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
36585 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
36587 accept authenticated = *
36588 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
36589 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
36590 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
36592 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
36593 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
36594 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
36596 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
36598 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
36601 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
36603 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
36604 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
36605 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
36606 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
36608 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
36609 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
36610 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
36611 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
36612 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
36613 spoof another's address.
36615 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
36616 .cindex "line endings"
36617 .cindex "carriage return"
36619 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
36620 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
36621 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
36622 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
36623 use CRLF or just CR.
36625 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
36626 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
36627 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
36628 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
36629 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
36630 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
36631 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
36632 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
36636 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
36639 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
36640 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
36643 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
36644 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
36645 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
36646 people trying to play silly games.
36648 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
36649 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
36650 line and a bare LF in a body line is replaced with a space.
36652 If the first header line received in a message does not end with CRLF, a subsequent
36653 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
36660 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
36661 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
36662 .cindex "address" "qualification"
36663 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
36664 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
36665 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
36666 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
36667 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
36669 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
36670 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
36671 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
36672 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
36673 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
36675 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
36676 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
36677 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
36678 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
36679 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
36680 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
36681 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
36682 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
36687 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
36688 .cindex "&""From""& line"
36689 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
36690 .cindex "sender" "address"
36691 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
36692 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
36693 .cindex "envelope from"
36694 .cindex "envelope sender"
36695 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36696 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
36697 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
36698 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
36700 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
36701 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
36703 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
36704 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
36705 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
36706 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
36707 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
36708 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
36709 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
36710 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
36711 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
36713 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
36714 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
36715 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
36716 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
36717 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
36718 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
36719 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
36721 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
36722 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
36723 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
36725 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
36726 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
36727 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
36728 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
36732 .section "Header lines"
36733 .subsection "Resent- header lines" SECID220
36735 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
36736 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
36737 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
36738 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
36739 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
36742 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
36743 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
36746 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
36747 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
36751 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
36752 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
36754 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
36755 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
36756 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
36758 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
36761 For a locally-submitted message,
36762 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
36763 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
36764 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
36765 included in log lines in this case.
36767 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
36768 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
36774 .subsection Auto-Submitted: SECID221
36775 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
36776 includes the header line:
36778 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
36781 .subsection Bcc: SECID222
36782 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
36783 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
36784 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
36785 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
36786 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
36789 .subsection Date: SECID223
36791 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
36792 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
36793 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
36795 .subsection Delivery-date: SECID224
36796 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
36797 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
36798 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
36799 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
36800 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
36801 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
36802 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
36806 .subsection Envelope-to: SECID225
36807 .chindex Envelope-to:
36808 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
36809 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
36810 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
36811 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
36812 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
36813 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
36817 .subsection From: SECTthefrohea
36819 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36820 .cindex "message" "submission"
36821 .cindex "submission mode"
36822 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
36823 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
36826 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
36827 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
36829 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
36830 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
36832 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
36833 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
36834 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
36836 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
36837 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
36839 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
36840 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
36844 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
36846 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
36847 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
36848 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
36849 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36850 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
36851 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
36852 &%qualify_domain%&.
36854 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
36855 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
36856 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
36857 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36860 .subsection Message-ID: SECID226
36861 .chindex Message-ID:
36862 .cindex "message" "submission"
36863 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
36864 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
36865 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
36866 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
36867 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
36868 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
36869 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
36870 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
36871 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
36872 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
36875 .subsection Received: SECID227
36877 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
36878 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
36879 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
36881 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
36882 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
36883 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
36884 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
36886 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
36887 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
36888 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
36891 .subsection References: SECID228
36892 .chindex References:
36893 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
36894 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
36895 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
36896 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
36897 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
36898 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
36899 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
36900 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
36901 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
36905 .subsection Return-path: SECID229
36906 .chindex Return-path:
36907 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
36908 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
36909 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
36910 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
36911 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
36912 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
36916 .subsection Sender: SECTthesenhea
36917 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
36918 .cindex "message" "submission"
36920 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
36921 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
36922 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
36923 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36926 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
36927 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36928 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
36929 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
36930 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
36931 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
36932 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
36933 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
36934 line is added to the message.
36936 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
36937 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
36938 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
36939 options true at the same time.
36941 .cindex "submission mode"
36942 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
36943 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
36944 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
36945 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
36947 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
36948 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
36949 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
36950 created as follows:
36953 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
36954 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
36955 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
36957 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
36958 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
36960 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
36961 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
36964 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
36965 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
36966 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
36967 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
36969 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
36970 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
36971 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
36972 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
36976 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
36977 "SECTheadersaddrem"
36978 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
36979 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
36980 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
36981 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
36982 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
36983 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
36984 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
36986 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
36987 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
36988 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
36989 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
36990 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
36991 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
36993 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
36994 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
36995 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
36997 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
36998 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
36999 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
37001 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
37002 X-added-second: another added header line
37004 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
37006 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
37007 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
37008 Each header-line is separately expanded.
37010 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
37011 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
37012 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
37013 not part of the names. For example:
37015 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
37018 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
37019 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
37020 Each item is separately expanded.
37021 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
37022 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
37023 will act as list separators.
37025 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
37026 items are expanded at routing time,
37027 and then associated with all addresses that are
37028 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
37029 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
37030 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
37032 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
37033 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
37034 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
37035 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
37037 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
37038 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
37039 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
37042 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
37043 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
37044 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
37045 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
37046 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
37047 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
37048 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
37050 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
37051 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
37052 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
37053 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
37055 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
37056 the following consequences:
37059 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
37060 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
37061 to it, at all times.
37063 Header lines that are added by a router's
37064 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
37065 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
37067 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
37068 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
37070 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
37071 a later router or by a transport.
37073 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
37074 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
37076 headers_remove = subject
37077 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
37081 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
37082 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
37088 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
37089 .cindex "address" "constructed"
37090 .cindex "constructed address"
37091 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
37094 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
37098 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
37100 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
37101 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
37102 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
37103 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
37104 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
37105 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
37106 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
37107 there is no password file entry.
37110 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
37111 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
37112 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
37113 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
37114 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
37115 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
37116 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
37117 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
37121 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
37122 .cindex "case of local parts"
37123 .cindex "local part" "case of"
37124 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
37125 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
37126 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
37127 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
37128 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
37129 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
37132 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
37133 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
37134 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
37135 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
37136 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
37140 domains = +local_domains
37141 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
37142 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
37145 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
37146 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
37147 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
37148 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
37149 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
37153 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
37154 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
37155 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
37156 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
37157 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
37158 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
37159 empty components for compatibility.
37163 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
37164 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
37165 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
37166 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
37167 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
37168 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
37170 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
37171 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
37172 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
37173 example, a header such as
37177 might get rewritten as
37179 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
37181 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
37182 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
37185 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
37186 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
37187 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
37188 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
37189 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
37190 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
37191 .ecindex IIDmesproc
37195 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37196 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37198 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
37199 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
37200 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
37201 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
37202 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
37203 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
37204 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
37207 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
37209 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
37211 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
37214 For mail delivery, the following are available:
37217 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
37219 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
37222 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
37225 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
37226 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
37229 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
37230 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
37231 used to contain the envelope information.
37235 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
37236 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
37237 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
37238 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
37239 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
37242 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
37243 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
37244 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
37245 processing is the same in both cases.
37247 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
37248 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
37249 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
37250 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
37251 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
37252 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
37253 .cindex "transport" "filter"
37254 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
37255 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
37258 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
37259 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
37260 required for the transaction.
37262 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
37263 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
37264 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
37265 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
37266 is called for verification.
37268 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
37269 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
37270 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
37272 .cindex "carriage return"
37274 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37275 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
37276 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37279 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
37280 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
37281 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
37282 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
37283 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
37284 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
37285 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
37286 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
37287 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
37289 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
37290 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
37291 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
37292 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
37294 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
37295 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
37296 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
37297 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
37299 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37300 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
37301 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
37302 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
37303 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
37304 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
37305 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
37306 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
37307 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
37308 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
37310 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
37311 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
37313 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37314 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
37315 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
37316 square bracket of the IP address.
37321 .subsection "Errors in outgoing SMTP" SECToutSMTPerr
37322 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
37323 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
37324 .cindex "host" "error"
37325 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
37326 message errors, and recipient errors.
37329 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
37330 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
37331 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
37334 Connection refused or timed out,
37336 Any error response code on connection,
37338 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
37340 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
37342 I/O errors at any time,
37344 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
37345 the &"."& at the end of the data.
37348 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
37349 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
37350 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
37351 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
37352 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
37353 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
37354 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
37355 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
37357 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
37358 .cindex "message" "error"
37359 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
37360 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
37361 message errors are:
37364 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
37367 Timeout after MAIL,
37369 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
37370 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
37371 connection at any other time.
37374 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
37375 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
37376 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
37377 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
37378 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
37379 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
37380 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
37381 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
37382 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
37383 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
37385 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
37386 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
37387 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
37390 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
37391 .cindex "recipient" "error"
37392 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
37393 recipient errors are:
37396 Any error response to RCPT,
37398 Timeout after RCPT.
37401 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
37402 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
37403 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
37404 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
37405 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
37406 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
37407 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
37408 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
37409 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
37410 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
37411 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
37412 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
37413 the retry clock is reset.
37415 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
37416 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
37417 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
37418 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
37419 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
37420 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
37421 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
37422 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
37423 recipient's retry time.
37426 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
37427 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
37428 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
37429 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
37430 until the next delivery attempt.
37432 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
37433 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
37434 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
37435 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
37436 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
37439 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
37440 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
37441 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
37442 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
37443 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
37444 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
37445 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
37447 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
37448 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
37449 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
37450 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
37451 then to be treated as a host error.
37453 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
37454 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
37455 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
37456 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
37457 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
37462 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
37463 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
37464 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
37467 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
37468 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
37469 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
37471 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
37473 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
37474 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
37475 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
37476 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
37477 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
37478 stream and exits with an error code.
37480 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
37481 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
37482 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
37483 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
37485 .cindex "carriage return"
37487 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37488 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
37489 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37491 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
37492 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
37493 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
37495 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
37496 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
37497 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
37498 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
37499 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
37500 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
37501 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
37502 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
37504 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
37505 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
37506 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
37507 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
37508 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
37509 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
37510 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
37511 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
37512 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
37514 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
37515 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
37516 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
37518 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
37519 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
37520 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
37521 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
37522 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
37524 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
37525 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
37526 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
37527 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
37528 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
37529 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
37530 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
37532 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
37533 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
37534 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
37535 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
37536 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
37538 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
37539 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
37540 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
37541 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
37542 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
37543 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
37544 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
37545 a delivery process.
37547 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
37548 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
37549 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
37550 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
37551 however, available with &'inetd'&.
37553 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
37554 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
37555 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
37556 section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&.
37558 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
37559 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
37560 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
37564 .subsection "Unrecognized SMTP commands" SECID234
37565 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
37566 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
37567 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
37568 the error response to the last command. The default value for
37569 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
37570 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
37571 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
37574 .subsection "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" SECID235
37575 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
37576 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
37577 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
37578 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
37579 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
37580 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
37581 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
37582 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
37583 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
37584 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
37588 .subsection "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" SECID236
37589 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
37590 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
37591 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
37592 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
37593 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
37594 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
37595 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
37597 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
37598 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
37599 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
37600 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
37601 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
37604 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
37605 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
37606 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
37608 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
37609 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
37610 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
37611 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
37612 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
37617 .subsection "The VRFY and EXPN commands" SECID237
37618 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
37619 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
37620 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
37622 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
37623 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
37624 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
37625 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
37626 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
37627 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
37628 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
37629 SMTP response codes.
37631 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
37632 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
37633 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
37634 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
37635 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
37636 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
37637 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
37638 VRFY verification failures are logged in the main log for consistency with
37643 .subsection "The ETRN command" SECTETRN
37644 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
37645 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
37646 RFC 1985 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
37647 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
37648 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
37649 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
37650 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
37652 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
37653 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
37654 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
37655 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
37656 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
37657 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
37658 argument. For example,
37666 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
37667 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
37668 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
37669 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
37670 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
37672 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
37673 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
37674 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
37675 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
37676 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
37677 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
37678 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
37679 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
37681 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
37682 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
37683 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
37684 whatever the form of its argument. For
37687 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
37688 $sender_host_address
37690 .vindex "&$domain$&"
37691 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
37692 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
37693 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
37694 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
37695 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
37696 for it to change them before running the command.
37700 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
37701 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
37702 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
37703 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
37704 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
37705 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
37706 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
37707 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
37708 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
37709 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
37710 runs for RCPT commands:
37714 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
37718 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
37719 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
37720 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
37721 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
37722 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
37723 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
37724 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
37725 envelope along with the message.
37727 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
37728 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
37729 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
37730 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
37731 can be used to specify it.
37733 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
37734 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
37735 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
37736 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
37737 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
37740 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
37741 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
37742 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
37747 driver = manualroute
37748 transport = smtp_appendfile
37749 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
37753 driver = appendfile
37754 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
37759 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
37760 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
37761 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
37765 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
37766 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
37767 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
37768 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
37769 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
37770 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
37771 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
37772 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
37773 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
37774 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
37776 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
37777 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
37779 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
37780 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
37781 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
37782 make some use of automatically, for example:
37784 554 Unexpected end of file
37785 Transaction started in line 10
37786 Error detected in line 14
37788 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
37791 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
37792 The error message was:
37794 501 '>' missing at end of address
37796 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
37797 The error was detected in line 12.
37798 The SMTP command at fault was:
37800 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
37802 1 previous message was successfully processed.
37803 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
37805 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
37806 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
37808 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
37809 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
37813 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37814 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37816 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
37817 "Customizing messages"
37818 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
37819 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
37820 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
37821 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
37822 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
37824 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
37825 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
37826 option. Exim also adds the line
37828 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
37830 to all warning and bounce messages,
37833 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
37834 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
37835 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
37836 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
37837 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
37838 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
37839 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
37841 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
37842 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
37843 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
37844 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
37845 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
37848 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
37849 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
37850 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
37851 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
37852 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
37853 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
37854 option, rounded to a whole number.
37856 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
37859 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37860 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37862 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
37863 failing addresses with their error messages.
37865 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
37866 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
37868 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
37869 The fields exist for back-compatibility
37872 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
37873 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
37874 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
37876 Subject: Mail delivery failed
37877 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37878 {: returning message to sender}}
37880 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37882 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37883 {that you sent }{sent by
37887 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
37888 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
37890 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
37892 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
37895 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
37897 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
37900 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
37901 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
37902 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
37903 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
37904 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
37908 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37909 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37911 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
37912 the delayed addresses.
37914 The third item then ends the message.
37917 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
37918 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
37920 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
37921 $warn_message_delay
37923 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37925 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
37926 {that you sent }{sent by
37930 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
37931 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
37933 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
37934 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
37935 The date of the message is: $h_date
37937 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
37939 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
37940 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
37941 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
37942 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
37943 the message will be returned to you.
37945 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
37946 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
37947 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
37948 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
37949 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
37950 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
37951 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
37952 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
37958 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37959 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37961 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
37962 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
37963 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
37967 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
37968 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
37969 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
37970 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
37971 routing explicitly:
37973 send_to_smart_host:
37974 driver = manualroute
37975 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
37976 transport = remote_smtp
37978 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
37979 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
37980 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
37981 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
37982 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
37987 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
37988 .cindex "mailing lists"
37989 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
37990 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
37991 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
37993 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
37994 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
37995 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
37996 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
38000 domains = lists.example
38001 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38004 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38007 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
38008 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
38009 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
38010 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
38012 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
38013 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
38016 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
38017 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
38018 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
38019 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
38020 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
38022 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
38023 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
38024 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
38025 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
38026 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
38027 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
38028 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
38029 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
38030 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
38034 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
38035 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
38036 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
38037 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
38038 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
38039 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
38040 addresses are not rigorously checked.
38042 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
38043 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
38044 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
38045 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
38046 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
38050 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
38051 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
38052 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
38053 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
38054 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
38055 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
38056 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
38057 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
38058 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
38059 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
38061 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
38062 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
38063 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
38064 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
38065 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
38066 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
38067 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
38068 pre-existing messages.
38070 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
38071 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
38072 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
38073 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
38074 one level of expansion anyway.
38078 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
38079 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
38080 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
38081 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
38082 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
38083 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
38085 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
38086 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
38090 domains = lists.example
38091 local_part_suffix = -request
38092 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
38093 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
38098 domains = lists.example
38099 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38100 senders = ${if exists {$local_part_data} {lsearch;$local_part_data}{*}}
38101 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38104 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38109 domains = lists.example
38111 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
38113 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
38114 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
38115 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
38118 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
38119 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
38120 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
38121 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
38122 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
38123 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
38124 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
38125 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
38126 &"unrouteable address"& error.
38128 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
38129 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
38130 the address, giving a suitable error message.
38135 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
38137 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
38138 .cindex "envelope from"
38139 .cindex "envelope sender"
38140 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
38141 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
38142 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
38143 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
38144 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
38145 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
38147 .oindex &%errors_to%&
38148 .oindex &%return_path%&
38149 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
38150 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
38151 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
38152 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
38153 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
38154 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
38155 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
38161 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38162 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38164 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
38165 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
38166 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
38167 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
38168 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
38169 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
38170 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
38173 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
38175 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
38176 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
38177 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
38178 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
38179 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
38180 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
38182 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
38183 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
38184 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
38185 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
38189 domains = ! +local_domains
38191 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38192 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
38195 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
38196 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
38197 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
38198 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
38201 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
38202 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
38203 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
38204 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
38205 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
38209 domains = ! +local_domains
38210 transport = remote_smtp
38212 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
38213 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38216 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
38217 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
38218 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
38219 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
38222 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
38223 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
38224 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
38225 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
38226 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
38227 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
38235 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
38236 .cindex "virtual domains"
38237 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
38238 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
38242 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
38243 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
38244 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
38246 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
38247 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
38248 have login accounts on that host.
38251 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
38252 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
38253 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
38254 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
38255 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
38256 to a router of this form:
38260 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
38261 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
38264 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
38265 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
38266 domain that is being processed.
38267 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
38268 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
38270 When the router runs, it looks up the local
38271 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
38272 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
38273 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
38275 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
38276 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
38277 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
38278 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
38280 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
38281 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
38282 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
38286 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
38287 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
38288 transport = my_mailboxes
38290 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
38291 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
38292 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
38293 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
38294 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
38298 driver = appendfile
38299 file = /var/mail/$domain_data/$local_part_data
38302 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
38303 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
38305 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
38306 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
38307 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
38308 information about the domains.
38312 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
38313 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
38314 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
38315 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
38316 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
38317 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
38318 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
38319 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
38320 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
38321 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
38322 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
38323 example, consider this router:
38328 file = $home/.forward
38329 local_part_suffix = -*
38330 local_part_suffix_optional
38333 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
38334 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
38335 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
38336 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
38338 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
38339 save /home/$local_part_data/Mail/special
38342 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
38343 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
38344 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
38345 control over which suffixes are valid.
38347 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
38348 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
38354 local_part_suffix = -*
38355 local_part_suffix_optional
38356 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
38359 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
38360 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
38361 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
38362 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
38363 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
38367 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
38368 .cindex "vacation processing"
38369 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
38370 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
38371 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
38372 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
38373 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
38376 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
38377 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
38378 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
38379 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
38381 spqr, vacation-spqr
38384 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
38385 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
38386 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
38387 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
38388 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
38392 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
38393 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
38397 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
38398 .cindex "message" "copying every"
38399 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
38400 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
38401 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
38402 each day's messages.
38404 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
38405 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
38406 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
38407 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
38411 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
38412 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
38413 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
38414 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
38415 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
38416 permanently connected.
38418 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
38419 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
38420 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
38423 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
38424 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
38425 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
38426 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
38427 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
38428 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
38429 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
38430 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
38432 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
38433 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
38434 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
38435 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
38436 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
38437 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
38440 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
38441 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
38442 intermittent host. For example:
38444 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
38446 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
38447 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
38448 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
38449 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
38450 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
38451 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
38454 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
38455 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
38456 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
38457 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
38458 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
38459 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
38460 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
38464 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
38465 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
38466 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
38467 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
38468 delivered immediately.
38470 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
38471 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
38472 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
38473 .cindex "first pass routing"
38474 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
38475 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
38476 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
38477 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
38478 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
38479 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
38480 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
38481 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
38482 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
38483 single SMTP connection.
38487 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38488 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38490 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
38491 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
38492 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
38493 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
38494 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
38495 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
38496 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
38497 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
38498 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
38499 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
38502 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
38503 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
38504 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
38505 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
38506 email is not desirable.
38508 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
38509 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
38510 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
38511 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
38512 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
38513 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
38514 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
38516 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
38517 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
38518 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
38519 before sending a message to the smart host.
38521 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
38522 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
38523 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
38525 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
38526 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
38527 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
38528 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
38529 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
38530 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
38531 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
38533 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
38537 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
38538 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
38540 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
38541 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
38542 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
38543 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
38544 successful, a zero return code is given.
38546 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
38547 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
38548 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
38549 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
38550 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
38553 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
38554 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
38555 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
38557 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
38558 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
38559 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
38560 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
38561 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
38563 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
38564 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
38565 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
38567 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
38568 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
38569 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
38570 are ever generated.
38572 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
38574 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
38575 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
38576 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
38579 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
38580 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
38581 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
38582 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
38583 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
38584 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
38589 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38590 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38592 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
38593 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
38594 .cindex "log" "types of"
38595 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
38600 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
38601 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
38602 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
38603 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
38604 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
38605 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
38606 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
38607 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
38609 .cindex "reject log"
38610 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
38611 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
38612 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
38613 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
38614 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
38615 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
38616 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
38617 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
38618 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
38621 .cindex "panic log"
38622 .cindex "system log"
38623 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
38624 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
38625 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
38626 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
38627 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
38628 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
38629 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
38630 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
38631 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
38634 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
38635 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
38636 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
38638 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
38641 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
38642 ways of changing this:
38645 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
38650 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
38652 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
38655 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
38659 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
38660 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38661 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
38662 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
38663 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
38664 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
38669 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
38670 .cindex "log" "destination"
38671 .cindex "log" "to file"
38672 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
38674 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
38675 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
38676 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
38677 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
38678 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
38679 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
38680 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
38682 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
38683 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
38684 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
38685 references to the host name:
38687 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
38689 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
38690 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
38691 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
38692 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
38693 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
38696 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
38697 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
38698 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
38699 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
38700 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
38701 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
38702 implying the use of a default path.
38704 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
38705 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
38706 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
38707 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. If no such item exists, log
38708 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
38709 equivalent to the configuration file setting:
38711 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
38713 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
38714 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
38715 that is where the logs are written.
38717 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
38718 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
38720 Here are some examples of possible Makefile settings:
38722 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
38723 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
38724 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
38725 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
38727 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
38732 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
38733 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38734 .cindex "cycling logs"
38735 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38736 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
38737 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
38738 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
38739 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
38740 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
38741 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
38743 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
38744 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
38745 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
38746 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
38747 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
38748 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
38749 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
38750 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
38751 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
38752 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
38753 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
38758 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
38759 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
38760 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
38761 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
38762 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
38763 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
38764 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
38765 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
38767 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
38768 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
38769 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
38770 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
38772 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
38773 examples of names generated by the above examples:
38775 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
38776 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
38777 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
38778 /var/log/exim/main.200212
38780 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
38781 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
38782 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
38783 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
38785 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
38786 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
38787 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
38788 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
38789 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
38790 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
38793 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38794 /var/log/exim-panic.log
38795 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38796 /var/log/exim/panic
38800 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
38801 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
38802 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
38803 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
38804 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
38805 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
38806 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
38807 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
38808 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
38809 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
38810 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
38811 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
38812 the time and host name to each line.
38813 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
38816 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
38818 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
38820 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
38823 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
38824 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
38825 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
38826 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
38828 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
38829 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
38830 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
38831 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
38832 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
38833 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
38834 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
38835 RFC 3164, you should set
38837 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
38839 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
38840 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
38842 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
38843 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
38844 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
38845 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
38846 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
38847 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
38848 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
38849 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
38850 name, and pid as added by syslog:
38852 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
38853 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
38854 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
38855 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
38858 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
38861 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
38862 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
38863 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
38864 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
38866 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
38867 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
38868 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
38869 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
38870 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
38871 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
38873 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
38874 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
38875 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
38878 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
38880 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
38881 without modification.
38883 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
38884 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
38885 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
38890 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
38891 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
38892 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
38893 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
38894 timestamp. The flags are:
38895 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
38896 .irow &%<=%& "message arrival"
38897 .irow &%(=%& "message fakereject"
38898 .irow &%=>%& "normal message delivery"
38899 .irow &%->%& "additional address in same delivery"
38900 .irow &%>>%& "cutthrough message delivery"
38901 .irow &%*>%& "delivery suppressed by &%-N%&"
38902 .irow &%**%& "delivery failed; address bounced"
38903 .irow &%==%& "delivery deferred; temporary problem"
38907 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
38908 .cindex "log" "reception line"
38909 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
38910 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
38911 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
38913 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
38914 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
38915 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
38917 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
38918 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
38919 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
38923 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
38927 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
38928 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
38929 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
38930 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
38931 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
38932 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
38933 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
38934 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
38935 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
38936 name in parentheses.
38938 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
38939 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
38940 the log containing text like these examples:
38942 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
38943 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
38945 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
38948 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
38949 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
38952 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
38953 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
38954 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
38955 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
38956 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
38957 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
38958 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
38959 suite that was used.
38961 .cindex log protocol
38962 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
38963 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
38964 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
38965 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
38966 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
38967 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
38968 authenticator name.
38970 .cindex "size" "of message"
38971 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
38972 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
38973 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
38974 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
38977 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
38978 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
38982 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
38983 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
38984 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
38985 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
38986 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
38987 to fit it on the page:
38989 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
38990 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
38991 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
38992 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
38993 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
38995 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
38996 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
38997 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
38998 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
38999 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
39001 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
39002 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
39003 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
39004 option, this is logged too, as a second colon-separated list item.
39005 Optionally (see the &%smtp_mailauth%& &%log_selector%&) there may be a third list item.
39007 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
39008 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
39010 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
39012 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
39013 parentheses afterwards.
39015 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
39016 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
39017 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
39018 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
39019 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
39020 remote IP address (and port if enabled)
39021 in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39022 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
39023 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
39024 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39025 TLS cipher information is still available.
39027 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
39028 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
39029 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
39030 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
39031 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
39033 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
39034 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
39036 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39037 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39040 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
39041 .cindex "discarded messages"
39042 .cindex "message" "discarded"
39043 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
39044 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
39045 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
39047 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
39048 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
39050 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
39051 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
39053 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
39054 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
39058 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
39059 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
39061 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
39062 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
39064 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
39065 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
39066 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
39068 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
39069 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
39071 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
39072 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
39073 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
39077 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
39078 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
39079 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
39080 following form is logged:
39082 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
39083 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
39085 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
39086 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
39088 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
39089 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
39090 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
39091 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
39092 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
39094 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
39095 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
39096 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
39097 flagged with &`**`&.
39101 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
39102 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
39103 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
39104 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
39105 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
39109 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
39112 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
39114 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
39115 at the end of its processing.
39120 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
39121 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
39122 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
39123 the following table:
39125 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
39126 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
39127 &`Ci `& connection identifier
39128 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39129 &`CV `& certificate verification status
39130 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39131 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
39132 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
39133 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
39134 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
39135 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
39136 &`H `& host name and IP address
39137 &`I `& local interface used
39138 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
39139 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
39140 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
39141 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
39142 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
39143 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
39144 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
39145 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
39146 &`Q `& alternate queue name
39147 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
39148 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
39149 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
39150 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
39151 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
39152 &`S `& size of message in bytes
39153 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
39154 &`ST `& shadow transport name
39155 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
39156 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
39157 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
39158 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
39159 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
39163 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
39164 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
39165 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
39168 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
39169 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
39170 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
39171 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
39172 during the first delivery attempt.
39174 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
39175 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
39176 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
39178 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
39179 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
39180 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
39181 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
39182 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
39185 .cindex "error" "ignored"
39186 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
39189 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
39190 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
39192 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
39193 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39195 A delivery set up by a router configured with
39196 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
39197 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
39201 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39204 .cindex DKIM "log line"
39205 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
39206 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
39213 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
39214 .cindex "log" "selectors"
39215 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
39216 default logging to the main log, or you can request additional logging. The value of
39217 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
39220 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
39222 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
39223 selection marked by asterisks:
39224 .itable none 0 0 3 2.8in left 10pt center 3in left
39225 .irow &`8bitmime`& "received 8BITMIME status"
39226 .irow &`acl_warn_skipped`& * "skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL"
39227 .irow &`address_rewrite`& "address rewriting"
39228 .irow &`all_parents`& "all parents in => lines"
39229 .irow &`arguments`& "command line arguments"
39230 .irow &`connection_id`& "connection identifier"
39231 .irow &`connection_reject`& * "connection rejections"
39232 .irow &`delay_delivery`& * "immediate delivery delayed"
39233 .irow &`deliver_time`& "time taken to attempt delivery"
39234 .irow &`delivery_size`& "add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines"
39235 .irow &`dkim`& * "DKIM verified domain on <= lines"
39236 .irow &`dkim_verbose`& "separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature; DKIM signing"
39237 .irow &`dnslist_defer`& * "defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups"
39238 .irow &`dnssec`& "DNSSEC secured lookups"
39239 .irow &`etrn`& * "ETRN commands"
39240 .irow &`host_lookup_failed`& * "as it says"
39241 .irow &`ident_timeout`& "timeout for ident connection"
39242 .irow &`incoming_interface`& "local interface & port on <= and => lines"
39243 .irow &`incoming_port`& "remote port on <= lines"
39244 .irow &`lost_incoming_connection`& * "as it says (includes timeouts)"
39245 .irow &`millisec`& "millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times"
39246 .irow &`msg_id`& * "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value"
39247 .irow &`msg_id_created`& "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added"
39248 .irow &`outgoing_interface`& "local interface on => lines"
39249 .irow &`outgoing_port`& "add remote port to => lines"
39250 .irow &`queue_run`& * "start and end queue runs"
39251 .irow &`queue_time`& "time on queue for one recipient"
39252 .irow &`queue_time_exclusive`& "exclude recieve time from QT times"
39253 .irow &`queue_time_overall`& "time on queue for whole message"
39254 .irow &`pid`& "Exim process id"
39255 .irow &`pipelining`& "PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines"
39256 .irow &`proxy`& "proxy address on <= and => lines"
39257 .irow &`receive_time`& "time taken to receive message"
39258 .irow &`received_recipients`& "recipients on <= lines"
39259 .irow &`received_sender`& "sender on <= lines"
39260 .irow &`rejected_header`& * "header contents on reject log"
39261 .irow &`retry_defer`& * "&<quote>&retry time not reached&</quote>&"
39262 .irow &`return_path_on_delivery`& "put return path on => and ** lines"
39263 .irow &`sender_on_delivery`& "add sender to => lines"
39264 .irow &`sender_verify_fail`& * "sender verification failures"
39265 .irow &`size_reject`& * "rejection because too big"
39266 .irow &`skip_delivery`& * "delivery skipped in a queue run"
39267 .irow &`smtp_confirmation`& * "SMTP confirmation on => lines"
39268 .irow &`smtp_connection`& "incoming SMTP connections"
39269 .irow &`smtp_incomplete_transaction`& "incomplete SMTP transactions"
39270 .irow &`smtp_mailauth`& "AUTH argument to MAIL commands"
39271 .irow &`smtp_no_mail`& "session with no MAIL commands"
39272 .irow &`smtp_protocol_error`& "SMTP protocol errors"
39273 .irow &`smtp_syntax_error`& "SMTP syntax errors"
39274 .irow &`subject`& "contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines"
39275 .irow &`tls_certificate_verified`& * "certificate verification status"
39276 .irow &`tls_cipher`& * "TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines"
39277 .irow &`tls_peerdn`& "TLS peer DN on <= and => lines"
39278 .irow &`tls_resumption`& "append * to cipher field"
39279 .irow &`tls_sni`& "TLS SNI on <= lines"
39280 .irow &`unknown_in_list`& "lookup failed in list match"
39281 .irow &`all`& "&*all of the above*&"
39283 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
39284 section &<<SECID99>>&
39286 More details on each of these items follows:
39290 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
39291 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
39292 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
39293 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
39294 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
39295 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
39297 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
39298 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
39299 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
39300 this log selector is set.
39302 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
39303 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
39304 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
39305 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
39306 such users cannot access the log).
39308 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
39309 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
39310 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
39311 parentheses between them.
39313 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
39314 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
39315 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
39316 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
39317 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
39318 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
39319 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
39320 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
39321 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
39322 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
39323 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
39324 between the caller and Exim.
39326 .cindex "log" "connection identifier"
39327 &%connection_identifier%&: An identifier for the accepted connection is added to
39328 connection start and end lines and to message accept lines.
39329 The identifier is tagged by Ci=.
39330 The value is PID-based, so will reset on reboot and will wrap.
39332 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
39333 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
39334 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
39336 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
39337 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
39338 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
39339 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
39340 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
39341 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
39343 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
39344 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
39345 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
39346 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39347 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
39349 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
39350 .cindex "size" "of message"
39351 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
39352 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
39354 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39355 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39356 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
39357 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
39359 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39360 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39361 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
39362 Also, on message delivery lines signing information (domain and selector)
39363 is added, tagged with DKIM=.
39365 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
39366 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
39367 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
39368 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
39369 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
39372 .cindex dnssec logging
39373 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
39374 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
39375 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
39376 It does not cover helo-name verification.
39377 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
39379 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
39380 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
39381 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
39382 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
39383 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
39384 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
39386 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
39387 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
39388 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
39389 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
39390 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
39392 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
39393 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
39394 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
39395 client's ident port times out.
39397 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
39398 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39399 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39400 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39401 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39402 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39403 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
39404 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
39405 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
39406 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
39407 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing
39408 &"=>"&, &"->"&, &"=="& and &"**"& lines.
39409 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39411 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
39412 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
39413 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
39414 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
39415 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
39416 on a proxied connection
39417 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
39418 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
39420 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
39421 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
39422 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
39423 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
39424 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
39425 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
39426 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
39427 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
39428 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
39429 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
39430 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
39432 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
39433 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
39434 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
39436 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
39437 .cindex millisecond logging
39438 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
39439 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
39440 appended to the seconds value.
39442 .cindex "log" "message id"
39443 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
39445 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
39446 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
39447 (submission mode) without one.
39448 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
39450 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39451 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39452 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39453 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39454 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39455 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
39456 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
39457 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
39458 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39460 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
39461 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
39462 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
39463 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
39464 containing => tags) following the IP address.
39465 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
39466 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
39467 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
39468 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
39469 local port is a random ephemeral port.
39471 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
39472 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
39473 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
39474 immediately after the time and date.
39476 .cindex log pipelining
39477 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
39478 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
39479 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
39480 The field is a single "L".
39482 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
39483 the field has a minus appended.
39485 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
39486 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
39487 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
39488 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
39489 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
39492 .cindex "log" "queue run"
39493 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
39494 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
39496 .cindex "log" "queue time"
39497 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
39498 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
39500 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39501 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
39503 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
39504 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
39505 example, &`QT=3m45s`&.
39507 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
39508 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
39509 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
39510 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39511 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
39513 .cindex "log" "recipients"
39514 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
39515 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
39516 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
39517 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
39519 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
39522 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
39523 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
39524 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
39525 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
39527 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
39528 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
39529 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
39530 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
39531 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
39533 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
39534 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
39535 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
39536 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
39539 .cindex "log" "return path"
39540 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
39541 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
39542 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
39543 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
39545 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
39546 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
39547 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
39548 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
39549 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
39551 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
39552 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
39553 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
39554 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
39557 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
39558 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
39561 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
39562 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
39563 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
39564 queue run because it another process is already delivering it or because
39566 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
39567 .cindex "&""message is frozen""&"
39568 The message that is written is either &"spool file is locked"& or
39569 &"message is frozen"&.
39571 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
39572 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
39573 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
39574 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
39575 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
39576 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
39579 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
39580 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
39581 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
39582 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
39583 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
39584 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
39585 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
39586 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
39587 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
39588 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
39590 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
39591 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
39592 reset if the daemon is restarted.
39593 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
39594 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
39595 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
39596 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
39597 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
39599 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
39600 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
39601 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
39602 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
39603 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
39604 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
39606 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
39607 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
39608 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
39609 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
39610 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
39611 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
39612 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
39613 already have their own log lines.
39615 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
39616 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
39617 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
39618 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
39619 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
39620 the same logging options.
39622 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
39623 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
39627 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
39628 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
39629 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
39630 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
39631 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
39633 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
39634 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
39635 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
39636 was accepted or used.
39638 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
39639 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
39640 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
39641 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
39642 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
39643 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
39644 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
39645 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
39647 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
39648 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
39649 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
39650 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
39651 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
39652 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
39653 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
39654 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
39655 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
39657 .cindex "log" "subject"
39658 .cindex "subject, logging"
39659 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
39660 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
39661 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
39662 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
39663 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
39665 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
39667 .cindex DANE logging
39668 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
39669 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
39671 using a CA trust anchor,
39672 &`CV=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
39673 and &`CV=no`& if not.
39675 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
39676 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
39677 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39678 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
39680 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
39681 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
39682 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39683 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
39684 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
39686 .cindex "log" "TLS resumption"
39687 .cindex "TLS" "logging session resumption"
39688 &%tls_resumption%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39689 connection and the TLS session resumed one used on a previous TCP connection,
39690 an asterisk is appended to the X= cipher field in the log line.
39692 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
39693 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
39694 .cindex SNI logging
39695 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
39696 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
39697 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
39699 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
39700 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
39701 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed, or because
39702 a bad IP address was in the list.
39706 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
39707 .cindex "message" "log file for"
39708 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
39709 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
39710 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
39711 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
39712 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
39713 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
39714 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
39715 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
39716 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
39717 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
39718 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
39720 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
39721 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
39722 &%message_logs%& option false.
39728 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39731 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
39732 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
39733 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
39734 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
39735 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
39737 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
39738 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
39739 "list what Exim processes are doing"
39740 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
39741 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
39742 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
39743 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
39745 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
39746 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
39747 "extract statistics from the log"
39748 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
39749 "check address acceptance from given IP"
39750 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
39751 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
39752 .irow &<<SECTdumpdb>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
39753 .irow &<<SECTtidydb>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
39754 .irow &<<SECTfixdb>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
39755 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
39756 .irow &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>& &'exim_msgdate'& "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)"
39759 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
39760 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
39761 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
39766 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
39767 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
39768 .cindex "process, querying"
39770 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
39771 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
39772 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
39773 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
39774 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
39775 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
39776 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
39777 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
39779 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
39780 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
39781 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
39784 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
39785 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
39786 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
39787 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
39788 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
39790 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
39791 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD`& "the command for running &'ps'&"
39792 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG`& "the argument for &'ps'&"
39793 .irow &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG`& "the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output"
39794 .irow &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG`& "the argument for the &'kill'& command"
39796 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
39798 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
39799 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
39800 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
39801 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
39802 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
39803 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
39805 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
39806 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
39810 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
39811 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
39812 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
39813 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
39817 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
39821 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
39822 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
39825 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
39826 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39827 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
39831 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
39832 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39833 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
39835 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
39836 Match against the size field.
39838 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39839 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
39841 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39842 Match messages that are older than the given time.
39845 Match only frozen messages.
39848 Match only non-frozen messages.
39850 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
39851 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
39854 The following options control the format of the output:
39858 Display only the count of matching messages.
39861 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
39865 Display message ids only.
39868 Brief format &-- one line per message.
39871 Display messages in reverse order.
39874 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
39877 The following options give alternates for configuration:
39880 .vitem &*-C*&&~<&'config&~file'&>
39881 is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
39882 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
39884 .vitem &*-E*&&~<&'path'&>
39885 can be used to specify a path for the exim binary,
39886 overriding the built-in one.
39889 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
39890 At least one selection option, or either the &*-c*& or &*-h*& option, must be given.
39894 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
39895 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
39896 .cindex "queue" "summary"
39897 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
39898 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
39899 running a command such as
39901 exim -bp | exiqsumm
39903 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
39904 it, as in the following example:
39906 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
39908 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
39909 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
39910 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
39911 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
39913 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
39914 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
39915 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
39916 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
39917 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
39918 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
39921 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
39922 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
39923 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
39924 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
39925 level"& addresses).
39930 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
39932 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
39933 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
39934 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
39935 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
39936 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
39937 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
39938 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
39939 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
39940 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
39941 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
39943 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
39945 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
39947 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
39948 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
39949 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
39951 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
39952 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
39953 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
39954 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
39955 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
39957 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
39958 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
39959 regular expression.
39961 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
39962 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
39964 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
39965 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
39969 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
39970 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
39971 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
39972 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
39973 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
39974 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
39977 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
39978 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
39979 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
39980 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
39981 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
39984 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
39985 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
39986 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
39987 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
39988 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
39989 the &%--help%& option.
39992 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
39993 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
39994 .cindex "cycling logs"
39995 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
39996 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
39997 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
39998 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
39999 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
40000 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
40001 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
40003 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
40004 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
40006 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
40007 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
40008 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
40012 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
40013 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
40014 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
40015 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
40016 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
40017 logs are handled similarly.
40019 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
40020 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
40021 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
40022 any existing log files.
40024 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
40025 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
40026 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
40027 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
40028 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
40030 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
40032 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
40033 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
40037 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
40038 .cindex "statistics"
40039 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
40040 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
40041 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
40042 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
40043 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
40045 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
40046 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
40047 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
40048 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
40049 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
40051 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
40053 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
40054 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
40055 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
40056 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
40057 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
40058 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
40059 also produced per user.
40061 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
40062 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
40063 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
40064 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
40065 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
40067 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
40068 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
40069 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
40070 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
40071 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
40072 an entirely separate message.
40074 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
40075 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
40076 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
40077 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
40078 least one address that failed.
40080 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
40081 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
40082 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
40083 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
40084 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
40085 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
40086 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
40088 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
40089 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
40090 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
40092 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
40093 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
40094 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
40096 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
40099 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
40100 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
40101 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
40102 .cindex "checking access"
40103 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
40104 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
40105 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
40106 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
40107 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
40108 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
40110 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
40111 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
40113 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
40115 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
40116 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
40117 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
40118 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
40121 550 Relay not permitted
40123 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
40124 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
40125 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
40126 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
40129 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
40130 -f himself@there.example
40132 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
40133 mandatory arguments.
40135 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
40136 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
40137 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
40141 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
40142 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
40143 .cindex "building DBM files"
40144 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
40145 .cindex "lower casing"
40146 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
40147 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
40148 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
40149 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
40150 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
40151 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
40153 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
40154 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
40155 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
40156 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
40159 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
40160 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
40161 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
40165 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
40166 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
40167 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
40168 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
40170 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
40172 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
40173 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
40175 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
40176 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
40177 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
40178 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
40179 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
40180 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
40182 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
40183 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
40184 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
40185 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
40186 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
40187 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
40188 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
40194 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
40195 .cindex "retry" "times"
40196 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
40197 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
40198 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
40199 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
40200 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
40201 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
40202 output. For example:
40204 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
40205 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
40206 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40207 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40208 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
40209 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
40210 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
40211 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
40212 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
40213 past final cutoff time
40215 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
40216 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
40217 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
40218 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
40219 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
40220 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
40223 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
40224 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
40225 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
40226 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
40227 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
40228 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
40232 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
40233 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
40234 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
40235 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
40236 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
40237 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
40238 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
40241 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
40243 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
40246 &'callout'&: the callout cache
40248 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
40250 &'tls'&: TLS session resumption data
40252 &'misc'&: other hints data
40255 The &'misc'& database is used for
40258 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
40260 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
40261 &(smtp)& transport)
40263 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
40266 Recording EHLO-time facilities advertised by hosts
40271 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECTdumpdb"
40272 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
40273 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
40274 &'exim_dumpdb'& program,
40275 taking as arguments the spool and database names.
40276 An option &'-z'& may be given to request times in UTC;
40277 otherwise times are in the local timezone.
40278 An option &'-k'& may be given to dump only the record keys.
40279 For example, to dump the retry database:
40281 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
40283 For the retry database
40284 two lines of output are produced for each entry:
40286 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
40287 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
40289 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
40290 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
40291 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
40292 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
40293 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
40294 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
40295 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
40296 and a textual description of the error.
40298 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
40299 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
40300 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
40303 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
40304 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
40305 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
40306 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
40307 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
40308 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
40313 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECTtidydb"
40314 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
40315 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
40316 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
40317 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
40318 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
40319 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
40320 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
40321 updated sufficiently often.
40323 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
40324 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
40325 the retry database:
40327 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
40329 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
40330 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
40331 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
40332 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
40333 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
40334 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
40335 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
40336 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
40337 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
40338 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
40339 whenever it removes information from the database.
40341 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
40342 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
40343 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
40344 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
40345 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
40347 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
40348 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
40349 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
40350 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
40351 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
40352 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
40353 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
40356 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
40357 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
40362 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECTfixdb"
40363 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
40364 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
40365 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
40366 getting round problems in a live system. Its interface
40367 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
40368 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
40371 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
40372 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
40373 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
40374 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
40375 by new data, for example:
40379 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
40380 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
40381 used as optional separators.
40383 Both displayed and input times are in the local timezone by default.
40384 If an option &'-z'& is used on the command line, displayed times
40390 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
40391 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
40392 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
40393 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
40394 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
40395 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
40396 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
40397 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
40398 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
40399 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
40400 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
40401 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
40402 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
40406 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
40409 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
40412 .vitem &%-interval%&
40413 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
40414 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
40416 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
40417 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
40420 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
40423 Suppress verification output.
40425 .vitem &%-retries%&
40426 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
40427 the lock (default 10).
40429 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
40430 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
40431 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
40432 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
40435 .vitem &%-timeout%&
40436 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
40437 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
40438 default), a non-blocking call is used.
40441 Generate verbose output.
40444 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
40445 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
40446 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
40447 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
40448 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
40449 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
40450 more than 30 minutes old.
40452 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
40453 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
40454 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
40455 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
40456 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
40457 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
40459 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
40460 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
40461 suppresses all output except error messages.
40465 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
40467 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
40469 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
40470 <&'some commands'&>
40473 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
40474 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
40477 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
40478 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
40480 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
40481 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
40484 .section "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)" "SECTexim_msgdate"
40485 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
40486 The &'exim_msgdate'& utility is written by Andrew Aitchison and included in the Exim distribution.
40487 This Perl script converts an Exim Mesage ID back into a human readable form.
40488 For details of &'exim_msgdate'&'s options, run &'exim_msgdate'& with the &%--help%& option.
40490 Section &<<SECTmessiden>>& (Message identification) describes Exim Mesage IDs.
40492 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40493 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40495 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
40496 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
40497 .cindex "X-windows"
40498 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
40499 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
40500 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
40501 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
40502 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
40503 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
40504 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
40505 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
40509 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
40510 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
40511 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
40512 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
40513 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
40514 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
40515 parameters are for.
40517 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
40518 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
40519 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
40521 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
40523 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
40524 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
40525 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
40526 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
40527 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
40529 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
40530 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
40532 Eximon*background: gray94
40534 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
40535 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
40536 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
40537 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
40538 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
40539 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
40540 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
40543 Eximon*highlight: gray
40546 .cindex "admin user"
40547 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
40548 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
40550 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
40551 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
40552 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
40553 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
40554 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
40556 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
40557 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
40558 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
40559 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
40560 different parts of the display.
40565 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
40566 .cindex "stripchart"
40567 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
40568 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40569 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
40570 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
40571 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
40572 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
40573 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
40574 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
40575 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40577 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
40578 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
40579 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
40580 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
40582 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
40583 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
40584 to a single partition.
40586 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
40587 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
40588 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
40589 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
40590 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
40591 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40592 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40597 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
40598 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
40599 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
40600 .cindex "window size"
40601 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
40602 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
40603 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
40604 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
40605 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
40606 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
40608 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
40609 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
40610 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
40611 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
40613 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
40614 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
40615 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
40616 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
40617 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
40618 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40620 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
40621 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
40622 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40626 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
40627 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
40628 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
40629 the main log is maintained.
40630 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
40631 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
40632 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
40633 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
40634 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
40636 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
40637 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
40638 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
40639 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
40640 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
40641 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
40642 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
40643 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
40644 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
40645 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
40646 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40648 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
40649 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
40650 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
40651 It cannot go further back up the log.
40653 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
40654 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
40655 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
40656 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
40657 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
40658 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
40660 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
40661 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
40662 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
40663 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
40664 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
40665 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
40667 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
40668 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
40669 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
40670 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
40671 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
40672 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
40673 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
40674 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
40675 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
40680 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
40681 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
40682 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
40683 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
40684 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
40685 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
40686 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
40687 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
40688 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
40689 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
40691 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
40692 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
40693 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
40694 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
40695 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
40696 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
40697 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
40699 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
40700 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
40701 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
40702 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
40703 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
40704 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
40705 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
40707 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
40708 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
40709 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
40710 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
40712 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
40713 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
40714 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
40715 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
40716 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
40717 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
40718 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
40721 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
40722 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
40724 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
40725 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
40726 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
40727 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
40728 display is updated.
40732 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
40733 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
40734 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
40735 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
40736 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
40739 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
40740 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
40741 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
40742 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
40743 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
40745 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
40747 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
40751 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
40752 in a new text window.
40754 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
40755 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
40756 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
40758 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
40759 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
40760 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
40761 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
40763 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
40764 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
40765 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
40766 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
40767 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
40769 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
40770 that the message be frozen.
40772 .cindex "thawing messages"
40773 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
40774 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
40775 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
40776 that the message be thawed.
40778 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
40779 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
40780 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
40781 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
40783 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
40784 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
40787 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
40788 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40789 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40790 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40791 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
40792 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
40793 which case no action is taken.
40795 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
40796 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40797 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40798 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40799 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
40800 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
40801 case no action is taken.
40803 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
40804 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
40806 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
40807 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
40808 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
40809 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
40810 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
40811 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
40812 the address is qualified with that domain.
40815 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
40816 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
40817 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
40818 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
40819 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
40820 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
40821 if no output is generated.
40823 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
40824 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
40825 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
40826 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
40828 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
40829 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
40830 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
40837 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40838 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40840 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
40841 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
40842 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
40843 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
40845 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
40846 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
40847 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
40848 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
40849 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
40850 its security as compared with other MTAs.
40852 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
40853 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
40854 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
40855 as soon as possible.
40858 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
40859 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
40860 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
40861 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
40862 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
40863 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
40866 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
40867 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
40868 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
40869 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
40870 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
40871 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
40873 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
40874 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
40875 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
40876 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
40879 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
40880 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
40881 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
40882 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
40883 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
40884 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
40885 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
40886 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
40887 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
40891 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
40892 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
40893 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
40894 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
40895 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
40896 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
40897 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
40899 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
40902 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
40903 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
40904 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
40905 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
40906 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
40911 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
40913 .cindex "root privilege"
40914 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
40915 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
40916 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
40917 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
40918 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
40919 is required for two things:
40922 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
40923 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
40926 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
40927 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
40931 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
40932 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
40933 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
40934 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
40935 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
40936 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
40937 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
40938 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
40940 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
40941 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
40942 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
40944 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
40945 uid and gid in the following cases:
40950 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
40951 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
40952 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
40953 the calling process.
40954 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
40955 option may not be used at all.
40956 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
40957 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
40958 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
40963 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
40964 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
40967 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
40968 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
40969 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
40970 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
40971 testing address verification
40974 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
40977 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
40978 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
40981 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
40984 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
40985 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
40986 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
40987 will be used during message reception.
40989 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
40990 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
40992 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
40993 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
40994 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
40995 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
40996 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
40997 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
40998 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
40999 generating bounce and warning messages.
41001 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
41002 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
41003 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
41004 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
41006 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
41007 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
41013 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
41014 .cindex "privilege, running without"
41015 .cindex "unprivileged running"
41016 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
41017 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
41018 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
41019 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
41020 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
41021 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
41022 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
41026 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
41027 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
41028 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
41029 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
41031 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
41032 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
41033 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
41034 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
41035 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
41037 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
41038 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
41039 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
41042 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
41043 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
41044 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
41046 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
41047 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
41048 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
41049 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
41050 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
41051 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
41052 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
41053 address this problem at this time.
41055 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
41056 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
41057 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
41058 be used in the most straightforward way.
41060 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
41061 number of restrictions on what you can do:
41064 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
41065 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
41066 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
41067 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
41068 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
41070 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
41071 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
41073 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
41074 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
41075 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
41076 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
41078 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
41079 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
41082 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
41083 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
41084 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
41086 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
41087 owned by the Exim user.
41089 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
41090 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
41091 mailboxes need to be created manually.
41096 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
41097 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
41098 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
41099 gives more security at essentially no cost.
41101 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
41102 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
41107 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
41108 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
41109 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
41113 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
41114 .cindex "security" "local commands"
41115 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
41116 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
41117 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
41118 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
41119 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
41122 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
41123 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
41124 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
41125 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
41126 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
41128 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
41129 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
41130 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
41131 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
41132 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
41133 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
41134 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
41136 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
41137 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
41138 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
41140 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
41141 taint checking might apply to their usage.
41143 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
41144 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
41145 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
41147 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
41148 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
41149 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
41151 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
41152 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
41153 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
41154 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
41160 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
41161 .cindex "security" "data sources"
41162 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
41163 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
41164 .cindex "PCRE2" "security"
41165 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
41166 are some issues to be aware of:
41169 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
41171 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
41173 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
41174 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE2. Be aware of what
41175 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
41176 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
41177 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
41178 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
41181 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
41182 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
41183 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
41185 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
41186 expected to yield one result.
41192 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
41193 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
41194 .cindex "IP source routing"
41195 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
41196 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
41197 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
41198 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
41202 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
41203 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
41204 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
41209 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
41210 .cindex "trusted users"
41211 .cindex "admin user"
41212 .cindex "privileged user"
41213 .cindex "user" "trusted"
41214 .cindex "user" "admin"
41215 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
41216 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
41217 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
41218 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
41219 permit a remote host to be specified.
41222 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
41223 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
41224 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
41225 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
41226 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
41227 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
41229 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
41230 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
41231 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
41232 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
41233 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
41235 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
41236 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
41237 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
41238 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
41239 includes the contents of files on the spool.
41243 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
41244 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
41245 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
41246 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
41247 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
41248 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
41250 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
41251 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
41252 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
41253 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
41254 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
41255 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
41258 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
41259 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
41260 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
41261 This affects most of the checking options,
41262 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
41265 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
41266 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
41267 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
41268 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
41269 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
41270 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
41274 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
41275 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
41276 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
41277 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
41278 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
41283 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
41284 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
41285 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
41286 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
41291 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
41292 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
41293 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
41294 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
41295 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
41299 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
41300 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
41301 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
41305 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
41306 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
41307 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
41308 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
41309 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
41310 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
41311 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
41313 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
41314 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
41319 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
41320 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
41321 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
41322 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
41326 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
41327 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
41328 enough to hold the result.
41329 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
41334 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41335 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41337 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
41338 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
41339 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
41340 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
41341 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
41342 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
41343 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
41344 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
41345 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
41346 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
41347 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
41348 themselves are recoverable.
41350 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
41351 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
41352 and should not be used as such.
41354 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
41355 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
41356 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
41359 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
41360 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
41361 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
41362 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
41363 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
41365 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
41366 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
41367 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
41368 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
41370 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
41372 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
41375 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
41377 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
41378 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
41379 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
41380 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
41381 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
41382 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
41383 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
41384 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
41387 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
41388 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
41389 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
41390 relics of crashes and can be removed.
41392 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
41393 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
41394 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
41395 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
41396 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
41397 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
41398 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
41399 normally the Exim user.
41401 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
41402 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
41403 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
41404 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
41405 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
41406 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
41407 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
41408 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
41410 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
41411 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
41412 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
41413 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
41415 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen.
41416 These contain variables, can appear in any
41417 order, and are omitted when not relevant.
41419 If there is a second hyphen after the first,
41420 the corresponding data is tainted.
41421 If there is a value in parentheses, the data is quoted for a lookup.
41423 The following word specifies a variable,
41424 and the remainder of the item depends on the variable.
41427 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41428 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
41429 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
41430 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
41431 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
41432 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
41433 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
41434 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
41435 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
41438 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41439 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
41440 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
41441 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41442 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41443 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41445 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41446 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
41447 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
41448 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41449 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41450 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41452 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
41453 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
41454 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
41456 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
41457 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
41458 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
41459 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
41460 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41462 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
41463 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
41464 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
41465 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
41466 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41468 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
41469 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
41470 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
41472 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
41473 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
41474 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
41476 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41477 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
41478 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
41480 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41481 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
41482 present if the number is greater than zero.
41484 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
41485 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
41486 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
41488 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
41489 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
41490 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
41492 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41493 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
41496 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41497 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
41498 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
41501 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
41502 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
41503 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
41504 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
41506 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
41507 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
41508 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
41510 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41511 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
41512 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
41513 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
41514 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
41515 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
41517 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
41518 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
41519 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
41520 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
41521 supplied by the remote host, if any.
41523 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41524 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
41525 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
41526 generated messages.
41529 The message is from a local sender.
41531 .vitem &%-localerror%&
41532 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
41534 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
41535 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
41536 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
41537 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
41539 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
41540 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
41541 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
41544 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
41545 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
41548 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
41549 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
41550 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
41552 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
41553 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
41554 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
41556 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
41557 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
41558 of &$spam_score_int$&.
41560 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
41561 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
41562 rather than Unix-format.
41563 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
41564 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
41566 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
41567 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
41568 certificate was verified by the server.
41570 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
41571 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
41572 name of the cipher suite that was used.
41574 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
41575 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
41576 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
41580 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
41581 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
41582 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
41583 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
41584 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
41585 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
41586 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
41587 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
41588 addresses are complete.
41590 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
41591 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
41592 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
41593 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
41594 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
41595 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
41597 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
41598 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
41599 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41601 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
41602 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
41603 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
41604 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
41608 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41609 darcy@austen.fict.example
41611 alice@wonderland.fict.example
41613 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
41614 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
41615 line is of the following form:
41617 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
41618 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
41620 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
41621 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
41622 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
41623 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
41624 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
41625 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
41626 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
41627 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
41630 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
41631 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
41632 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
41633 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
41634 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
41638 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
41639 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
41640 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
41641 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
41642 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
41643 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
41644 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
41645 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
41646 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
41647 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
41650 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
41651 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
41652 typical set of headers:
41654 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
41655 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41656 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
41657 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
41658 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
41659 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
41660 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
41661 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41662 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
41663 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41664 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41666 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
41667 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
41668 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
41669 .ecindex IIDforspo1
41670 .ecindex IIDforspo2
41671 .ecindex IIDforspo3
41673 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
41674 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
41675 an ASCII newline character.
41676 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
41677 can have an alternate format.
41678 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
41679 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
41680 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
41681 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
41682 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
41683 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
41685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41688 .chapter "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
41689 "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC Support"
41691 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
41694 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
41695 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
41696 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
41697 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
41699 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
41700 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
41701 any original DKIM signature.
41703 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
41704 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41706 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
41708 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
41709 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
41710 (including transport filters) except cutthrough delivery.
41711 However, signing options may not depend on headers modified by
41712 routers, the transport or a transport filter.
41714 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
41715 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
41716 different signature contexts.
41719 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
41720 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
41721 Exim's standard controls.
41723 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
41724 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
41726 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
41727 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
41728 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
41729 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
41731 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
41732 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
41733 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
41734 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
41737 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
41738 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
41739 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
41740 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
41744 .subsection "Signing outgoing messages" SECDKIMSIGN
41745 .cindex DKIM signing
41747 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
41748 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
41750 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41752 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41753 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41756 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
41757 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
41758 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
41759 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
41760 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
41762 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
41763 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
41765 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
41766 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
41767 After expansion, this can be a list.
41768 Each element in turn,
41770 .vindex "&$dkim_domain$&"
41771 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
41772 while expanding the remaining signing options.
41773 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
41774 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41776 .option dkim_selector smtp "string list&!!" unset
41777 This sets the key selector string.
41778 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
41779 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
41780 .vindex "&$dkim_selector$&"
41781 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
41782 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
41783 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
41784 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41786 To do, for example, dual-signing with RSA and EC keys
41787 this could be be used:
41789 dkim_selector = ec_sel : rsa_sel
41790 dkim_private_key = KEYS_DIR/$dkim_selector
41793 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
41794 This sets the private key to use.
41795 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
41796 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
41797 The result can either
41799 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
41801 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
41802 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
41804 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
41807 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
41808 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
41812 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
41814 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
41815 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
41817 The result file from the first command should be retained, and
41818 this option set to use it.
41819 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
41820 for the DNS TXT record.
41821 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
41825 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
41826 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
41829 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41831 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41832 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41835 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
41836 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
41837 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
41838 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
41839 for some transition period.
41840 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
41843 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
41845 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
41846 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
41849 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
41851 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
41852 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
41855 Exim also supports an alternate format
41856 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
41857 of the standard, but not adopted.
41858 A future release will probably drop that support.
41860 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
41861 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
41863 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
41865 &`sha256`& &-- the default
41867 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
41870 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41872 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41875 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
41876 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
41877 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
41878 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
41879 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
41880 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
41882 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
41883 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
41884 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
41885 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
41886 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
41888 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
41889 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
41890 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
41891 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
41892 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
41895 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
41896 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
41897 list of header names.
41898 Headers with these names, or the absence of such a header, will be included
41899 in the message signature.
41900 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
41901 whether or not each header is present in the message.
41902 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
41903 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
41904 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
41906 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
41907 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
41908 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
41910 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
41911 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
41913 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
41914 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
41915 name will be appended.
41917 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
41918 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
41919 If not set, no such information will be included.
41920 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the
41921 current time for the expiry tag (e.g. 1209600 for two weeks); both creation
41922 (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included unless the offset is 0 (no expiry).
41924 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
41927 .subsection "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" SECDKIMVFY
41928 .cindex DKIM verification
41930 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
41931 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
41933 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
41934 Individual classes of DKIM signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
41935 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
41936 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
41937 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
41939 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
41940 Performing verification sets up information used by the
41941 &%authresults%& expansion item.
41943 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
41944 of this section can be ignored.
41946 The results of verification are made available to the
41947 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which (for complex needs) can examine and modify them.
41948 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
41949 By default, the ACL is called once for each
41950 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
41951 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
41952 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
41953 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
41955 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
41956 a large number of expansion variables
41957 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
41958 runtime of the ACL.
41960 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
41961 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
41962 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
41963 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
41965 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
41966 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
41967 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
41968 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
41969 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
41970 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
41973 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
41975 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
41976 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
41977 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
41979 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
41981 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
41982 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
41983 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
41985 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
41988 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
41989 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
41991 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
41992 (such as the From: header)
41993 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
41994 and for the domain part if identities.
41995 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
41997 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
41998 for each matching signature.
42001 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
42002 available (from most to least important):
42006 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
42007 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
42008 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
42009 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
42011 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
42012 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined
42013 (it need do no more than accept, which is the default),
42014 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
42015 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
42016 The value is maintained for the MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42018 Within the DKIM ACL,
42019 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
42021 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
42022 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42024 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
42025 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42027 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
42028 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42030 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
42033 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42034 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
42035 hash-method or key-size:
42037 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
42038 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
42039 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
42040 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
42041 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
42042 set dkim_verify_status = fail
42043 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
42046 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
42047 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
42048 "fail" or "invalid". One of
42050 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
42051 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
42053 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
42054 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
42056 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
42057 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
42058 means that the message body was modified in transit.
42060 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
42061 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
42062 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
42063 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
42066 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42068 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
42069 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
42070 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
42071 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42073 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
42074 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
42075 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
42076 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42078 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
42079 The key record selector string.
42081 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
42082 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
42083 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
42084 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
42085 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42088 Note that RFC 8301 says:
42090 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42092 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
42093 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
42096 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
42097 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
42098 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
42099 processing of such signatures.
42101 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
42102 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42104 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
42105 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42107 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
42108 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
42109 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
42110 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
42111 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
42112 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
42114 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
42115 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
42116 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
42117 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
42118 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
42119 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
42120 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
42121 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
42123 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
42124 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
42125 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
42127 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
42128 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
42129 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
42130 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
42131 integer size comparisons against this value.
42132 Note that Exim does not check this value.
42134 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
42135 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
42137 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
42138 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
42140 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
42141 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
42143 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
42144 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42147 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
42148 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42151 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
42152 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
42154 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
42155 Number of bits in the key.
42156 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
42157 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
42159 Note that RFC 8301 says:
42161 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
42162 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
42165 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
42170 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
42173 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
42174 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
42175 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
42176 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42177 This condition is only usable in a DKIM ACL.
42178 This is typically used to restrict an ACL
42179 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
42182 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
42183 warn sender_domains = gmail.com
42184 dkim_signers = gmail.com
42186 log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
42189 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
42190 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
42192 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
42193 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
42194 results against the actual result of verification,
42195 given by &$dkim_verify_status$& if that is non-empty or "none" if empty.
42196 This condition may be used in DKIM, MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42198 A basic verification might be:
42200 deny !dkim_status = pass:none:invalid
42203 A more complex use could be
42204 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
42207 deny sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
42208 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
42209 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
42210 message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
42213 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
42214 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
42215 for more information of what they mean.
42217 The condition is true if the status
42218 (or any of the list of status values)
42219 is any one of the supplied list.
42225 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
42226 .cindex SPF verification
42228 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
42229 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
42230 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
42231 the &url(http://openspf.org).
42232 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
42233 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
42234 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
42237 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
42238 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
42240 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
42241 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
42242 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
42243 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
42244 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
42246 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
42247 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42248 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42249 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42252 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42253 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
42254 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
42255 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
42256 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
42260 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
42263 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
42264 domain in the envelope-from address.
42266 .vitem &%softfail%&
42267 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
42271 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
42274 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
42275 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
42276 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
42278 .vitem &%permerror%&
42279 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
42280 You may deny messages when this occurs.
42282 .vitem &%temperror%&
42283 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
42284 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
42287 There was an error during processing of the SPF lookup
42290 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
42291 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
42292 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
42293 short-circuit fashion.
42298 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
42299 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
42300 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
42301 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why;\
42302 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
42303 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
42304 ip=$sender_host_address
42307 Note: The above mentioned URL may not be as helpful as expected. You are
42308 encouraged to replace the link with a link to a site with more
42311 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
42314 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
42316 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
42317 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
42318 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
42319 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
42320 it for logging purposes.
42322 .vitem &$spf_received$&
42323 .vindex &$spf_received$&
42324 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header (name and
42325 content) that can be added to the message. Please note that
42326 according to the SPF draft, this header must be added at the
42327 top of the header list, i.e. with
42329 add_header = :at_start:$spf_received
42331 See section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>& for further details.
42333 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
42334 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
42336 .vitem &$spf_result$&
42337 .vindex &$spf_result$&
42338 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
42339 currently one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror,
42340 temperror, or &"(invalid)"&.
42342 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
42343 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
42344 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
42345 and required in order to obtain a result.
42347 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42348 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42349 .vindex &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&
42350 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
42351 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
42352 The string is generated by the SPF library from the template configured in the main config
42353 option &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&.
42357 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42358 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
42359 .cindex SPF "best guess"
42360 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
42361 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
42362 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
42364 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
42365 for a description of what it means.
42366 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
42368 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
42369 of the spf one. For example:
42372 deny spf_guess = fail
42373 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
42376 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
42377 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
42378 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
42381 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
42382 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
42384 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
42385 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
42386 &%spf_guess%& option.
42387 For example, the following:
42390 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
42393 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
42396 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
42398 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
42399 address as the key and an IP address
42404 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
42407 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
42408 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
42414 .subsection "SRS (Sender Rewriting Scheme)" SECTSRS
42415 .cindex SRS "sender rewriting scheme"
42416 .cindex VERP "variable envelope return path"
42418 SRS can be used to modify sender addresses when forwarding so that
42419 SPF verification does not object to them.
42420 It can also be used to identify a received bounce message as
42421 likely (or not) having been trigged by a message from the
42422 local system, and for identifying dead addresses in mailing lists.
42423 It is one implementation of a VERP (Variable Envelope Return Path) method.
42425 SRS operates by encoding the original envelope sender in a new
42426 sender local part and using a domain run by the forwarding site
42427 as the new domain for the sender. Any DSN message should be returned
42428 to this new sender at the forwarding site, which can extract the
42429 original sender from the coded local part and forward the DSN to
42432 This is a way of avoiding the breakage that SPF does to forwarding.
42433 The constructed local-part will be longer than the original,
42434 leading to possible problems with very long addresses.
42435 The changing of the sender address also hinders the tracing of mail
42438 Exim can be built to include native SRS support. To do this
42439 SUPPORT_SRS=yes must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42440 If this has been done, the macros _HAVE_SRS and _HAVE_NATIVE_SRS
42442 The support is limited to SRS0-encoding; SRS1 is not supported.
42444 .cindex SRS excoding
42445 To encode an address use this expansion item:
42447 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
42448 .cindex "&%srs_encode%& expansion item"
42449 .cindex SRS "expansion item"
42450 The first argument should be a secret known and used by all systems
42451 handling the recipient domain for the original message.
42452 There is no need to periodically change this key; a timestamp is also
42454 The second argument should be given as the envelope sender address before this
42455 encoding operation.
42456 If this value is empty the the expansion result will be empty.
42457 The third argument should be the recipient domain of the message when
42458 it arrived at this system.
42459 All arguments are expanded before use.
42461 The result of the expansion is the replacement envelope-from (return path)
42465 .cindex SRS decoding
42466 To decode an address use this expansion condition:
42468 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
42469 The first argument should be the recipient local part as it was received.
42470 The second argument is the site secret.
42471 Both arguments are expanded before use.
42473 If the messages is not for an SRS-encoded recipient the condition will
42475 If it is, the condition will return true and the variable
42476 &$srs_recipient$& will be set to the decoded (original) value.
42478 If the second argument is empty then the condition returns true if
42479 the first argument is in valid SRS formet, else false.
42480 The variable &$srs_recipient$& is not set for this case.
42486 SRS_SECRET = <pick something unique for your site for this. Use on all MXs.>
42492 # if outbound, and forwarding has been done, use an alternate transport
42493 domains = ! +my_domains
42494 transport = ${if eq {$local_part@$domain} \
42495 {$original_local_part@$original_domain} \
42496 {remote_smtp} {remote_forwarded_smtp}}
42501 domains = +my_domains
42502 # detect inbound bounces which are SRS'd, and decode them
42503 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {SRS_SECRET}}
42504 data = $srs_recipient
42506 inbound_srs_failure:
42509 domains = +my_domains
42510 # detect inbound bounces which look SRS'd but are invalid
42511 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {}}
42513 data = :fail: Invalid SRS recipient address
42515 #... further routers here get inbound_srs-redirected recipients
42516 # and any that were not SRS'd
42519 # transport; should look like the non-forward outbound
42520 # one, plus the max_rcpt and return_path options
42521 remote_forwarded_smtp:
42523 # single-recipient so that $original_domain is valid
42525 # modify the envelope from, for mails that we forward
42526 return_path = ${srs_encode {SRS_SECRET} {$return_path} {$original_domain}}
42533 .section DMARC SECDMARC
42534 .cindex DMARC verification
42536 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
42537 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
42538 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
42539 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
42540 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
42542 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
42543 the libopendmarc library is used.
42545 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
42546 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
42547 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
42548 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
42549 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
42550 This description assumes
42551 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
42552 are in /usr/local/lib.
42554 .subsection Configuration SSECDMARCCONFIG
42555 .cindex DMARC configuration
42557 There are three main-configuration options:
42558 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
42560 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
42561 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
42562 defines the location of a text file of valid
42563 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
42564 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
42565 the most current version can be downloaded
42566 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
42567 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
42568 The default for the option is unset.
42569 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
42572 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
42573 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
42574 defines the location of a file to log results
42575 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
42576 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
42577 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
42578 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
42579 directory of this file is writable by the user
42581 The default is unset.
42583 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
42584 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42585 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
42586 forensic report detailing alignment failures
42587 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
42588 and you have configured Exim to send them.
42589 If set, this is expanded and used for the
42590 From: header line; the address is extracted
42591 from it and used for the envelope from.
42592 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
42593 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
42596 .subsection Controls SSECDMARCCONTROLS
42597 .cindex DMARC controls
42599 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
42600 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
42601 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
42602 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
42603 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
42604 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
42606 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42608 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
42609 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
42610 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
42611 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
42612 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
42613 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
42614 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
42615 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
42616 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
42617 construction might be inadequate.
42619 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42621 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
42622 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
42623 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
42626 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
42629 .subsection ACL SSECDMARCACL
42630 .cindex DMARC "ACL condition"
42632 DMARC checks can be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
42633 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
42634 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
42635 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
42636 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
42637 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
42638 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
42640 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
42641 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
42642 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
42643 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
42644 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
42645 .irow &'accept'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email"
42646 .irow &'reject'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email"
42647 .irow &'quarantine'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection"
42648 .irow &'none'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral"
42649 .irow &'norecord'& "No policy section in the DMARC record for this RFC5322.From field"
42650 .irow &'nofrom'& "Unable to determine the domain of the sender"
42651 .irow &'temperror'& "Library error or dns error"
42652 .irow &'off'& "The DMARC check was disabled for this email"
42654 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
42655 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
42656 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
42657 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
42658 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
42659 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
42662 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
42663 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
42664 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
42666 Performing the check sets up information used by the
42667 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42669 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
42670 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
42671 expansion variables are available:
42674 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
42675 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
42676 .cindex DMARC result
42677 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
42678 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
42679 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
42680 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
42681 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
42683 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
42684 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
42685 Slightly longer, human readable status.
42687 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42688 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42689 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
42691 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42692 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42693 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
42694 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
42695 is any error, including no DMARC record.
42698 .subsection Logging SSECDMARCLOGGING
42699 .cindex DMARC logging
42701 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
42702 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
42703 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
42704 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
42705 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
42706 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
42707 processing or failure delivery issues).
42709 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
42710 tools, you need to:
42712 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
42714 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
42715 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
42718 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
42720 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42722 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
42723 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
42726 .subsection Example SSECDMARCEXAMPLE
42727 .cindex DMARC example
42732 warn domains = +local_domains
42733 hosts = +local_hosts
42734 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42736 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
42737 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42739 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
42740 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
42743 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
42745 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
42747 warn dmarc_status = !accept
42749 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
42751 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
42753 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
42754 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
42756 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
42757 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
42758 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
42760 deny dmarc_status = reject
42762 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
42764 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
42771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42774 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
42776 .cindex "proxy support"
42777 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
42779 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
42780 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
42783 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
42784 .cindex proxy inbound
42785 .cindex proxy "server side"
42786 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
42787 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
42789 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
42790 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
42791 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
42794 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
42795 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
42797 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
42798 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
42799 to distribute load.
42800 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
42801 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
42802 There is no logging if a host passes or
42803 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
42804 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
42806 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
42807 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
42808 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
42809 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
42810 automatically determines which version is in use.
42812 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
42813 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
42814 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
42815 Exim and the proxy server. The Proxy Protocol header must be received
42816 within &%proxy_protocol_timeout%&, which defaults to 3s.
42818 The following expansion variables are usable
42819 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
42821 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
42822 .irow $proxy_external_address "IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy"
42823 .irow $proxy_external_port "Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy"
42824 .irow $proxy_local_address "IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy"
42825 .irow $proxy_local_port "Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy"
42826 .irow $proxy_session "boolean: SMTP connection via proxy"
42828 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
42829 there was a protocol error.
42830 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
42831 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
42833 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
42834 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
42835 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
42836 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
42837 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
42838 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
42839 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
42840 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
42841 A possible solution is:
42843 # Set max number of connections per host
42845 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
42846 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
42848 defer ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
42849 message = Too many connections from this IP right now
42854 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
42855 .cindex proxy outbound
42856 .cindex proxy "client side"
42857 .cindex proxy SOCKS
42858 .cindex SOCKS proxy
42859 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
42860 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
42861 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
42864 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
42865 on an smtp transport.
42866 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
42867 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
42868 Each proxy specifier is a list
42869 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
42870 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
42872 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
42873 The list of options is in the following table:
42874 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
42875 .irow &'auth'& "authentication method"
42876 .irow &'name'& "authentication username"
42877 .irow &'pass'& "authentication password"
42878 .irow &'port'& "tcp port"
42879 .irow &'tmo'& "connection timeout"
42880 .irow &'pri'& "priority"
42881 .irow &'weight'& "selection bias"
42884 More details on each of these options follows:
42887 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
42888 .cindex proxy authentication
42889 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
42890 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
42891 for access to the proxy.
42892 Default is &"none"&.
42894 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
42897 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
42900 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
42903 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
42906 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
42907 higher values being tried first.
42908 The default priority is 1.
42910 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
42911 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
42912 weighted by this value.
42913 The default value for selection bias is 1.
42916 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
42917 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
42918 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
42920 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
42921 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
42922 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
42923 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
42925 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42926 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42928 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
42929 "Internationalisation""
42930 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
42933 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
42935 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
42936 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
42937 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
42939 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
42940 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
42941 requirement, upon libidn2.
42943 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
42944 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
42945 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
42946 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
42947 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
42948 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
42949 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
42951 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
42952 international handling for the message is enabled and
42953 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
42955 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
42956 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
42957 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
42958 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
42960 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
42961 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
42962 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
42963 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
42965 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
42966 components expanded to a-label form,
42967 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
42970 .cindex log protocol
42971 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
42972 .cindex i18n logging
42973 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
42974 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
42976 The following expansion operators can be used:
42978 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
42979 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
42980 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
42981 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
42984 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
42985 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
42987 may use the following modifier:
42989 control = utf8_downconvert
42990 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
42992 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
42993 a-label form before smtp delivery.
42994 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
42995 but could be used for any message.
42997 If a value is appended it may be:
42998 .itable none 0 0 2 5* right 95* left
42999 .irow &`1`& "mandatory downconversion"
43000 .irow &`0`& "no downconversion"
43001 .irow &`-1`& "if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host"
43003 If no value is given, 1 is used.
43005 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
43006 is initially set to -1.
43008 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
43009 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
43010 or an empty string.
43011 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
43012 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
43015 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
43016 Configurations supporting these should inspect
43017 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
43019 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
43020 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
43021 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
43023 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
43024 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
43028 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
43029 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
43030 the following expansion operator can be used:
43032 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
43035 The string is converted from the charset specified by
43036 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
43037 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
43039 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
43040 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
43041 (which has to be a single character)
43042 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
43043 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
43045 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
43046 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
43048 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
43049 by many other IMAP servers.
43053 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
43054 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
43055 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
43058 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
43059 must be representable in UTF-16.
43062 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43063 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43065 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
43069 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
43070 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
43071 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
43072 processing actions.
43074 Most installations will never need to use Events.
43075 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
43076 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
43078 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
43079 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
43080 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
43082 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
43083 An example might look like:
43084 .cindex logging custom
43086 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
43087 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
43088 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
43089 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
43090 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
43091 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
43092 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
43093 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
43094 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
43098 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
43099 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
43100 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
43102 The current list of events is:
43103 .itable all 0 0 4 25* left 10* center 15* center 50* left
43104 .row auth:fail after both "per driver per authentication attempt"
43105 .row dane:fail after transport "per connection"
43106 .row dns:fail after both "per lookup"
43107 .row msg:complete after main "per message"
43108 .row msg:defer after transport "per message per delivery try"
43109 .row msg:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43110 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport "per recipient per host"
43111 .row msg:rcpt:defer after transport "per recipient"
43112 .row msg:host:defer after transport "per host per delivery try; host errors"
43113 .row msg:fail:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43114 .row msg:fail:internal after main "per recipient"
43115 .row tcp:connect before transport "per connection"
43116 .row tcp:close after transport "per connection"
43117 .row tls:cert before both "per certificate in verification chain"
43118 .row tls:fail:connect after main "per connection"
43119 .row smtp:connect after transport "per connection"
43120 .row smtp:ehlo after transport "per connection"
43122 New event types may be added in future.
43124 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
43125 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
43126 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
43128 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
43129 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
43130 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
43132 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
43133 should define the event action.
43135 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
43136 with the event type:
43137 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43138 .row auth:fail "smtp response"
43139 .row dane:fail "failure reason"
43140 .row dns:fail "failure reason, key and lookup-type"
43141 .row msg:defer "error string"
43142 .row msg:delivery "smtp confirmation message"
43143 .row msg:fail:internal "failure reason"
43144 .row msg:fail:delivery "smtp error message"
43145 .row msg:host:defer "error string"
43146 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer "error string"
43147 .row msg:rcpt:defer "error string"
43148 .row tls:cert "verification chain depth"
43149 .row tls:fail:connect "error string"
43150 .row smtp:connect "smtp banner"
43151 .row smtp:ehlo "smtp ehlo response"
43154 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
43156 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&,
43157 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
43158 the course of its processing:
43160 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
43163 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
43164 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
43166 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
43167 a useful way of writing to the main log.
43169 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
43170 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
43171 following will be forced:
43172 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43173 .row auth:fail "log information to write"
43174 .row tcp:connect "do not connect"
43175 .row tls:cert "refuse verification"
43176 .row smtp:connect "close connection"
43178 All other message types ignore the result string, and
43179 no other use is made of it.
43181 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
43182 then the &$host_address$& and &$host_port$& variables
43183 will be that of the proxy and not the target system.
43185 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
43186 chain element received on the connection.
43187 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
43190 For dns:fail events from dnsdb lookups, a &"defer_never"& option does not
43191 affect the reporting of DNS_AGAIN.
43193 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43194 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43196 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
43197 "Adding drivers or lookups"
43198 .cindex "adding drivers"
43199 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
43200 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
43201 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
43202 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
43205 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
43206 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
43208 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
43210 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
43212 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
43213 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
43214 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
43216 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
43218 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
43221 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
43222 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
43224 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
43225 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
43226 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
43227 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
43228 simple form that most lookups have.
43230 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
43231 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
43232 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
43234 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
43235 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
43237 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
43240 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
43241 as for other drivers and lookups.
43244 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
43245 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
43246 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
43247 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
43248 searched using a binary chop procedure.
43250 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
43251 the interface that is expected.
43256 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43259 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43260 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
43261 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
43262 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
43264 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43269 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
43270 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
43274 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
43275 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
43276 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
43279 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43280 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////